ZILOG EZ80F91MCU

eZ80Acclaim!™ Flash Microcontrollers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Worldwide Headquarters • 532 Race Street • San Jose, CA 95126
Telephone: 408.558.8500 • Fax: 408.558.8300 • www.ZiLOG.com
This publication is subject to replacement by a later edition. To determine whether a later edition
exists, or to request copies of publications, contact:
ZiLOG Worldwide Headquarters
532 Race Street
San Jose, CA 95126
Telephone: 408.558.8500
Fax: 408.558.8300
www.ZiLOG.com
ZiLOG is a registered trademark of ZiLOG Inc. in the United States and in other countries. All other products and/or
service names mentioned herein may be trademarks of the companies with which they are associated.
Document Disclaimer
© 2004 by ZiLOG, Inc. All rights reserved. Information in this publication concerning the devices, applications, or
technology described is intended to suggest possible uses and may be superseded. ZiLOG, INC. DOES NOT
ASSUME LIABILITY FOR OR PROVIDE A REPRESENTATION OF ACCURACY OF THE INFORMATION, DEVICES,
OR TECHNOLOGY DESCRIBED IN THIS DOCUMENT. ZiLOG ALSO DOES NOT ASSUME LIABILITY FOR
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY INFRINGEMENT RELATED IN ANY MANNER TO USE OF INFORMATION, DEVICES,
OR TECHNOLOGY DESCRIBED HEREIN OR OTHERWISE. Except with the express written approval ZiLOG, use of
information, devices, or technology as critical components of life support systems is not authorized. No licenses or
other rights are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, by this document under any intellectual property rights.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
iii
Table of Contents
List of Figures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
List of Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Architectural Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Pin Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
System Clock Source Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
SCLK Source Selection Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Register Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
eZ80® CPU Core . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
New Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
External Reset Input and Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Voltage Brown-Out Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
SLEEP Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
HALT Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
HALT Mode and the EMAC Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
General-Purpose Input/Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
GPIO Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
GPIO Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
GPIO Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Level-Triggered Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Edge-Triggered Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
GPIO Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Port x Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Port x Data Direction Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Port x Alternate Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Port x Alternate Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Interrupt Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Maskable Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Interrupt Priority Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
GPIO Port Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
iv
Chip Selects and Wait States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Memory and I/O Chip Selects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Memory Chip Select Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Memory Chip Select Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Reset States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Memory Chip Select Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
I/O Chip Select Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Wait States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
WAIT Input Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Chip Selects During Bus Request/Bus Acknowledge Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Bus Mode Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
eZ80 Bus Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Z80 Bus Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Intel Bus Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Intel Bus Mode—Separate Address and Data Buses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Intel™ Bus Mode—Multiplexed Address and Data Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Motorola Bus Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Switching Between Bus Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Chip Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Chip Select x Lower Bound Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Chip Select x Upper Bound Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Chip Select x Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Chip Select x Bus Mode Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Bus Arbiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Random Access Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
RAM Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
RAM Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
RAM Address Upper Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
MBIST Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Flash Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Flash Memory Arrangement in the eZ80F91 Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Flash Memory Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Reading Flash Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Memory Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
I/O Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Programming Flash Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Single-Byte I/O Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Multibyte I/O Write (Row Programming) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Memory Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Erasing Flash Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Mass Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Page Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Information Page Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Flash Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
v
Flash Key Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Address Upper Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Frequency Divider Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Write/Erase Protection Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Interrupt Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Page Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Row Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Column Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Program Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Watch-Dog Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Watch-Dog Timer Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Watch-Dog Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enabling and Disabling the WDT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Time-Out Period Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RESET Or NMI Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Watch-Dog Timer Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Watch-Dog Timer Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Watch-Dog Timer Reset Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Programmable Reload Timers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Programmable Reload Timers Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Basic Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reading the Current Count Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting Timer Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Single Pass Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Continuous Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Input Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Break Point Halting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Specialty Timer Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Event Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RTC Oscillator Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Port Pin Allocation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Basic Timer Register Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Register Set for Capture in Timer 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Register Set for Capture/Compare/PWM in Timer 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Interrupt Identification Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
118
119
120
120
122
122
123
123
123
124
124
124
126
127
127
128
128
128
129
130
130
131
131
132
133
133
134
134
134
135
136
136
136
137
138
139
141
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
vi
Timer Data Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Data Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Reload Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Reload Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Input Capture Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Input Capture Value A Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Input Capture Value A Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Input Capture Value B Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Input Capture Value B Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Output Compare Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Output Compare Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Output Compare Value Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Timer Output Compare Value Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
142
142
143
144
144
145
146
146
147
147
148
149
150
Multi-PWM Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Multi-PWM Mode Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PWM Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Modification of Edge Transition Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AND/OR Gating of the PWM Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PWM Nonoverlapping Output Pair Delays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multi-PWM Power-Trip Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Multi-PWM Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation Rising Edge—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation Rising Edge—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation Falling Edge—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pulse-Width Modulation Falling Edge—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Oscillator and Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Battery Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Recommended Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Seconds Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Minutes Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Hours Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Week Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Month Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Month Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Year Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Century Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Alarm Seconds Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
150
153
153
154
155
157
158
158
159
161
162
163
164
165
166
166
167
167
167
167
168
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
vii
Real-Time Clock Alarm Minutes Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Alarm Hours Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Alarm Day-of-the-Week Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Alarm Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Real-Time Clock Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
177
178
179
180
181
183
UART Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
UART Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Modem Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Transmitter Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Receiver Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Modem Status Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Recommended Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Module Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control Transfers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Transfers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Baud Rate Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
BRG Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Baud Rate Generator Register—Low and High Bytes . . . . . . .
UART Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Transmit Holding Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Receive Buffer Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Interrupt Identification Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART FIFO Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Line Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Modem Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Line Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Modem Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
UART Scratch Pad Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Infrared Encoder/Decoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transmit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Receive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Jitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Signal Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Loopback Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Serial Peripheral Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
184
184
185
185
186
186
186
187
187
187
187
187
188
189
189
191
191
192
192
193
195
196
198
200
202
203
204
204
205
205
206
206
207
207
209
210
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
viii
Master In, Slave Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Out, Slave In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Slave Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Serial Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Flags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mode Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Write Collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Baud Rate Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Baud Rate Generator Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Transfer Procedure with SPI Configured as a Master . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Transfer Procedure with SPI Configured as a Slave . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Baud Rate Generator Registers—Low Byte and High Byte . . . . .
SPI Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Transmit Shift Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SPI Receive Buffer Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Serial I/O Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C General Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clocking Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bus Arbitration Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Validity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
START and STOP Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transferring Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Byte Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Acknowledge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clock Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Arbitration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clock Synchronization for Handshake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Transmit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Receive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Slave Transmit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Slave Receive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
I C Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Resetting the I2C Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Slave Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Extended Slave Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Clock Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
210
210
210
210
212
213
213
213
213
213
214
214
214
215
216
217
217
218
219
219
219
219
220
220
221
221
221
222
223
224
224
224
227
229
230
231
231
231
232
232
233
234
236
238
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
ix
Bus Clock Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
I2C Software Reset Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ethernet Media Access Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Arbiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TxDMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RxDMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Shared Memory Organization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC and the System Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Operation in HALT Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Configuration Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Configuration Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Configuration Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Configuration Register 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Station Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value Register—Low and High Bytes .
EMAC Interpacket Gap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Interpacket Gap Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Interpacket Gap Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Maximum Frame Length Register—Low and High Bytes . . . .
EMAC Address Filter Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Hash Table Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC MII Management Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC PHY Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC PHY Unit Select Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Transmit Polling Timer Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Reset Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer Register—Low and
High Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Low and High Bytes . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Upper Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Receive High Boundary Pointer Register—Low and
High Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Receive Read Pointer Register—Low and High Bytes . . . . . .
EMAC Buffer Size Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
239
239
240
241
241
242
242
243
244
245
248
249
249
249
251
253
254
255
256
257
258
258
259
260
261
261
263
264
265
266
267
267
268
268
269
270
271
272
272
273
274
275
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
x
EMAC Interrupt Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC PHY Read Status Data Register—Low and High Bytes . . . . .
EMAC MII Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—Low and High Bytes . . . . . . . .
EMAC FIFO Data Register—Low and High Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EMAC FIFO Flags Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZiLOG Debug Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI-Supported Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Clock and Data Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Start Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Single-Bit Byte Separator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Register Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Write Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Single-Byte Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Block Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Read Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Single-Byte Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Block Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operation of the eZ80F91 Device during ZDI Break Points . . . . . . . . . . .
Bus Requests During ZDI Debug Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Potential Hazards of Enabling Bus Requests During Debug Mode . . .
ZDI Write Only Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Read Only Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Address Match Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Break Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Master Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Write Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Read/Write Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Bus Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Instruction Store 4:0 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Write Memory Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
eZ80 Product ID Low and High Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
eZ80 Product ID Revision Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Read Register Low, High, and Upper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Bus Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ZDI Read Memory Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
277
278
279
280
281
281
282
282
284
285
286
286
287
288
288
289
290
291
291
291
292
292
292
293
293
294
294
295
296
296
297
299
300
300
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
309
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xi
On-Chip Instrumentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Introduction to On-Chip Instrumentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
OCI Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
OCI Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JTAG Boundary Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pin Coverage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Boundary Scan Cell Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chain Sequence and Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Boundary Scan Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Phase-Locked Loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Phase Frequency Detector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Charge Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Voltage Controlled Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Loop Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Divider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
MUX/CLK Sync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lock Detect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PLL Normal Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Requirement to the Phase-Locked Loop Function . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PLL Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PLL Divider Control Register—Low and High Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PLL Control Register 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PLL Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PLL Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
eZ80® CPU Instruction Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Op-Code Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
On-Chip Oscillators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Primary Crystal Oscillator Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
32 KHz Real-Time Clock Crystal Oscillator Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
311
311
312
312
313
313
313
314
314
319
319
320
320
321
321
321
321
321
321
322
322
323
323
323
325
326
327
330
335
342
342
343
345
345
DC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
POR and VBO Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flash Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
346
347
347
348
External Memory Read Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Memory Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External I/O Read Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External I/O Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wait State Timing for Read Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
349
350
352
353
355
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xii
Wait State Timing for Write Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Purpose I/O Port Input Sample Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Purpose I/O Port Output Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Bus Acknowledge Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External System Clock Driver Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Packaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Part Number Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Precharacterization Product . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Document Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Document Number Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Change Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Customer Feedback Form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
356
357
357
358
358
359
361
361
362
363
363
363
364
379
Table of Contents
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xiii
List of Figures
Figure 1. GPIO Port Pin Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Figure 2. Example: Memory Chip Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Figure 3. Wait Input Sampling Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Figure 4. Example: Z80 Bus Mode Read Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Figure 5. Example: Z80 Bus Mode Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Figure 6. Intel Bus Mode Signal and Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Figure 7. Motorola Bus Mode Signal and Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Figure 8. Example: eZ80F91 On-Chip RAM Memory Addressing . . . . . . . . . 101
Figure 9. Programmable Reload Timer Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Figure 10. PWM AND/OR Gating Functional Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Figure 11. UART Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Figure 12. SPI Master Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Figure 13. SPI Slave Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Figure 14. I2C Clock and Data Relationship . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Figure 15. START and STOP Conditions In I2C Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Figure 16. I2C Frame Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Figure 17. I2C Acknowledge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Figure 18. Clock Synchronization In I2C Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Figure 19. internal Ethernet Shared Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Figure 20. Descriptor Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Figure 21. Descriptor Table Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Figure 22. Typical ZDI Debug Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
Figure 23. Schematic For Building a Target Board ZPAK Connector . . . . . . . 287
Figure 24. ZDI Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Figure 25. ZDI Read Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Figure 26. Normal PLL Programming Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Figure 27. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Configuration—50 MHz
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Figure 28. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Configuration—32 KHz
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Figure 29. External I/O Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Figure 30. Wait State Timing for Read Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
Figure 31. Wait State Timing for Write Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
List of Figures
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xiv
List of Tables
Table 1.
Table 2.
Table 3.
Table 4.
Table 5.
Table 6.
Table 7.
Table 8.
Table 9.
Table 10.
Table 11.
Table 12.
Table 13.
Table 14.
Table 15.
Table 16.
Table 17.
Table 18.
Table 19.
Table 20.
Table 21.
Table 22.
Table 23.
Table 24.
Table 25.
Table 26.
Table 27.
Table 28.
Table 29.
Table 30.
Table 31.
Table 32.
PS019209-0504
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Port x Data Direction Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Port x Alternate Registers 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Port x Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Port x Alternate Registers 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Interrupt Vector Sources by Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Interrupt Priority Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Interrupt Vector Priority Control Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Example: Maskable Interrupt Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Example: Priority Levels for Maskable Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Chip Select x Lower Bound Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Chip Select x Upper Bound Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Chip Select x Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Chip Select x Bus Mode Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
eZ80F91 Pin Status During Bus Acknowledge Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . 98
RAM Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
RAM Address Upper Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
MBIST Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Flash Key Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Flash Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Flash Address Upper Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Flash Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Flash Frequency Divider Values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Flash Frequency Divider Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Flash Write/Erase Protection Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Flash Interrupt Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Flash Page Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Flash Row Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Flash Column Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Flash Program Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Watch-Dog Timer Approximate Time-Out Delays . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
PRELIMINARY
List of Tables
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xv
Table 33. Watch-Dog Timer Approximate Time-Out Delays w/ Internal
RC Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 34. Watch-Dog Timer Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 35. Watch-Dog Timer Reset Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 36. Example: PRT Single Pass Mode Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 37. Example : PRT Continuous Mode Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 38. Example: PRT Timer Out Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 39. GPIO Mode Selection When Using Timer Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 40. Timer Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 41. Timer Interrupt Enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 42. Timer Interrupt Identification Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 43. Timer Data Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 44. Timer Reload Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 45. Timer Data Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 46. Timer Reload Register—High Byte. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 47. Timer Input Capture Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 48. Timer Input Capture Value Register A—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 49. Timer Input Capture Value Register A—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 50. Timer Input Capture Value Register B—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 51. Timer Input Capture Value Register B—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 52. Timer Output Compare Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 53. Timer Output Compare Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 54. Compare Value Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 55. Compare Value Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 56. Enabling PWM Generators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 57. PWM Nonoverlapping Output Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 58. PWM Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 59. PWM Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 60. PWM Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 61. PWMx Rising-Edge Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 62. PWMx Rising-Edge Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 63. PWMx Falling-Edge Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 64. PWMx Falling-Edge Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 65. Real-Time Clock Seconds Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 66. Real-Time Clock Minutes Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 67. Real-Time Clock Hours Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
123
124
126
129
130
132
135
138
139
141
142
143
143
144
144
145
146
146
147
147
148
149
150
151
156
158
159
161
162
163
164
165
168
169
170
List of Tables
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xvi
Table 68. Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Week Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 69. Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Month Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 70. Real-Time Clock Month Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 71. Real-Time Clock Year Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 72. Real-Time Clock Century Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 73. Real-Time Clock Alarm Seconds Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 74. Real-Time Clock Alarm Minutes Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 75. Real-Time Clock Alarm Hours Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 76. Real-Time Clock Alarm Day-of-the-Week Register . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 77. Real-Time Clock Alarm Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 78. Real-Time Clock Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 79. UART Baud Rate Generator Register—Low Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 80. UART Baud Rate Generator Register—High Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 81. UART Transmit Holding Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 82. UART Receive Buffer Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 83. UART Interrupt Enable Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 84. UART Interrupt Identification Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 85. UART Interrupt Status Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 86. UART FIFO Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 87. UART Line Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 88. UART Character Parameter Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 89. UART Modem Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 90. Parity Select Definition for Multidrop Communications. . . . . . . . . .
Table 91. UART Line Status Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 92. UART Modem Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 93. UART Scratch Pad Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 94. Infrared Encoder/Decoder Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 95. SPI Clock Phase and Clock Polarity Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 96. SPI Baud Rate Generator Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 97. SPI Baud Rate Generator Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 98. SPI Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 99. SPI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 100. SPI Receive Buffer Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 101. SPI Transmit Shift Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 102. I2C Master Transmit Status Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 103. I2C 10-Bit Master Transmit Status Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
190
190
191
192
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
198
200
202
203
207
211
215
215
216
217
218
218
225
226
List of Tables
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xvii
Table 104. I2C Master Transmit Status Codes For Data Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 105. I2C Master Receive Status Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 106. I2C Master Receive Status Codes For Data Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 107. I2C Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 108. I2C Slave Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 109. I2C Extended Slave Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 110. I2C Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 111. I2C Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 112. I2C Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 113. I2C Status Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 114. I2C Clock Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 115. I2C Software Reset Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 116. Arbiter Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 117. EMAC Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 118. EMAC Configuration Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 119. EMAC Configuration Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 120. EMAC Configuration Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 121. EMAC Configuration Register 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 122. EMAC Station Address Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 123. EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value Register—Low Byte . . . . . . .
Table 124. EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value Register—High Byte . . . . . . .
Table 125. EMAC_IPGT Non-Back-to-Back Settings for Full/Half Duplex
Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 126. EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 127. EMAC Interpacket Gap Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 128. EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 129. EMAC Maximum Frame Length Register—High Byte. . . . . . . . . .
Table 130. EMAC Maximum Frame Length Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . .
Table 131. EMAC Address Filter Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 132. EMAC Hash Table Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 133. EMAC MII Management Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 134. EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . .
Table 135. EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . .
Table 136. EMAC PHY Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 137. EMAC PHY Unit Select Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 138. EMAC Transmit Polling Timer Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
227
228
229
231
232
233
233
235
236
236
238
239
242
250
251
253
254
255
256
257
257
259
260
260
261
262
262
263
264
265
266
267
267
268
268
List of Tables
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xviii
Table 139. EMAC Reset Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 140. EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer Register—Low Byte . . .
Table 141. EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer Register—High Byte . .
Table 142. EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Low Byte. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 143. EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 144. EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Upper Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 145. EMAC Receive High Boundary Pointer Register—Low Byte . . . .
Table 146. EMAC Receive Read Pointer Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 147. EMAC Receive High Boundary Pointer Register—High Byte . . . .
Table 148. EMAC Receive Read Pointer Register—High Byte. . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 149. EMAC Buffer Size Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 150. EMAC Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 151. EMAC Interrupt Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 152. EMAC PHY Read Status Data Register—Low Byte. . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 153. EMAC MII Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 154. EMAC PHY Read Status Data Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 155. EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—Low Byte. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 156. EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 157. EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 158. EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—High Byte. . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 159. EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 160. EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—Low Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 161. EMAC FIFO Data Register—Low Byte. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 162. EMAC FIFO Data Register—High Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 163. EMAC FIFO Flags Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 164. Recommend ZDI Clock vs. System Clock Frequency . . . . . . . . . .
Table 165. ZDI Write Only Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 166. ZDI Address Match Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 167. ZDI Break Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 168. ZDI Master Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 169. ZDI Write Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 170. ZDI Read/Write Control Register Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 171. ZDI Bus Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 172. Instruction Store 4:0 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 173. eZ80 Product ID Low Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 174. ZDI Write Memory Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
269
270
270
271
271
272
272
273
273
274
275
276
277
278
279
279
280
281
281
282
283
283
284
284
285
287
294
296
297
299
300
301
302
304
305
305
List of Tables
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
xix
Table 175. eZ80 Product ID Revision Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 176. eZ80 Product ID High Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 177. ZDI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 178. ZDI Read Register Low, High and Upper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 179. ZDI Bus Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 180. ZDI Read Memory Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 181. PLL Divider Register—Low Bytes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 182. PLL Divider Register—High Bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 183. PLL Control Register 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 184. PLL Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 185. Arithmetic Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 186. Bit Manipulation Instructions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 187. Block Transfer and Compare Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 188. Exchange Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 189. Input/Output Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 190. Load Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 191. Logical Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 192. Processor Control Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 193. Program Control Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 194. Rotate and Shift Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 195. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Specifications—1 MHz
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 196. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Specifications—10 MHz
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 197. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Specifications—32 KHz
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 198. Typical 144-LQFP Package Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . .
Table 199. External Memory Read Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 200. External Memory Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 201. External I/O Read Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 202. External I/O Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 203. GPIO Port Output Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 204. Bus Acknowledge Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Table 205. PHI System Clock Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
306
306
307
308
309
310
324
324
325
326
330
330
330
331
331
332
332
332
333
333
343
343
344
348
349
351
352
354
358
358
358
List of Tables
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
1
Architectural Overview
The eZ80F91 device is a member of ZiLOG’s family of eZ80Acclaim!™ Flash
Microcontrollers. The eZ80F91 is a high-speed single-cycle instruction-fetch
microcontroller with a maximum clock speed of 50 MHz. It can operate in Z80compatible addressing mode (64 KB) or full 24-bit addressing mode (16 MB). The
rich peripheral set of the eZ80F91 makes it suitable for a variety of applications,
including industrial control, embedded communication, and point-of-sale terminals.
Features
•
•
Single-cycle instruction fetch, high-performance, pipelined eZ80® CPU core1
•
•
256 KB Flash memory and 16 KB SRAM (8 KB user, 8 KB EMAC)
•
•
•
•
•
Two UARTs with independent baud rate generators
•
Fixed-priority vectored interrupts (both internal and external) and interrupt
controller
•
Real-time clock with on-chip 32 KHz oscillator, selectable 50/60Hz input, and
separate VDD pin for battery backup
•
•
•
•
Four 16-bit Counter/Timers with prescalers and direct input/output drive
10/100 BaseT Ethernet Media Access Controller with Media-Independent
Interface (MII)
Low power features including SLEEP mode, HALT mode, and selective
peripheral power-down control
SPI with independent clock rate generator
I2C with independent clock rate generator
IrDA-compliant infrared encoder/decoder
Glueless external peripheral interface with 4 Chip Selects, individual Wait
State generators, and an external WAIT input pin—supports Z80-, Intel-, and
Motorola-style buses
Watch-Dog Timer with internal oscillator clocking option
32 bits of General-Purpose I/O
OCI™ and ZDI debug interfaces
1. For simplicity, the term eZ80® CPU is referred to as CPU for the bulk of this
document.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
2
•
•
•
•
Note:
1149.1-compatible JTAG
144-pin LQFP and BGA packages
3.0–3.6 V supply voltage with 5 V tolerant inputs
Operating Temperature Range:
– Standard: 0ºC to +70ºC
– Extended: –40ºC to +105ºC
All signals with an overline are active Low. For example, B/W, for which WORD is
active Low, and B/W, for which BYTE is active Low.
Power connections follow these conventional descriptions:
Connection
Circuit
Device
Power
VCC
VDD
Ground
GND
VSS
Block Diagram
Figure 1 illustrates a block diagram of the eZ80F91 microcontroller.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
3
MII Interface
Signals (18)
Ethernet
MAC
8KB
SRAM
Arbiter
Real-Time
RTC_VDD
Clock and
32KHz
Oscillator
RTC_XIN
RTC_XOUT
BUSACK
BUSREQ
INSTRD
Bus
Controller
I2C
Serial
Interface
ADDR[23:0]
SDA
MREQ
SCK
RD
DATA[7:0]
SCL
WR
NMI
SPI
Serial
Parallel
Interface
SS
MISO
IORQ
eZ80
CPU
HALT_SLP
256KB
MOSI
Flash
JTAG/ZDI
Debug
Interface
Memory
JTAG / ZDI Signals (5)
WP
WAIT
CTS0/1
Interrupt
Vector
[8:0]
DSR0/1
DCD0/1
8KB
SRAM
UART
Universal
Asynchronous
Receiver/
Transmitter
(2)
DTR0/1
RI0/1
RTS0/1
Chip Select
Interrupt
Controller
&
CS0
Wait State
CS1
Generator
CS2
CS3
DATA[7:0]
RxD0/1
TxD0/1
ADDR[23:0]
WDT
IrDA
Encoder/
Decoder
GPIO
8-bit General
Purpose
I/O Port
(4)
Crystal
Oscillator,
PLL, and
System Clock
Generator
Programmable
Reload
Watchdog
Timer
Internal
RC
Osc.
Timer/Counter
(4)
POR/VBO
OC0/1/2/3
PWM0/1/2/3
PWM0/1/2/3
EC0/1
TOUT0/1
IC0/1/2/3
LOOP_FLT
PHI
PLL_VDD
XIN
XOUT
PD[7:0]
PB[7:0]
PC[7:0]
PA[7:0]
IR_RxD
IR_TxD
RESET
Figure 1. eZ80F91 Block Diagram
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
4
Pin Description
Table 1 details the pin configuration of the eZ80F91 device in the 144-ball BGA
package.
Table 1. eZ80F91 144-Ball BGA Pin Configuration
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
A SDA
SCL
PA0
PA4
PA7
COL
TxD0
VDD
B
VSS
PHI
PA1
PA3
VDD
TxD3
Tx_EN
C PB6
PB7
VDD
PA5
VSS
TxD2
D PB1
PB3
PB5
VSS
CRS
E PC7
VDD
PB0
PB4
F PC3
PC4
PC5
G
2
1
Rx_DV MDC
WPn
A0
VSS
RxD1 MDIO
A2
A1
Tx_CLK
Rx_
CLK
RxD3
A3
VSS
VDD
TxD1
Rx_ER
RxD2
A4
A8
A6
A7
PA2
Tx_ER
RxD0
A5
A11
VSS
VDD
A10
VSS
PB2
PA6
A9
A17
A15
A14
A13
A12
PC0
PC1
PC2
PC6
PLL_
VSS
VSS
A23
A20
VSS
VDD
A16
H XOUT
XIN
PLL_
VDD
VDD
PD7
TMS
VSS
D5
VSS
A21
A19
A18
J
VSS
VDD
LOOP
FILT_
OUT
PD4
TRIGOUT
RTC_
VDD
NMIn
WRn
D2
CS0n
VDD
A22
K PD5
PD6
PD3
TDI
VSS
VDD
RESETn
RDn
VDD
D1
L PD1
PD2 TRSTn
TCK
RTC_
XOUT
BUSACKn
WAITn
MREQn
D6
D4
D0
CS3n
M PD0
VSS
HALT_
SLPn
RTC_
XIN
BUSREQn INSTRDn IORQn
D7
D3
VSS
VDD
VSS
PS019209-0504
TDO
PRELIMINARY
4
3
CS2n CS1n
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
5
VSS
VDD
Tx_ER
Tx_CLK
130 Tx_EN
TxD0
TxD1
TxD2
TxD3
COL
CRS
VSS
VDD
PA7/PWM3
120 PA6/PWM2/EC1
PA5/PWM1/TOUT1
PA4/PWM0/TOUT0
PA3/PWM3/OC3
PA2/PWM2/OC2
PA1/PWM1/OC1
PA0/PWM0/OC0
VSS
VDD
PHI
110 SCL
SDA
1
10
144-Pin LQFP
20
70
60
50
36
40
30
108 VSS
PB7/MOSI
PB6/MISO
PB5/IC3
PB4/IC2
PB3/SCK
PB2/SS
PB1/IC1
100 PB0/IC0/EC0
VSS
VDD
PC7/RI1
PC6/DCD1
PC5/DSR1
PC4/DTR1
PC3/CTS1
PC2/RTS1
PC1/RxD1
90 PC0/TxD1
VSS
VDD
PLL_VDD
XIN
XOUT
PLL_VSS
LOOP_FILT
VSS
VDD
80 PD7/RI0
PD6/DCD0
PD5/DSR0
PD4/DTR0
PD3/CTS0
PD2/RTS0
PD1/RxD0/IR_RxD
73 PD0/TxD0/IR_TxD
VDD
VSS
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
VDD
VSS
IORQ
MREQ
RD
WR
INSTRD
WAIT
RESET
NMI
BUSREQ
BUSACK
VDD
VSS
RTC_XIN
RTC_XOUT
RTC_VDD
VSS
HALT_SLP
TMS
TCK
TRIGOUT
TDI
TDO
TRST
VSS
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
VDD
VSS
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
VDD
VSS
A11
A12
A13
A14
A15
A16
VDD
VSS
A17
A18
A19
A20
A21
A22
A23
VDD
VSS
CS0
CS1
CS2
CS3
144 WP
MDIO
MDC
RxD3
140 RxD2
RxD1
RxD0
Rx_DV
Rx_CLK
Rx_ER
Figure 2 illustrates the pin layout of the eZ80F91 device in the 144-pin LQFP
package.
Figure 2. 144-Pin LQFP Configuration of the eZ80F91
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
6
Pin Characteristics
Table 2 describes the pins and functions of the eZ80F91 MCU’s 144-pin LQFP
package and 144-ball BGA package.
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
1
A1
ADDR0
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
2
B1
ADDR1
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
3
B2
ADDR2
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
4
C3
ADDR3
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
7
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
5
D4
ADDR4
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
6
C1
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
7
C2
VSS
Ground
Ground.
8
E5
ADDR5
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
9
D2
ADDR6
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
10
D1
ADDR7
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
8
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
11
D3
ADDR8
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
12
F6
ADDR9
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
13
E1
ADDR10
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
14
E2
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
15
E3
VSS
Ground
Ground.
16
E4
ADDR11
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
9
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
17
F1
ADDR12
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
18
F2
ADDR13
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
19
F3
ADDR14
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
20
F4
ADDR15
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
10
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
21
G1
ADDR16
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
22
G2
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
23
G3
VSS
Ground
Ground.
24
F5
ADDR17
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
25
H1
ADDR18
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
26
H2
ADDR19
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
11
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
27
G4
ADDR20
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
28
H3
ADDR21
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
29
J1
ADDR22
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
30
G5
ADDR23
Address Bus
Bidirectional
Configured as an output in
normal operation. The address
bus selects a location in memory
or I/O space to be read or written.
Configured as an input during bus
acknowledge cycles. Drives the
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
block to generate Chip Selects.
31
J2
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
32
H4
VSS
Ground
Ground.
33
J3
CS0
Chip Select 0
Output, Active Low
CS0 Low indicates that an access
is occurring in the defined CS0
memory or I/O address space.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
12
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
34
K1
CS1
Chip Select 1
Output, Active Low
CS1 Low indicates that an access
is occurring in the defined CS1
memory or I/O address space.
35
K2
CS2
Chip Select 2
Output, Active Low
CS2 Low indicates that an access
is occurring in the defined CS2
memory or I/O address space.
36
L1
CS3
Chip Select 3
Output, Active Low
CS3 Low indicates that an access
is occurring in the defined CS3
memory or I/O address space.
37
M1
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
38
M2
VSS
Ground
Ground.
39
L2
DATA0
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 is the
bus master.
40
K3
DATA1
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 device
is the bus master.
41
J4
DATA2
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 is the
bus master.
42
M3
DATA3
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 is the
bus master.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
13
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
43
L3
DATA4
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 is the
bus master.
44
H5
DATA5
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 is the
bus master.
45
L4
DATA6
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 is the
bus master.
46
M4
DATA7
Data Bus
Bidirectional
The data bus transfers data to
and from I/O and memory
devices. The eZ80F91 drives
these lines only during Write
cycles when the eZ80F91 is the
bus master.
47
K4
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
48
G6
VSS
Ground
Ground.
49
M5
IORQ
Input/Output
Request
Bidirectional, Active
Low
IORQ indicates that the CPU is
accessing a location in I/O space.
RD and WR indicate the type of
access. The eZ80F91 device
does not drive this line during
RESET. It is an input in bus
acknowledge cycles.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
14
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
50
L5
MREQ
Memory
Request
Bidirectional, Active
Low
MREQ Low indicates that the
CPU is accessing a location in
memory. The RD, WR, and
INSTRD signals indicate the type
of access. The eZ80F91 device
does not drive this line during
RESET. It is an input in bus
acknowledge cycles.
51
K5
RD
Read
Output, Active Low
RD Low indicates that the
eZ80F91 device is reading from
the current address location. This
pin is tristated during bus
acknowledge cycles.
52
J5
WR
Write
Output, Active Low
WR indicates that the CPU is
writing to the current address
location. This pin is tristated
during bus acknowledge cycles.
53
M6
INSTRD
Instruction
Output, Active Low
Read Indicator
INSTRD (with MREQ and RD)
indicates the eZ80F91 device is
fetching an instruction from
memory. This pin is tristated
during bus acknowledge cycles.
54
L6
WAIT
WAIT Request Schmitt-trigger input, Driving the WAIT pin Low forces
Active Low
the CPU to wait additional clock
cycles for an external peripheral
or external memory to complete
its Read or Write operation.
55
K6
RESET
Reset
Schmitt-trigger input, This signal is used to initialize the
Active Low
eZ80F91 device. This input must
be Low for a minimum of 3
system clock cycles, and must be
held Low until the clock is stable.
This input includes a Schmitt
trigger to allow RC rise times.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
15
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
56
J6
NMI
Nonmaskable Schmitt-trigger input, The NMI input is a higher priority
Interrupt
Active Low
input than the maskable
interrupts. It is always recognized
at the end of an instruction,
regardless of the state of the
interrupt enable control bits. This
input includes a Schmitt trigger to
allow RC rise times.
57
M7
BUSREQ
Bus Request
Schmitt-trigger input, External devices can request the
Active Low
eZ80F91 device to release the
memory interface bus for their
use, by driving this pin Low.
58
L7
BUSACK
Bus
Acknowledge
Output, Active Low
59
K7
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
60
H6
VSS
Ground
Ground.
61
M8
RTC_XIN
Real-Time
Clock Crystal
Input
62
L8
RTC_XOUT Real-Time
Clock Crystal
Output
Signal Direction
Description
The eZ80F91 device responds to
a Low on BUSREQ, by tristating
the address, data, and control
signals, and by driving the
BUSACK line Low. During bus
acknowledge cycles ADDR[23:0],
IORQ, and MREQ are inputs.
Input
This pin is the input to the lowpower 32KHz crystal oscillator for
the Real-Time Clock.
Bidirectional
This pin is the output from the
low-power 32KHz crystal
oscillator for the Real-Time Clock.
This pin is an input when the RTC
is configured to operate from 50/
60 Hz input clock signals and the
32 KHz crystal oscillator is
disabled.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
16
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
63
J7
RTC_VDD
Real-Time
Clock Power
Supply
Power supply for the Real-Time
Clock and associated 32KHz
oscillator. Isolated from the power
supply to the remainder of the
chip. A battery can be connected
to this pin to supply constant
power to the Real-Time Clock
and 32KHz oscillator.
64
K8
VSS
Ground
Ground.
65
M9
HALT_SLP HALT and
SLEEP
Indicator
Output, Active Low
A Low on this pin indicates that
the CPU has entered either HALT
or SLEEP mode because of
execution of either a HALT or
SLP instruction.
66
H7
TMS
JTAG Test
Mode Select
Input
JTAG Mode Select Input.
67
L9
TCK
JTAG Test
Clock
Input
JTAG and ZDI clock input.
68
J8
TRIGOUT
JTAG Test
Output
Trigger Output
Active High trigger event
indicator.
69
K9
TDI
JTAG Test
Data In
Bidirectional
JTAG data input pin. Functions
as ZDI data I/O pin when JTAG is
disabled.
70
M10
TDO
JTAG Test
Data Out
Output
JTAG data output pin.
71
L10
TRST
JTAG Reset
Schmitt-trigger input, JTAG reset input pin.
Active Low
72
M11
VSS
Ground
Signal Direction
Description
Ground.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
17
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
73
PD0
GPIO Port D
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
TxD0
UART
Output
Transmit Data
This pin is used by the UART to
transmit asynchronous serial
data. This signal is multiplexed
with PD0.
IR_TxD
IrDA Transmit Output
Data
This pin is used by the IrDA
encoder/decoder to transmit
serial data. This signal is
multiplexed with PD0.
PD1
GPIO Port D
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
RxD0
Receive Data
Input
This pin is used by the UART to
receive asynchronous serial data.
This signal is multiplexed with
PD1.
IR_RxD
IrDA Receive
Data
Input
This pin is used by the IrDA
encoder/decoder to receive serial
data. This signal is multiplexed
with PD1.
74
M12
L12
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
18
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
75
PD2
GPIO Port D
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
RTS0
Request to
Send
Output, Active Low
Modem control signal from
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PD2.
PD3
GPIO Port D
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
CTS0
Clear to Send Input, Active Low
Modem status signal to the
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PD3.
PD4
GPIO Port D
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
DTR0
Data Terminal Output, Active Low
Ready
76
77
L11
K10
J9
Bidirectional
Modem control signal to the
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PD4.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
19
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
78
PD5
GPIO Port D
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
DSR0
Data Set
Ready
Input, Active Low
Modem status signal to the
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PD5.
PD6
GPIO Port D
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
DCD0
Data Carrier
Detect
Input, Active Low
Modem status signal to the
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PD6.
PD7
GPIO Port D
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port D
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
D is multiplexed with one UART.
RI0
Ring Indicator Input, Active Low
Modem status signal to the
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PD7.
79
80
K12
K11
H8
81
J11
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
82
J12
VSS
Ground
Ground.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
20
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
Analog
Loop Filter pin for the Analog
PLL.
83
J10
LOOP_FILT PLL Loop
Filter
84
G7
PLL_VSS
Ground
Ground for Analog PLL.
85
H12
XOUT
System Clock Output
Oscillator
Output
This pin is the output of the
onboard crystal oscillator. When
used, a crystal should be
connected between XIN and
XOUT.
86
H11
XIN
System Clock Input
Oscillator Input
This pin is the input to the
onboard crystal oscillator for the
primary system clock. If an
external oscillator is used, its
clock output should be connected
to this pin. When a crystal is
used, it should be connected
between XIN and XOUT.
87
H10
PLL_VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply for Analog PLL.
88
H9
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
89
G12
VSS
Ground
Ground.
90
G11
PC0
GPIO Port C
TxD1
Transmit Data Output
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
This pin is used by the UART to
transmit asynchronous serial
data. This signal is multiplexed
with PC0.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
21
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
91
PC1
GPIO Port C
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
RxD1
Receive Data
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin is used by the UART to
receive asynchronous serial data.
This signal is multiplexed with
PC1.
PC2
GPIO Port C
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
RTS1
Request to
Send
Output, Active Low
Modem control signal from
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PC2.
PC3
GPIO Port C
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
CTS1
Clear to Send Schmitt-trigger input, Modem status signal to the
Active Low
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PC3.
92
93
G10
G9
F12
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
22
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
94
PC4
GPIO Port C
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
DTR1
Data Terminal Output, Active Low
Ready
Modem control signal to the
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PC4.
PC5
GPIO Port C
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
DSR1
Data Set
Ready
Schmitt-trigger input, Modem status signal to the
Active Low
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PC5.
PC6
GPIO Port C
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
DCD1
Data Carrier
Detect
Schmitt-trigger input, Modem status signal to the
Active Low
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PC6.
95
96
F11
F10
G8
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
23
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
97
PC7
GPIO Port C
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port C
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output. Port
C is multiplexed with one UART.
RI1
Ring Indicator Schmitt-trigger input, Modem status signal to the
Active Low
UART. This signal is multiplexed
with PC7.
E12
98
E11
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
99
F9
VSS
Ground
Ground.
100
E10
PB0
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
IC0
Input Capture
Schmitt-trigger input
Input Capture A Signal to Timer
1. This signal is multiplexed with
PB0.
EC0
Event Counter Schmitt-trigger input
Event Counter Signal to Timer 1.
This signal is multiplexed with
PB0.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
24
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
101
PB1
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
IC1
Input Capture
Schmitt-trigger input
Input Capture B Signal to Timer
1. This signal is multiplexed with
PB1.
PB2
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
SS
SPI Slave
Select
Schmitt-trigger input, The slave select input line is used
Active Low
to select a slave device in SPI
mode. This signal is multiplexed
with PB2.
PB3
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
SCK
SPI Serial
Clock
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
SPI serial clock. This signal is
multiplexed with PB3.
102
103
D12
F8
D11
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
25
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
104
PB4
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
IC2
Input Capture
Schmitt-trigger input
Input Capture A Signal to Timer
3. This signal is multiplexed with
PB4.
PB5
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
IC3
Input Capture
Schmitt-trigger input
Input Capture B Signal to Timer
3. This signal is multiplexed with
PB5.
PB6
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
MISO
SPI Master In
Slave Out
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
The MISO line is configured as an
input when the eZ80F91 device is
an SPI master device and as an
output when eZ80F91 is an SPI
slave device. This signal is
multiplexed with PB6.
105
106
E9
D10
C12
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
26
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
107
PB7
GPIO Port B
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port B
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
MOSI
SPI Master
Out Slave In
Bidirectional with
Schmitt-trigger input
The MOSI line is configured as an
output when the eZ80F91 device
is an SPI master device and as
an input when the eZ80F91
device is an SPI slave device.
This signal is multiplexed with
PB7.
C11
108
B12
VSS
Ground
Ground.
109
A12
SDA
I2C Serial Data Bidirectional
This pin carries the I2C data
signal.
110
A11
SCL
I2C Serial
Clock
This pin is used to receive and
transmit the I2C clock.
111
B11
PHI
System Clock Output
This pin is an output driven by the
internal system clock. It can be
used by the system for
synchronization with the eZ80F91
device.
112
C10
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
113
D9
VSS
Ground
Ground.
Bidirectional
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
27
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
114
PA0
GPIO Port A
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM0
PWM Output 0 Output
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
PWM 0. This signal is multiplexed
with PA0.
OC0
Output
Compare 0
Output
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Output Compare 0. This signal is
multiplexed with PA0.
PA1
GPIO Port A
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM1
PWM Output 1 Output
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
PWM 1. This signal is multiplexed
with PA1.
OC1
Output
Compare 1
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Output Compare 1. This signal is
multiplexed with PA1.
115
A10
B10
Output
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
28
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
116
PA2
GPIO Port A
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM2
PWM Output 2 Output
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
PWM 2. This signal is multiplexed
with PA2.
OC2
Output
Compare 2
Output
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Output Compare 2. This signal is
multiplexed with PA2.
PA3
GPIO Port A
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM3
PWM Output 3 Output
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
PWM 3. This signal is multiplexed
with PA3.
OC3
Output
Compare 3
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Output Compare 3 This signal is
multiplexed with PA3.
117
E8
B9
Output
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
29
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
118
PA4
GPIO Port A
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM0
PWM Output 0 Output
Inverted
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Negative PWM 0. This signal is
multiplexed with PA4.
TOUT0
Timer Out
Output
This pin is used by Timer 0 timerout signal. This signal is
multiplexed with PA4.
PA5
GPIO Port A
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM1
PWM Output 1 Output
Inverted
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Negative PWM 1. This signal is
multiplexed with PA5.
TOUT1
Timer Out
This pin is used by Timer 1 timerout signal. This signal is
multiplexed with PA5.
119
A9
C9
Output
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
30
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
120
PA6
GPIO Port A
Bidirectional
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM2
PWM Output 2 Output
Inverted
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Negative PWM 2. This signal is
multiplexed with PA6.
EC1
Event Counter Input
Event Counter Signal to Timer 2.
This signal is multiplexed with
PA6.
PA7
GPIO Port A
This pin can be used for generalpurpose I/O. It can be individually
programmed as input or output
and can also be used individually
as an interrupt input. Each Port A
pin, when programmed as output,
can be selected to be an opendrain or open-source output.
PWM3
PWM Output 3 Output
Inverted
This pin is used by Timer 3 for
Negative PWM 3. This signal is
multiplexed with PA7.
121
F7
A8
Bidirectional
122
B8
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
123
C8
VSS
Ground
Ground.
124
D8
CRS
MII Carrier
Sense
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY*. Carrier Sense is an
asynchronous signal.
125
A7
COL
MII Collision
Detect
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Collision Detect is an
asynchronous signal.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
31
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
126
B7
TxD3
MII Transmit
Data
Output
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Transmit Data is
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Tx_CLK.
127
C7
TxD2
MII Transmit
Data
Output
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Transmit Data is
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Tx_CLK.
128
D7
TxD1
MII Transmit
Data
Output
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Transmit Data is
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Tx_CLK.
129
A6
TxD0
MII Transmit
Data
Output
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Transmit Data is
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Tx_CLK.
130
B6
Tx_EN
MII Transmit
Enable
Output
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Transmit Enable is
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Tx_CLK.
131
C6
Tx_CLK
MII Transmit
Clock
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Transmit Clock is the
Nibble or Symbol Clock provided
by the MII PHY Interface.
132
E7
Tx_ER
MII Transmit
Error
Output
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Transmit Error is
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Tx_CLK.
133
A5
VDD
Power Supply
Power Supply.
134
B5
VSS
Ground
Ground.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
32
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
135
D6
Rx_ER
MII Receive
Error
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Receive Error is provided
by the MII PHY Interface
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Rx_CLK.
136
C5
Rx_CLK
MII Receive
Clock
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Receive Clock is the Nibble
or Symbol Clock provided by the
MII PHY Interface.
137
A4
Rx_DV
MII Receive
Data Valid
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Receive Data Valid is
provided by the MII PHY Interface
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Rx_CLK.
138
E6
RxD0
MII Receive
Data
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Receive Data is provided
by the MII PHY Interface
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Rx_CLK.
139
B4
RxD1
MII Receive
Data
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Receive Data is provided
by the MII PHY Interface
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Rx_CLK.
140
D5
RxD2
MII Receive
Data
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Receive Data is provided
by the MII PHY Interface
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Rx_CLK.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
33
Table 2. Pin Identification on the eZ80F91 Device (Continued)
LQFP BGA
Pin # Pin#
Symbol
Function
Signal Direction
Description
141
C4
RxD3
MII Receive
Data
Input
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Interface to the
PHY. Receive Data is provided
by the MII PHY Interface
synchronous to the rising-edge of
Rx_CLK.
142
A3
MDC
MII
Management
Data Clock
Output
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Management
Interface to the PHY. The
Ethernet MAC provides the MII
Management Data Clock to the
MII PHY Interface.
143
B3
MDIO
MII
Management
Data
Bidirectional
This pin is used by the Ethernet
MAC for the MII Management
Interface to the PHY. The
Ethernet MAC sends and
receives the MII Management
Data to and from the MII PHY
Interface.
144
A2
WP
Write Protect
Schmitt-trigger input, The Write Protect input is used by
Active Low
the Flash Controller to protect the
Boot Block from Write and
ERASE operations.
Note: *PHY represents the physical layer of the OSI model.
System Clock Source Options
System Clock. The eZ80F91 device’s internal clock, SCLK, is responsible for
clocking all internal logic. The SCLK source can be an external crystal oscillator,
an internal PLL, or an internal 32 kHz RTC oscillator. The SCLK source is selected
by PLL Control Register 0. RESET default is provided by the external crystal oscillator. Refer to the CLK_MUX values in the PLL Control Register 0, Table 207 on
page 325 for details.
PHI. PHI is a device output driven by SCLK that can be used for system synchro-
nization to the eZ80F91 device. PHI is used as the reference clock for all AC
Characteristics.
External Crystal Oscillator. An externally-driven oscillator that can operate in two
modes. In one mode, the XIN pin can be driven by a can oscillator from DC up to
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
34
50 Mhz while the XOUT pin is unconnected. In the other mode, the XIN and XOUT
pins can be driven by a crystal circuit.
Crystals recommended by ZiLOG are defined to be a 50 Mhz–3 overtone circuit or
1–10 MHz range fundamental for PLL operation. For details, refer to the On-Chip
Oscillators section on page 342.
Real Time Clock. An internal 32 KHz real-time clock crystal oscillator driven by
either the on-chip 32768 Hz crystal oscillator or a 50/60 Hz power-line frequency
input. While intended for timekeeping, the RTC 32 KHz oscillator can be selected
as an SCLK. RTC_VDD and RTC_VSS provide an isolated power supply to ensure
RTC operation in the event of loss of line power when a battery is provided. For
details, refer to the On-Chip Oscillators section on page 342.
PLL Clock. The eZ80F91 internal PLL driven by external crystals or can oscillators
in the 1 MHz to 10 MHz range to generate an SCLK up to 50 MHz. For details, refer
to the Phase-Locked Loop section on page 320.
SCLK Source Selection Example
If an application must run the eZ80F91 device at 40 MHz, the following solutions
are possible:
PS019209-0504
•
Use a 40 MHz–3rd overtone crystal (not recommended due to its weak fundamental rating)
•
•
Use a 40 MHz can oscillator (expensive)
Use an 8 MHz fundamental two-pin crystal and program the internal PLL with
a multiplier of five to achieve 40 MHz (inexpensive).
PRELIMINARY
Architectural Overview
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
35
Register Map
All on-chip peripheral registers are accessed in the I/O address space. All I/O
operations employ 16-bit addresses. The upper byte of the 24-bit address bus is
undefined during all I/O operations (ADDR[23:16] = UU). All I/O operations using
16-bit addresses within the range 0000h–00FFh are routed to the on-chip peripherals. External I/O Chip Selects are not generated if the address space programmed for the I/O Chip Selects overlaps the 0000h–00FFh address range.
Registers at unused addresses within the 0000h–00FFh range assigned to onchip peripherals are not implemented. Read access to such addresses returns
unpredictable values and Write access produces no effect. Table 3 diagrams the
register map for the eZ80F91 device.
Table 3. Register Map
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Product ID
0000
ZDI_ID_L
eZ80 Product ID Low Byte Register
08
R
305
0001
ZDI_ID_H
eZ80 Product ID High Byte Register
00
R
306
0002
ZDI_ID_REV
eZ80 Product ID Revision Register
XX
R
306
Interrupt Priority
0010
INT_P0
Interrupt Priority Register—Byte 0
00
R/W
69
0011
INT_P1
Interrupt Priority Register—Byte 1
00
R/W
69
0012
INT_P2
Interrupt Priority Register—Byte 2
00
R/W
69
0013
INT_P3
Interrupt Priority Register—Byte 3
00
R/W
69
0014
INT_P4
Interrupt Priority Register—Byte 4
00
R/W
69
0015
INT_P5
Interrupt Priority Register—Byte 5
00
R/W
69
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
36
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Ethernet Media Access Controller
0020
EMAC_TEST
EMAC Test Register
00
R/W
249
0021
EMAC_CFG1
EMAC Configuration Register
00
R/W
251
0022
EMAC_CFG2
EMAC Configuration Register
37
R/W
253
0023
EMAC_CFG3
EMAC Configuration Register
0F
R/W
254
0024
EMAC_CFG4
EMAC Configuration Register
00
R/W
255
0025
EMAC_STAD_0
EMAC Station Address—Byte 0
00
R/W
256
0026
EMAC_STAD_1
EMAC Station Address—Byte 1
00
R/W
256
0027
EMAC_STAD_2
EMAC Station Address—Byte 2
00
R/W
256
0028
EMAC_STAD_3
EMAC Station Address—Byte 3
00
R/W
256
0029
EMAC_STAD_4
EMAC Station Address—Byte 4
00
R/W
256
002A
EMAC_STAD_5
EMAC Station Address—Byte 5
00
R/W
256
002B
EMAC_TPTV_L
EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value—
Low Byte
00
R/W
257
002C
EMAC_TPTV_H
EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value—
High Byte
00
R/W
257
002D
EMAC_IPGT
EMAC Inter-Packet Gap
15
R/W
258
002E
EMAC_IPGR1
EMAC Non-Back-Back IPG
0C
R/W
260
002F
EMAC_IPGR2
EMAC Non-Back-Back IPG
12
R/W
261
0030
EMAC_MAXF_L
EMAC Maximum Frame Length—Low
Byte
00
R/W
261
0031
EMAC_MAXF_H
EMAC Maximum Frame Length—High
Byte
06
R/W
262
0032
EMAC_AFR
EMAC Address Filter Register
00
R/W
263
0033
EMAC_HTBL_0
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 0
00
R/W
264
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
37
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Ethernet Media Access Controller, continued
0034
EMAC_HTBL_1
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 1
00
R/W
264
0035
EMAC_HTBL_2
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 2
00
R/W
264
0036
EMAC_HTBL_3
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 3
00
R/W
264
0037
EMAC_HTBL_4
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 4
00
R/W
264
0038
EMAC_HTBL_5
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 5
00
R/W
264
0039
EMAC_HTBL_6
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 6
00
R/W
264
003A
EMAC_HTBL_7
EMAC Hash Table—Byte 7
00
R/W
264
003B
EMAC_MIIMGT
EMAC MII Management Register
00
R/W
265
003C
EMAC_CTLD_L
EMAC PHY Configuration Data—Low
Byte
00
R/W
266
003D
EMAC_CTLD_H
EMAC PHY Configuration Data—High
Byte
00
R/W
267
003E
EMAC_RGAD
EMAC PHY Register Address Register
00
R/W
267
003F
EMAC_FIAD
EMAC PHY Unit Select Address
Register
00
R/W
268
0040
EMAC_PTMR
EMAC Transmit Polling Timer Register
00
R/W
268
0041
EMAC_RST
EMAC Reset Control Register
00
R/W
269
0042
EMAC_TLBP_L
EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary
Pointer—Low Byte
00
R/W
270
0043
EMAC_TLBP_H
EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary
Pointer—High Byte
00
R/W
270
0044
EMAC_BP_L
EMAC Boundary Pointer—Low Byte
00
R/W
271
0045
EMAC_BP_H
EMAC Boundary Pointer—High Byte
C0
R/W
271
0046
EMAC_BP_U
EMAC Boundary Pointer—Upper Byte
FF
R/W
272
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
38
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Ethernet Media Access Controller, continued
0047
EMAC_RHBP_L
EMAC Receive High Boundary
Pointer—Low Byte
00
R/W
272
0048
EMAC_RHBP_H
EMAC Receive High Boundary
Pointer—High Byte
00
R/W
273
0049
EMAC_RRP_L
EMAC Receive Read Pointer—Low
Byte
00
R/W
273
004A
EMAC_RRP_H
EMAC Receive Read Pointer—High
Byte
00
R/W
274
004B
EMAC_BUFSZ
EMAC Buffer Size Register
00
R/W
274
004C
EMAC_IEN
EMAC Interrupt Enable Register
00
R/W
275
004D
EMAC_ISTAT
EMAC Interrupt Status Register
00
R/W
277
004E
EMAC_PRSD_L
EMAC PHY Read Status Data—Low
Byte
00
R/W
278
004F
EMAC_PRSD_H
EMAC PHY Read Status Data—High
Byte
00
R/W
279
0050
EMAC_MIISTAT
EMAC MII Status Register
00
R/W
279
0051
EMAC_RWP_L
EMAC Receive Write Pointer—Low
Byte
00
R/W
280
0052
EMAC_RWP_H
EMAC Receive Write Pointer—High
Byte
00
R/W
281
0053
EMAC_TRP_L
EMAC Transmit Read Pointer—Low
Byte
00
R/W
281
0054
EMAC_TRP_H
EMAC Transmit Read Pointer—High
Byte
00
R/W
282
0055
EMAC_BLKSLFT_L
EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—
Low Byte
00
R/W
282
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
39
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Ethernet Media Access Controller, continued
0056
EMAC_BLKSLFT_H EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—
High Byte
00
R/W
283
0057
EMAC_FDATA_L
EMAC FIFO Data—Low Byte
0X
R/W
284
0058
EMAC_FDATA_H
EMAC FIFO Data—High Byte
XX
R/W
284
0059
EMAC_FFLAGS
EMAC FIFO Flags Register
33
R/W
285
005C
PLL_DIV_L
PLL Divider Register—Low Byte
00
W
324
005D
PLL_DIV_H
PLL Divider Register—High Byte
00
W
324
005E
PLL_CTL0
PLL Control Register 0
00
R/W
325
005F
PLL_CTL1
PLL Control Register 1
00
R/W
326
PLL
Timers and PWM
0060
TMR0_CTL
Timer 0 Control Register
00
R/W
138
0061
TMR0_IER
Timer 0 Interrupt Enable Register
00
R/W
139
0062
TMR0_IIR
Timer 0 Interrupt Identification Register
00
R/W
141
0063
TMR0_DR_L
Timer 0 Data Register—Low Byte
XX
R
142
TMR0_RR_L
Timer 0 Reload Register—Low Byte
XX
W
143
TMR0_DR_H
Timer 0 Data Register—High Byte
XX
R
143
TMR0_RR_H
Timer 0 Reload Register—High Byte
XX
W
144
0065
TMR1_CTL
Timer 1 Control Register
00
R/W
138
0066
TMR1_IER
Timer 1 Interrupt Enable Register
00
R/W
139
0067
TMR1_IIR
Timer 1 Interrupt Identification Register
00
R/W
141
0068
TMR1_DR_L
Timer 1 Data Register—Low Byte
XX
R
142
TMR1_RR_L
Timer 1 Reload Register—Low Byte
XX
W
143
0064
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
40
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Timers and PWM, continued
0069
TMR1_DR_H
Timer 1 Data Register—High Byte
XX
R
143
TMR1_RR_H
Timer 1 Reload Register—High Byte
XX
W
144
006A
TMR1_CAP_CTL
Timer 1 Input Capture Control Register
XX
R/W
144
006B
TMR1_CAPA_L
Timer 1 Capture Value A Register—
Low Byte
XX
R/W
145
006C
TMR1_CAPA_H
Timer 1 Capture Value A Register—
High Byte
XX
R/W
146
006D
TMR1_CAPB_L
Timer 1 Capture Value B Register—
Low Byte
XX
R/W
146
006E
TMR1_CAPB_H
Timer 1 Capture Value B Register—
High Byte
XX
R/W
147
006F
TMR2_CTL
Timer 2 Control Register
00
R/W
138
0070
TMR2_IER
Timer 2 Interrupt Enable Register
00
R/W
139
0071
TMR2_IIR
Timer 2 Interrupt Identification Register
00
R/W
141
0072
TMR2_DR_L
Timer 2 Data Register—Low Byte
XX
R
142
TMR2_RR_L
Timer 2 Reload Register—Low Byte
XX
W
143
TMR2_DR_H
Timer 2 Data Register—High Byte
XX
R
143
TMR2_RR_H
Timer 2 Reload Register—High Byte
XX
W
144
0074
TMR3_CTL
Timer 3 Control Register
00
R/W
138
0075
TMR3_IER
Timer 3 Interrupt Enable Register
00
R/W
139
0076
TMR3_IIR
Timer 3 Interrupt Identification Register
00
R/W
141
0077
TMR3_DR_L
Timer 3 Data Register—Low Byte
XX
R
142
TMR3_RR_L
Timer 3 Reload Register—Low Byte
XX
W
143
0073
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
41
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Timers and PWM, continued
0078
TMR3_DR_H
Timer 3 Data Register—High Byte
XX
R
143
TMR3_RR_H
Timer 3 Reload Register—High Byte
XX
W
144
0079
PWM_CTL1
PWM Control Register 1
00
R/W
158
007A
PWM_CTL2
PWM Control Register 2
00
R/W
159
007B
PWM_CTL3
PWM Control Register 3
00
R/W
161
TMR3_CAP_CTL
Timer 3 Input Capture Control Register
00
R/W
144
PWM0R_L
PWM 0 Rising-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
162
TMR3_CAPA_L
Timer 3 Capture Value A Register—
Low Byte
XX
R/W
145
PWM0R_H
PWM 0 Rising-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
163
TMR3_CAPA_H
Timer 3 Capture Value A Register—
High Byte
XX
R/W
146
PWM1R_L
PWM 1 Rising-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
162
TMR3_CAPB_L
Timer 3 Capture Value B Register—
Low Byte
XX
R/W
146
PWM1R_H
PWM 1 Rising-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
163
TMR3_CAPB_H
Timer 3 Capture Value B Register—
High Byte
XX
R/W
147
PWM2R_L
PWM 2 Rising-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
162
TMR3_OC_CTL1
Timer 3 Output Compare Control
Register 1
00
R/W
138
007C
007D
007E
007F
0080
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
42
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Timers and PWM, continued
0081
0082
0083
0084
0085
0086
PWM2R_H
PWM 2 Rising-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
163
TMR3_OC_CTL2
Timer 3 Output Compare Control
Register 2
00
R/W
138
PWM3R_L
PWM 3 Rising-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
162
TMR3_OC0_L
Timer 3 Output Compare 0 Value
Register—Low Byte
XX
R/W
149
PWM3R_H
PWM 3 Rising-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
163
TMR3_OC0_H
Timer 3 Output Compare 0 Value
Register—High Byte
XX
R/W
150
PWM0F_L
PWM 0 Falling-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
164
TMR3_OC1_L
Timer 3 Output Compare 1 Value
Register—Low Byte
XX
R/W
149
PWM0F_H
PWM 0 Falling-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
165
TMR3_OC1_H
Timer 3 Output Compare 1 Value
Register—High Byte
XX
R/W
150
PWM1F_L
PWM 1 Falling-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
164
TMR3_OC2_L
Timer 3 Output Compare 2 Value
Register—Low Byte
XX
R/W
149
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
43
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Timers and PWM, continued
0087
PWM1F_H
PWM 1 Falling-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
165
TMR3_OC2_H
Timer 3 Output Compare 2 Value
Register—High Byte
XX
R/W
150
PWM2F_L
PWM 2 Falling-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
164
TMR3_OC3_L
Timer 3 Output Compare 3 Value
Register—Low Byte
XX
R/W
149
PWM2F_H
PWM 2 Falling-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
165
TMR3_OC3_H
Timer 3 Output Compare 3 Value
Register—High Byte
XX
R/W
150
008A
PWM3F_L
PWM 3 Falling-Edge Register—Low
Byte
XX
R/W
164
008B
PWM3F_H
PWM 3 Falling-Edge Register—High
Byte
XX
R/W
165
00/201
R/W
124
XX
W
126
0088
0089
Watch-Dog Timer
0093
WDT_CTL
Watch-Dog Timer Control Register
0094
WDT_RR
Watch-Dog Timer Reset Register
General-Purpose Input/Output Ports
0096
PA_DR
Port A Data Register
XX
R/W2
63
0097
PA_DDR
Port A Data Direction Register
FF
R/W
63
0098
PA_ALT1
Port A Alternate Register 1
00
R/W
63
0099
PA_ALT2
Port A Alternate Register 2
00
R/W
64
009A
PB_DR
Port B Data Register
XX
R/W2
63
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
44
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
General-Purpose Input/Output Ports, continued
009B
PB_DDR
Port B Data Direction Register
FF
R/W
63
009C
PB_ALT1
Port B Alternate Register 1
00
R/W
63
009D
PB_ALT2
Port B Alternate Register 2
00
R/W
64
63
009E
PC_DR
Port C Data Register
XX
R/W2
009F
PC_DDR
Port C Data Direction Register
FF
R/W
63
00A0
PC_ALT1
Port C Alternate Register 1
00
R/W
63
00A1
PC_ALT2
Port C Alternate Register 2
00
R/W
64
63
00A2
PD_DR
Port D Data Register
XX
R/W2
00A3
PD_DDR
Port D Data Direction Register
FF
R/W
63
00A4
PD_ALT1
Port D Alternate Register 1
00
R/W
63
00A5
PD_ALT2
Port D Alternate Register 2
00
R/W
64
Chip Select/Wait State Generator
00A8
CS0_LBR
Chip Select 0 Lower Bound Register
00
R/W
93
00A9
CS0_UBR
Chip Select 0 Upper Bound Register
FF
R/W
94
00AA
CS0_CTL
Chip Select 0 Control Register
E8
R/W
95
00AB
CS1_LBR
Chip Select 1 Lower Bound Register
00
R/W
93
00AC
CS1_UBR
Chip Select 1 Upper Bound Register
00
R/W
94
00AD
CS1_CTL
Chip Select 1 Control Register
00
R/W
95
00AE
CS2_LBR
Chip Select 2 Lower Bound Register
00
R/W
93
00AF
CS2_UBR
Chip Select 2 Upper Bound Register
00
R/W
94
00B0
CS2_CTL
Chip Select 2 Control Register
00
R/W
95
00B1
CS3_LBR
Chip Select 3 Lower Bound Register
00
R/W
93
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
45
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Chip Select/Wait State Generator, continued
00B2
CS3_UBR
Chip Select 3 Upper Bound Register
00
R/W
94
00B3
CS3_CTL
Chip Select 3 Control Register
00
R/W
95
Random Access Memory Control
00B4
RAM_CTL
RAM Control Register
80
R/W
102
00B5
RAM_ADDR_U
RAM Address Upper Byte Register
FF
R/W
103
00B6
MBIST_GPR
General Purpose RAM MBIST Control
00
R/W
104
00B7
MBIST_EMR
Ethernet MAC RAM MBIST Control
00
R/W
104
Serial Peripheral Interface
00B8
SPI_BRG_L
SPI Baud Rate Generator Register—
Low Byte
02
R/W
215
00B9
SPI_BRG_H
SPI Baud Rate Generator Register—
High Byte
00
R/W
215
00BA
SPI_CTL
SPI Control Register
04
R/W
216
00BB
SPI_SR
SPI Status Register
00
R
217
00BC
SPI_TSR
SPI Transmit Shift Register
XX
W
218
SPI_RBR
SPI Receive Buffer Register
XX
R
218
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Control
00
R/W
207
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
00BF
IR_CTL
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 0 (UART0)
00C0
UART0_RBR
UART 0 Receive Buffer Register
XX
R
192
UART0_THR
UART 0 Transmit Holding Register
XX
W
191
UART0_BRG_L
UART 0 Baud Rate Generator
Register—Low Byte
02
R/W
190
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
46
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 0 (UART0), continued
00C1
UART0_IER
UART 0 Interrupt Enable Register
00
R/W
192
UART0_BRG_H
UART 0 Baud Rate Generator
Register—High Byte
00
R/W
190
UART0_IIR
UART 0 Interrupt Identification
Register
01
R
193
UART0_FCTL
UART 0 FIFO Control Register
00
W
195
00C3
UART0_LCTL
UART 0 Line Control Register
00
R/W
196
00C4
UART0_MCTL
UART 0 Modem Control Register
00
R/W
198
00C5
UART0_LSR
UART 0 Line Status Register
60
R
200
00C6
UART0_MSR
UART 0 Modem Status Register
XX
R
202
00C7
UART0_SPR
UART 0 Scratch Pad Register
00
R/W
203
00C8
I2C_SAR
I2C Slave Address Register
00
R/W
232
00C9
I2C_XSAR
I2C Extended Slave Address Register
00
R/W
233
00CA
I2C_DR
I2C Data Register
00
R/W
233
00CB
I2C_CTL
I2C Control Register
00
R/W
235
I2C_SR
I2C Status Register
F8
R
236
I2C_CCR
I2C Clock Control Register
00
W
238
I2C_SRR
I2C Software Reset Register
XX
W
239
00C2
I2C
00CC
00CD
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
47
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 1 (UART1)
00D0
UART1_RBR
UART 1 Receive Buffer Register
XX
R
192
UART1_THR
UART 1 Transmit Holding Register
XX
W
191
UART1_BRG_L
UART 1 Baud Rate Generator
Register—Low Byte
02
R/W
190
UART1_IER
UART 1 Interrupt Enable Register
00
R/W
192
UART1_BRG_H
UART 1 Baud Rate Generator
Register—High Byte
00
R/W
190
UART1_IIR
UART 1 Interrupt Identification
Register
01
R
193
UART1_FCTL
UART 1 FIFO Control Register
00
W
195
00D3
UART1_LCTL
UART 1 Line Control Register
00
R/W
196
00D4
UART1_MCTL
UART 1 Modem Control Register
00
R/W
198
00D5
UART1_LSR
UART 1 Line Status Register
60
R/W
200
00D6
UART1_MSR
UART 1 Modem Status Register
XX
R/W
202
00D7
UART1_SPR
UART 1 Scratch Pad Register
00
R/W
203
00D1
00D2
Low-Power Control
00DB
CLK_PPD1
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Register
1
00
R/W
56
00DC
CLK_PPD2
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Register
2
00
R/W
57
Real-Time Clock
00E0
RTC_SEC
RTC Seconds Register
XX
R/W3
168
00E1
RTC_MIN
RTC Minutes Register
XX
R/W3
169
XX
R/W3
170
00E2
RTC_HRS
RTC Hours Register
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
48
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
0X
R/W3
171
172
Real-Time Clock, continued
00E3
RTC_DOW
RTC Day-of-the-Week Register
00E4
RTC_DOM
RTC Day-of-the-Month Register
XX
R/W3
00E5
RTC_MON
RTC Month Register
XX
R/W3
173
174
00E6
RTC_YR
RTC Year Register
XX
R/W3
00E7
RTC_CEN
RTC Century Register
XX
R/W3
175
00E8
RTC_ASEC
RTC Alarm Seconds Register
XX
R/W
176
00E9
RTC_AMIN
RTC Alarm Minutes Register
XX
R/W
177
00EA
RTC_AHRS
RTC Alarm Hours Register
XX
R/W
178
00EB
RTC_ADOW
RTC Alarm Day-of-the-Week Register
0X
R/W
179
00EC
RTC_ACTRL
RTC Alarm Control Register
00
R/W
180
00ED
RTC_CTRL
RTC Control Register
x0xxxx00
b/
x0xxxx10
b4
R/W
181
Chip Select Bus Mode Control
00F0
CS0_BMC
Chip Select 0 Bus Mode Control
Register
02
R/W
96
00F1
CS1_BMC
Chip Select 1 Bus Mode Control
Register
02
R/W
96
00F2
CS2_BMC
Chip Select 2 Bus Mode Control
Register
02
R/W
96
00F3
CS3_BMC
Chip Select 3 Bus Mode Control
Register
02
R/W
96
Flash Key Register
00
W
110
Flash Memory Control
00F5
FLASH_KEY
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
49
Table 3. Register Map (Continued)
Address
(hex)
Mnemonic
Name
Reset
(hex)
CPU
Access
Page
#
Flash Memory Control, continued
00F6
FLASH_DATA
Flash Data Register
XX
R/W
111
00F7
FLASH_ADDR_U
Flash Address Upper Byte Register
00
R/W
112
00F8
FLASH_CTL
Flash Control Register
88
R/W
113
114
00F9
FLASH_FDIV
Flash Frequency Divider Register
01
R/W5
00FA
FLASH_PROT
Flash Write/Erase Protection Register
FF
R/W5
115
00FB
FLASH_IRQ
Flash Interrupt Control Register
00
R/W
116
00FC
FLASH_PAGE
Flash Page Select Register
00
R/W
118
00FD
FLASH_ROW
Flash Row Select Register
00
R/W
119
00FE
FLASH_COL
Flash Column Select Register
00
R/W
120
00FF
FLASH_PGCTL
Flash Program Control Register
00
R/W
120
Notes:
1. After an external pin reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 00h. After a Watch-Dog Timer timeout reset, the Watch-Dog Timer Control register is reset to 20h.
2. When the CPU reads this register, the current sampled value of the port is read.
3. Read Only if RTC is locked; Read/Write if RTC is unlocked.
4. After an external pin reset or a Watch-Dog Timer reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx00b. After a
an RTC Alarm sleep-mode recovery reset, the RTC Control register is reset to x0xxxx10b.
5. Read Only if Flash Memory is locked. Read/Write if Flash Memory is unlocked.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Register Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
50
eZ80® CPU Core
The eZ80® CPU is the first 8-bit CPU to support 16 MB linear addressing. Each
software module or task under a real-time executive or operating system can
operate in Z80-compatible (64 KB) mode or full 24-bit (16 MB) address mode.
The CPU instruction set is a superset of the instruction sets for the Z80™ and
Z180™ CPUs. Z80 and Z180 programs can be executed on an eZ80® CPU with
little or no modification.
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Code-compatible with Z80 and Z180 products
24-bit linear address space
Single-cycle instruction fetch
Pipelined fetch, decode, and execute
Dual Stack Pointers for ADL (24-bit) and Z80 (16-bit) memory modes
24-bit CPU registers and ALU (Arithmetic Logic Unit)
Debug support
Nonmaskable Interrupt (NMI), plus support for 128 maskable vectored interrupts
New Instructions
•
Loads/unloads the I register with a 16-bit value. These new instructions are:
– LD I,HL (ED C7)
– LD HL,I (ED D7)
For more information on the CPU, its instruction set, and eZ80 programming,
please refer to the eZ80 CPU User Manual (UM0077), available on zilog.com.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
eZ80® CPU Core
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
51
Reset
Reset Operation
The Reset controller within the eZ80F91 device features a consistent reset function for all types of resets that can affect the system. A system reset, referred to in
this document as RESET, returns the eZ80F91 to a defined state. All internal registers affected by a RESET return to their default conditions. RESET configures
the GPIO port pins as inputs and clears the CPU’s Program Counter to 000000h.
Program code execution ceases during RESET.
The events that can cause a RESET are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Power-On Reset (POR)
Low-voltage brown-out (VBO)
External RESET pin assertion
Watch-Dog Timer (WDT) time-out when configured to generate a RESET
Real-Time Clock alarm with the CPU in low-power SLEEP mode
Execution of a Debug RESET command
During RESET, an internal RESET mode timer holds the system in RESET for
1025 system clock (SCLK) cycles to allow sufficient time for the primary crystal
oscillator to stabilize. For internal RESET sources, the RESET mode timer begins
incrementing on the next rising edge of SCLK following deactivation of the signal
that is initiating the RESET event. For external RESET pin assertion, the RESET
mode timer begins on the next rising edge of SCLK following assertion of the
RESET pin for three consecutive SCLK cycles.
Note:
The default clock source for SCLK on RESET is the crystal input (XIN). Refer to
the CLK_MUX values in the PLL Control Register 0, Table 207 on page 325.
External Reset Input and Indicator
The eZ80F91 RESET pin functions as both an open-drain (active Low) RESET
mode indicator and as an active Low RESET input. When a RESET event occurs,
the internal circuitry begins driving the RESET pin Low. The RESET pin is held
Low by the internal circuitry until the internal RESET mode timer times out. If the
external reset signal is released prior to the end of the 1025-count time-out, program execution begins following the RESET mode time-out. If the external reset
signal is released after the end of the 1025 count time-out, then program execution begins following release of the RESET input (the RESET pin is High for four
consecutive SCLK cycles).
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Reset
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
52
Power-On Reset
A Power-On Reset (POR) occurs each time the supply voltage to the part rises
from below the voltage brown-out threshold (VVBO) to above the POR voltage
threshold (VPOR). The internal bandgap-referenced voltage detector sends a continuous RESET signal to the Reset controller until the supply voltage (VCC)
exceeds the POR voltage threshold. After VCC rises above VPOR, an on-chip analog delay element briefly maintains the RESET signal to the Reset controller. After
this analog delay element times out, the Reset controller holds the eZ80F91 in
RESET until the RESET mode timer expires. POR operation is illustrated in
Figure 3. The signals in Figure 3 are not drawn to scale, but are for illustration purposes only.
VCC = 3.3V
VPOR
VVBO
Program Execution
VCC = 0.0V
System Clock
Oscillator
Startup
Internal RESET
Signal
T ANA
RESET mode timer delay
Figure 3. Power-On Reset Operation
Voltage Brown-Out Reset
If, after program execution begins, the supply voltage (VCC) drops below the voltage brown-out threshold (VVBO), the eZ80F91 device resets. The VBO protection
circuitry detects the low supply voltage and initiates a RESET via the Reset controller. The eZ80F91 remains in RESET until the supply voltage again returns
above the POR voltage threshold (VPOR) and the Reset controller releases the
internal RESET signal. The VBO circuitry rejects very short negative brown-out
pulses to prevent spurious RESET events.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Reset
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
53
VBO operation is illustrated in Figure 4. The signals in the figure are not drawn to
scale, and are for illustration purposes only.
VCC = 3.3V
VPOR
VVBO
Program Execution
VCC = 3.3V
Voltage
Brown-out
Program Execution
System Clock
Internal RESET
Signal
TANA
RESET mode
timer delay
Figure 4. Voltage Brown-Out Reset Operation
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Reset
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
54
Low Power Modes
Overview
The eZ80F91 device provides a range of power-saving features. The highest level
of power reduction is provided by SLEEP mode. The next level of power reduction
is provided by the HALT instruction. The most basic level of power reduction is
provided by the clock peripheral power-down registers.
SLEEP Mode
Execution of the CPU’s SLP instruction places the eZ80F91 device into SLEEP
mode. In SLEEP mode, the operating characteristics are:
•
•
•
•
•
The primary crystal oscillator is disabled
The system clock is disabled
The CPU is idle
The Program Counter (PC) stops incrementing
The 32 KHz crystal oscillator continues to operate and drive the Real-Time
Clock and the Watch-Dog Timer (if WDT is configured to operate from the
32 KHz oscillator)
The CPU can be brought out of SLEEP mode by any of the following operations:
•
•
•
A RESET via the external RESET pin driven Low
•
A RESET via execution of a Debug RESET command
A RESET via a Real-Time Clock alarm
A RESET via a Watch-Dog Timer time-out (if running off of the 32 KHz oscillator and configured to generate a RESET upon time-out)
After exiting SLEEP mode, the standard RESET delay occurs to allow the primary
crystal oscillator to stabilize. Refer to the Reset section on page 51 for more information.
HALT Mode
Execution of the CPU’s HALT instruction places the eZ80F91 device into HALT
mode. In HALT mode, the operating characteristics are:
•
PS019209-0504
The primary crystal oscillator is enabled and continues to operate
PRELIMINARY
Low Power Modes
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
55
•
•
•
The system clock is enabled and continues to operate
The CPU is idle
The Program Counter (PC) stops incrementing
The CPU can be brought out of HALT mode by any of the following operations:
•
•
•
•
A nonmaskable interrupt (NMI)
•
A RESET via execution of a Debug RESET command
A maskable interrupt
A RESET via the external RESET pin driven Low
A Watch-Dog Timer time-out (if configured to generate either an NMI or
RESET upon time-out)
To minimize current in HALT mode, the system clock should be gated off for all
unused on-chip peripherals via the Clock Peripheral Power-Down Registers.
HALT Mode and the EMAC Function
When the CPU is in HALT mode, the eZ80F91 device’s EMAC block cannot be
disabled as can other peripherals. Upon receipt of an Ethernet packet, a
maskable Receive interrupt is generated by the EMAC block, just as it would be in
a non-halt mode. Accordingly, the processor wakes up and continues with the
user-defined application.
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Registers
To reduce power, the Clock Peripheral Power-Down Registers allow the system
clock to be blocked to unused on-chip peripherals. Upon RESET, all peripherals
are enabled. The clock to unused peripherals can be gated off by setting the
appropriate bit in the Clock Peripheral Power-Down Registers to 1. When powered down, the peripherals are completely disabled. To reenable, the bit in the
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Registers must be cleared to 0.
Many peripherals feature separate enable/disable control bits that must be appropriately set for operation. These peripheral specific enable/disable bits do not provide the same level of power reduction as the Clock Peripheral Power-Down
Registers. When powered down, the individual peripheral control register is not
accessible for Read or Write acess. See Tables 4 and 5.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Low Power Modes
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
56
Table 4. Clock Peripheral Power-Down Register 1
(CLK_PPD1 = 00DBh)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R/W
6
0
R/W
5
0
R/W
4
0
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
7
GPIO_D_OFF
1
System clock to GPIO Port D is powered down.
Port D alternate functions do not operate correctly.
0
System clock to GPIO Port D is powered up.
1
System clock to GPIO Port C is powered down.
Port C alternate functions do not operate correctly.
0
System clock to GPIO Port C is powered up.
1
System clock to GPIO Port B is powered down.
Port B alternate functions do not operate correctly.
0
System clock to GPIO Port B is powered up.
1
System clock to GPIO Port A is powered down.
Port A alternate functions do not operate correctly.
0
System clock to GPIO Port A is powered up.
3
SPI_OFF
1
System clock to SPI is powered down.
0
System clock to SPI is powered up.
2
I2C_OFF
1
System clock to I2C is powered down.
0
System clock to I2C is powered up.
1
UART1_OFF
1
System clock to UART1 is powered down.
0
System clock to UART1 is powered up.
0
UART0_OFF
1
System clock to UART0 and IrDA endec is powered down.
0
System clock to UART0 and IrDA endec is powered up.
6
GPIO_C_OFF
5
GPIO_B_OFF
4
GPIO_A_OFF
PS019209-0504
Value Description
PRELIMINARY
Low Power Modes
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
57
Table 5. Clock Peripheral Power-Down Register 2
(CLK_PPD2 = 00DCh)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R/W
6
0
R
5
0
R
4
0
R
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
7
PHI_OFF
1
PHI Clock output is disabled (output is high-impedance).
0
PHI Clock output is enabled.
[6:4]
000
Reserved.
3
TIMER3_OFF
1
System clock to TIMER3 is powered down.
0
System clock to TIMER3 is powered up.
2
TIMER2_OFF
1
System clock to TIMER2 is powered down.
0
System clock to TIMER2 is powered up.
1
TIMER1_OFF
1
System clock to TIMER1 is powered down.
0
System clock to TIMER1 is powered up.
0
TIMER0_OFF
1
System clock to TIMER0 is powered down.
0
System clock to TIMER0 is powered up.
PRELIMINARY
Low Power Modes
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
58
General-Purpose Input/Output
GPIO Overview
The eZ80F91 device features 32 General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) pins. The
GPIO pins are assembled as four 8-bit ports— Port A, Port B, Port C, and Port D.
All port signals can be configured for use as either inputs or outputs. In addition,
all of the port pins can be used as vectored interrupt sources for the CPU.
The eZ80F91 microcontroller’s GPIO ports are slightly modified from its eZ80®
predecessors. Specifically, Port A pins now can source 8 mA and sink 10 mA. In
addition, the Port B and C inputs now feature Schmitt-trigger input buffers.
GPIO Operation
GPIO operation is the same for all four GPIO ports (Ports A, B, C, and D). Each
port features eight GPIO port pins. The operating mode for each pin is controlled
by four bits that are divided between four 8-bit registers. These GPIO mode control registers are:
•
•
•
•
Port x Data Register (Px_DR)
Port x Data Direction Register (Px_DDR)
Port x Alternate Register 1 (Px_ALT1)
Port x Alternate Register 2 (Px_ALT2)
where x can be A, B, C, or D representing any of the four GPIO ports A, B, C, or D.
The mode for each pin is controlled by setting each register bit pertinent to the pin
to be configured. For example, the operating mode for Port B Pin 7 (PB7) is set by
the values contained in PB_DR[7], PB_DDR[7], PB_ALT1[7], and PB_ALT2[7].
The combination of the GPIO control register bits allows individual configuration of
each port pin for nine modes. In all modes, reading of the Port x Data register
returns the sampled state, or level, of the signal on the corresponding pin. Table 6
indicates the function of each port signal based upon these four register bits. After
a RESET event, all GPIO port pins are configured as standard digital inputs
(GPIO Mode 2), with interrupts disabled.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
General-Purpose Input/Output
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
59
Table 6. GPIO Mode Selection
GPIO
Mode
1
Px_ALT2
Bits7:0
Px_ALT1 Px_DDR Px_DR
Bits7:0
Bits7:0 Bits7:0 Port Mode
Output
0
0
0
0
Output
0
0
0
0
1
Output
1
0
0
1
0
Input from pin
High impedance
0
0
1
1
Input from pin
High impedance
0
1
0
0
Open-drain output
0
0
1
0
1
Open-drain I/O
High impedance
0
1
1
0
Open-source I/O
High impedance
0
1
1
1
Open-source output
1
5
1
0
0
0
Reserved
High impedance
6
1
0
0
1
Interrupt—dual edge-triggered
High impedance
7
1
0
1
0
Port B, C, or D—alternate function controls port I/O.
1
0
1
1
Port B, C, or D—alternate function controls port I/O.
1
1
0
0
Interrupt—active Low
High impedance
1
1
0
1
Interrupt—active High
High impedance
1
1
1
0
Interrupt—falling edge-triggered High impedance
1
1
1
1
Interrupt—rising edge-triggered High impedance
2
3
4
8
9
GPIO Mode 1. The port pin is configured as a standard digital output pin. The
value written to the Port x Data register (Px_DR) is presented on the pin.
GPIO Mode 2. The port pin is configured as a standard digital input pin. The output
is tristated (high impedance). The value stored in the Port x Data register produces no effect. As in all modes, a Read from the Port x Data register returns the
pin’s value. GPIO Mode 2 is the default operating mode following a RESET.
GPIO Mode 3. The port pin is configured as open-drain I/O. The GPIO pins do not
feature an internal pull-up to the supply voltage. To employ the GPIO pin in
OPEN-DRAIN mode, an external pull-up resistor must connect the pin to the supply voltage. Writing a 0 to the Port x Data register outputs a Low at the pin. Writing
a 1 to the Port x Data register results in high-impedance output.
GPIO Mode 4. The port pin is configured as open-source I/O. The GPIO pins do
not feature an internal pull-down to the supply ground. To employ the GPIO pin in
OPEN-SOURCE mode, an external pull-down resistor must connect the pin to the
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
General-Purpose Input/Output
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
60
supply ground. Writing a 1 to the Port x Data register outputs a High at the pin.
Writing a 0 to the Port x Data register results in a high-impedance output.
GPIO Mode 5. Reserved. This pin produces high-impedance output.
GPIO Mode 6. This bit enables a dual edge-triggered interrupt mode. Both a rising
and a falling edge on the pin cause an interrupt request to be sent to the CPU.
Writing a 1 to the Port x Data register bit position resets the corresponding interrupt request. Writing a 0 produces no effect. The programmer must set the Port x
Data register before entering the edge-triggered interrupt mode.
GPIO Mode 7. For Ports B, C, and D, the port pin is configured to pass control over
to the alternate (secondary) functions assigned to the pin. For example, the alternate mode function for PC7 is RI1 and the alternate mode function for PB4 is the
Timer 4 output. When GPIO Mode 7 is enabled, the pin output data and pin
tristated control come from the alternate function's data output and tristate control,
respectively. The value in the Port x Data register produces no effect on operation.
Input signals are sampled by the system clock before being passed to the alternate function input.
Note: Alternate function inputs are routed to the associated functional block regardless
of the GPIO mode setting.
Px_DDR does not indicate the GPIO direction in all alternate function modes.
GPIO Mode 8. The port pin is configured for level-sensitive interrupt modes. An
interrupt request is generated when the level at the pin is the same as the level
stored in the Port x Data register. The port pin value is sampled by the system
clock. The input pin must be held at the selected interrupt level for a minimum of 2
clock periods to initiate an interrupt. The interrupt request remains active as long
as this condition is maintained at the external source.
GPIO Mode 9. The port pin is configured for single edge-triggered interrupt mode.
The value in the Port x Data register determines if a positive or negative edge
causes an interrupt request. Writing a 0 to the Port x Data register bit sets the
selected pin to generate an interrupt request for falling edges. Writing a 1 to the
Port x Data register bit sets the selected pin to generate an interrupt request for
rising edges. Any time a port pin is configured for an edge-trigger interrupt, writing
a 1 to the Port x Data register causes a reset of the edge-trigger interrupt. Writing
a 0 produces no effect on operation. The programmer must set the Port x Data
register before entering the single- or dual-edge-triggered interrupt mode.
A simplified block diagram of a GPIO port pin is illustrated in Figure 5.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
General-Purpose Input/Output
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
61
GPIO Register
Data (Input)
Q
D
Q
D
System Clock
VDD
Mode 1
Mode 4
Data Bus
D
Q
Port
Pin
System Clock
GPIO Register
Data (Output)
Mode 1
Mode 3
GND
Figure 5. GPIO Port Pin Block Diagram
GPIO Interrupts
Each port pin can be used as an interrupt source. Interrupts can be either level- or
edge-triggered.
Level-Triggered Interrupts
When the port is configured for level-triggered interrupts, the corresponding port
pin is tristated. An interrupt request is generated when the level at the pin is the
same as the level stored in the Port x Data register. The port pin value is sampled
by the system clock. The input pin must be held at the selected interrupt level for a
minimum of 2 clock periods to initiate an interrupt. The interrupt request remains
active as long as this condition is maintained at the external source.
For example, if PA3 is programmed for low-level interrupt and the pin is forced
Low for 2 clock cycles, an interrupt request signal is generated from that port pin
and sent to the CPU. The interrupt request signal remains active until the external
device driving PA3 forces the pin High. The CPU must be enabled to respond to
interrupts for the interrupt request signal to be acted upon.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
General-Purpose Input/Output
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
62
Edge-Triggered Interrupts
When the port is configured for edge-triggered interrupts, the corresponding port
pin is tristated. If the pin receives the correct edge from an external device, the
port pin generates an interrupt request signal to the CPU. Any time a port pin is
configured for an edge-triggered interrupt, writing a 1 to that pin’s Port x Data register causes a reset of an edge-detected interrupt. The programmer must set the
bit in the Port x Data register to 1 before entering either single or dual edge-triggered interrupt mode for that port pin.
When configured for dual edge-triggered interrupt mode (GPIO Mode 6), both a
rising and a falling edge on the pin cause an interrupt request to be sent to the
CPU.
When configured for single edge-triggered interrupt mode (GPIO Mode 9), the
value in the Port x Data register determines if a positive or negative edge causes
an interrupt request. A 0 in the Port x Data register bit sets the selected pin to generate an interrupt request for falling edges. A 1 in the Port x Data register bit sets
the selected pin to generate an interrupt request for rising edges.
GPIO Control Registers
The 16 GPIO Control Registers operate in groups of four with a set for each Port
(A, B, C, and D). Each GPIO port features a Port Data register, Port Data Direction register, Port Alternate register 1, and Port Alternate register 2.
Port x Data Registers
When the port pins are configured for one of the output modes, the data written to
the Port x Data registers, detailed in Table 7, is driven on the corresponding pins.
In all modes, reading from the Port x Data registers always returns the current
sampled value of the corresponding pins. When the port pins are configured as
edge-triggered interrupt sources, writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in the Port x
Data register clears the interrupt signal that is sent to the CPU. When the port pins
are configured for edge-selectable interrupts or level-sensitive interrupts, the
value written to the Port x Data register bit selects the interrupt edge or interrupt
level. See Table 6 for more information.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
General-Purpose Input/Output
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
63
Table 7. Port x Data Registers
(PA_DR = 0096h, PB_DR = 009Ah, PC_DR = 009Eh, PD_DR = 00A2h)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
X
R/W
6
X
R/W
5
X
R/W
4
X
R/W
3
X
R/W
2
X
R/W
1
X
R/W
0
X
R/W
Note: X = Undefined; R/W = Read/Write.
Port x Data Direction Registers
In conjunction with the other GPIO Control Registers, the Port x Data Direction
registers, detailed in Table 8, control the operating modes of the GPIO port pins.
See Table 6 for more information. Px_DDR does not indicate the GPIO direction in
all alternate function modes.
Table 8. Port x Data Direction Registers
(PA_DDR = 0097h, PB_DDR = 009Bh, PC_DDR = 009Fh, PD_DDR = 00A3h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Port x Alternate Register 1
In conjunction with the other GPIO Control Registers, the Port x Alternate
Register 1, detailed in Table 9, controls the operating modes of the GPIO port
pins. Px_DDR does not indicate the GPIO direction in all alternate function
modes. See Table 6 for more information.
Table 9. Port x Alternate Registers 1
(PA_ALT1 = 0098h, PB_ALT1 = 009Ch, PC_ALT1 = 00A0h, PD_ALT1 = 00A4h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
General-Purpose Input/Output
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
64
Port x Alternate Register 2
In conjunction with the other GPIO Control Registers, the Port x Alternate
Register 2, detailed in Table 10, controls the operating modes of the GPIO port
pins. See Table 6 for more information.
Table 10. Port x Alternate Registers 2
(PA_ALT2 = 0099h, PB_ALT2 = 009Dh, PC_ALT2 = 00A1h, PD_ALT2 = 00A5h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
General-Purpose Input/Output
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
65
Interrupt Controller
The interrupt controller on the eZ80F91 device routes the interrupt request signals
from the internal peripherals, external devices (via the internal port I/O), and the
nonmaskable interrupt (NMI) pin to the CPU.
Maskable Interrupts
On the eZ80F91 device, all maskable interrupts use the CPU’s vectored interrupt
function. The size of the I register is modified to 16 bits in the eZ80F91 device, differing from that of previous versions of the eZ80® CPU, to allow for a 16 MB range
of interrupt vector table placement. Additionally, the size of the IVECT register is
increased from 8 bits to 9 bits to provide an interrupt vector table that can be
expanded and is more easily integrated with other interrupts.
The vectors are 4 bytes (32 bits) apart, even though only 3 bytes (24 bits) are
required. A fourth byte is implemented for both programmability and expansion
purposes.
Starting the interrupt vectors at 40h allows for easy implementation of the interrupt
controller vectors with the RST vectors. Table 11 lists the low-byte vector for each
of the maskable interrupt sources. The maskable interrupt sources are listed in
order of their priority, with vector 40h being the highest-priority interrupt. In ADL
mode, the full 24-bit interrupt vector is located at starting address {I[15:1],
IVECT[8:0]}, where I[15:0] is the CPU’s Interrupt Page Address Register.
Table 11. Interrupt Vector Sources by Priority
Priority
Vector
Source
Priority
Vector
Source
0
040h
EMAC Rx
24
0A0h
Port B 0
1
044h
EMAC Tx
25
0A4h
Port B 1
2
048h
EMAC SYS
26
0A8h
Port B 2
3
04Ch
PLL
27
0ACh
Port B 3
4
050h
Flash
28
0B0h
Port B 4
5
054h
Timer 0
29
0B4h
Port B 5
6
058h
Timer 1
30
0B8h
Port B 6
7
05Ch
Timer 2
31
0BCh
Port B 7
8
060h
Timer 3
32
0C0h
Port C 0
Note: *The vector addresses 064h and 068h are left unused to avoid conflict with the nonmaskable
interrupt (NMI) address 066h. The NMI is prioritized higher than all maskable interrupts.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
66
Table 11. Interrupt Vector Sources by Priority (Continued)
Priority
Vector
Source
Priority
Vector
Source
9
064h
unused*
33
0C4h
Port C 1
10
068h
unused*
34
0C8h
Port C 2
11
06Ch
RTC
35
0CCh
Port C 3
12
070h
UART 0
36
0D0h
Port C 4
13
074h
UART 1
37
0D4h
Port C 5
14
078h
I2C
38
0D8h
Port C 6
15
07Ch
SPI
39
0DCh
Port C 7
16
080h
Port A 0
40
0E0h
Port D 0
17
084h
Port A 1
41
0E4h
Port D 1
18
088h
Port A 2
42
0E8h
Port D 2
19
08Ch
Port A 3
43
0ECh
Port D 3
20
090h
Port A 4
44
0F0h
Port D 4
21
094h
Port A 5
45
0F4h
Port D 5
22
098h
Port A 6
46
0F8h
Port D 6
23
09Ch
Port A 7
47
0FCh
Port D 7
Note: *The vector addresses 064h and 068h are left unused to avoid conflict with the nonmaskable
interrupt (NMI) address 066h. The NMI is prioritized higher than all maskable interrupts.
The user’s program should store the interrupt service routine starting address in
the four-byte interrupt vector locations. As an example, in ADL mode, the threebyte address for the SPI interrupt service routine is be stored at {I[15:1], 07Ch},
{I[15:1], 07Dh} and {I[15:1], 07Eh}. In Z80 mode, the two-byte address for the SPI
interrupt service routine is be stored at {MBASE[7:0], I[7:1], 07Ch} and {MBASE,
I[7:1], 07Dh}. The least-significant byte is stored at the lower address.
When any one or more of the interrupt requests (IRQs) become active, an interrupt request is generated by the interrupt controller and sent to the CPU. The corresponding 9-bit interrupt vector for the highest-priority interrupt is placed on the
9-bit interrupt vector bus, IVECT[8:0]. The interrupt vector bus is internal to the
eZ80F91 device and is therefore not visible externally. The response time of the
CPU to an interrupt request is a function of the current instruction being executed
as well as the number of wait states being asserted. The interrupt vector, {I[15:1],
IVECT[8:0]}, is visible on the address bus, ADDR[23:0], when the interrupt service
routine begins. The response of the CPU to a vectored interrupt on the eZ80F91
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
67
device is explained in Table 12. Interrupt sources are required to be active until
the interrupt service routine (ISR) starts.
The lower bit of the I register is replaced with the MSB of the IVECT from the interrupt controller. As a result, the interrupt vector table is required to be placed onto a
512-byte boundary. Setting the LSB of the I register produces no effect on the
interrupt vector address.
Note:
Table 12. Vectored Interrupt Operation
Memory
Mode
ADL
Bit
MADL
Bit
Operation
Z80 Mode
0
0
Read the LSB of the interrupt vector placed on the internal vectored
interrupt bus, IVECT [8:0], by the interrupting peripheral.
• IEF1 ← 0
• IEF2 ← 0
• The Starting Program Counter is effectively {MBASE, PC[15:0]}.
• Push the 2-byte return address PC[15:0] onto the ({MBASE,SPS}) stack.
• The ADL mode bit remains cleared to 0.
• The interrupt vector address is located at { MBASE, I[7:1], IVECT[8:0] }.
• PC[23:0] ← ( { MBASE, I[7:1], IVECT[8:0] } ).
• The interrupt service routine must end with RETI.
ADL Mode
1
0
Read the LSB of the interrupt vector placed on the internal vectored
interrupt bus, IVECT [8:0], by the interrupting peripheral.
• IEF1 ← 0
• IEF2 ← 0
• The Starting Program Counter is PC[23:0].
• Push the 3-byte return address, PC[23:0], onto the SPL stack.
• The ADL mode bit remains set to 1.
• The interrupt vector address is located at { I[15:1], IVECT[8:0] }.
• PC[23:0] ← ( { I[15:1], IVECT[8:0] } ).
• The interrupt service routine must end with RETI.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
68
Table 12. Vectored Interrupt Operation (Continued)
Memory
Mode
ADL
Bit
MADL
Bit
Operation
Z80 Mode
0
1
Read the LSB of the interrupt vector placed on the internal vectored
interrupt bus, IVECT[8:0], bus by the interrupting peripheral.
• IEF1 ← 0
• IEF2 ← 0
• The Starting Program Counter is effectively {MBASE, PC[15:0]}.
• Push the 2-byte return address, PC[15:0], onto the SPL stack.
• Push a 00h byte onto the SPL stack to indicate an interrupt from Z80 mode
(because ADL = 0).
• Set the ADL mode bit to 1.
• The interrupt vector address is located at { I[15:1], IVECT[8:0] }.
• PC[23:0] ← ( { I[15:1], IVECT[8:0] } ).
• The interrupt service routine must end with RETI.L
ADL Mode
1
1
Read the LSB of the interrupt vector placed on the internal vectored
interrupt bus, IVECT [8:0], by the interrupting peripheral.
• IEF1 ← 0
• IEF2 ← 0
• The Starting Program Counter is PC[23:0].
• Push the 3-byte return address, PC[23:0], onto the SPL stack.
• Push a 01h byte onto the SPL stack to indicate a restart from ADL mode
(because ADL = 1).
• The ADL mode bit remains set to 1.
• The interrupt vector address is located at {I[15:1], IVECT[8:0]}.
• PC[23:0] ← ( { I[15:1], IVECT[8:0] } ).
• The interrupt service routine must end with RETI.L
Interrupt Priority Registers
The eZ80F91 provides two interrupt priority levels for the maskable interrupts.
The default priority (or Level 0) is indicated in Table 11. The default priority of any
maskable interrupt can increase to Level 1 (a higher priority than any Level 0
interrupt) by setting the appropriate bit in the Interrupt Priority Registers, which
are shown in Table 13.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
69
Table 13. Interrupt Priority Registers
(INT_P0 = 0010h, INT_P1 = 0011h, INT_P2 = 0012h,
INT_P3 = 0013h, INT_P4 = 0014h, INT_P5 = 0015h)
Bit
INT_P0 Reset
INT_P1 Reset
INT_P2 Reset
INT_P3 Reset
INT_P4 Reset
INT_P5 Reset
CPU Access
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
6
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
5
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
4
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
3
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
2
0
0*
0
0
0
0
R/W
1
0
0*
0
0
0
0
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
Note: X = Undefined; R/W = Read/Write, *Unused.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
7
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
6
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
5
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
4
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
3
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
2
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
1
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
0
INT_PX
0
Default Interrupt Priority
1
Level One Interrupt Priority
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
70
The Interrupt Priority Control bits are shown in Table 14.
Table 14. Interrupt Vector Priority Control Bits
Priority
Control Bit
Vector
Source
Priority
Control Bit
Vector
Source
INT_P0[0]
040h
EMAC Rx
INT_P3[0]
0A0h
Port B 0
INT_P0[1]
044h
EMAC Tx
INT_P3[1]
0A4h
Port B 1
INT_P0[2]
048h
EMAC SYS
INT_P3[2]
0A8h
Port B 2
INT_P0[3]
04Ch
PLL
INT_P3[3]
0ACh
Port B 3
INT_P0[4]
050h
Flash
INT_P3[4]
0B0h
Port B 4
INT_P0[5]
054h
Timer 0
INT_P3[5]
0B4h
Port B 5
INT_P0[6]
058h
Timer 1
INT_P3[6]
0B8h
Port B 6
INT_P0[7]
05Ch
Timer 2
INT_P3[7]
0BCh
Port B 7
INT_P1[0]
060h
Timer 3
INT_P4[0]
0C0h
Port C 0
INT_P1[1]
064h
unused*
INT_P4[1]
0C4h
Port C 1
INT_P1[2]
068h
unused*
INT_P4[2]
0C8h
Port C 2
INT_P1[3]
06Ch
RTC
INT_P4[3]
0CCh
Port C 3
INT_P1[4]
070h
UART 0
INT_P4[4]
0D0h
Port C 4
INT_P1[5]
074h
UART 1
INT_P4[5]
0D4h
Port C 5
INT_P1[6]
078h
I2C
INT_P4[6]
0D8h
Port C 6
INT_P1[7]
07Ch
SPI
INT_P4[7]
0DCh
Port C 7
INT_P2[0]
080h
Port A 0
INT_P5[0]
0E0h
Port D 0
INT_P2[1]
084h
Port A 1
INT_P5[1]
0E4h
Port D 1
INT_P2[2]
088h
Port A 2
INT_P5[2]
0E8h
Port D 2
INT_P2[3]
08Ch
Port A 3
INT_P5[3]
0ECh
Port D 3
INT_P2[4]
090h
Port A 4
INT_P5[4]
0F0h
Port D 4
INT_P2[5]
094h
Port A 5
INT_P5[5]
0F4h
Port D 5
INT_P2[6]
098h
Port A 6
INT_P5[6]
0F8h
Port D 6
INT_P2[7]
09Ch
Port A 7
INT_P5[7]
0FCh
Port D 7
Note: *The vector addresses 064h and 068h are left unused to avoid conflict with the NMI
vector address 066h.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
71
If more than one maskable interrupt is prioritized to a higher level (Level 1), the
higher-priority interrupts follow the priority order described in Table 11. For example, Table 15 shows the maskable interrupts 044h (EMAC Tx), 084h (Port A 1),
and 06Ch (RTC) as elevated to Priority Level 1. Table 16 shows the new interrupt
priority for the top ten maskable interrupts.
Table 15. Example: Maskable Interrupt Priority
Priority
Register
Setting
Description
INT_P0
02h
Increase 044h (EMAC Tx) to Priority Level 1
INT_P1
08h
Increase 06Ch (RTC) to Priority Level 1
INT_P2
02h
Increase 084h (Port A1) to Priority Level 1
INT_P3
00h
Default priority
INT_P4
00h
Default priority
INT_P5
00h
Default priority
Table 16. Example: Priority Levels for Maskable Interrupts
PS019209-0504
Priority
Vector
Source
0
044h
EMAC Tx
1
06Ch
RTC
2
084h
Port A 1
3
040h
EMAC Rx
4
048h
EMAC SYS
5
04Ch
PLL
6
050h
Flash
7
054h
Timer 0
8
058h
Timer 1
9
05Ch
Timer 2
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
72
GPIO Port Interrupts
All interrupts are latched. In effect, an interrupt is held even if the interrupt occurs
while another interrupt is being serviced and interrupts are disabled, or if the interrupt is of a lower priority. However, before the latched ISR completes its task or
reenables interrupts, the ISR must clear the interrupt. For on-chip peripherals, the
interrupt is cleared when the data register is accessed. For GPIO-level interrupts,
the interrupt signal must be removed before the ISR completes its task. For GPIOedge interrupts (single and dual), the interrupt is cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit position in the data register. See the Edge-Triggered Interrupts
section on page 62.
Note:
Care must be taken using a GPIO data register when it is configured for interrupts. For edge-interrupt modes (Modes 6 and 9) as discussed above, writing a 1
clears the interrupt. However, a 1 in the data register also conveys a particular
configuration. For example, when the data register Px_DR is set first, followed by
the Px_ALT2, Px_ALT1, and Px_DDR registers, then the configuration is performed correctly. Writing a 1 to the register later to clear interrupts does not
change the configuration.
In Mode 9 operation, if the GPIO is already configured for Mode 9 and the trigger
edge must be changed (from falling to rising or from rising to falling), the configuration must be changed to another mode, such as Mode 2, and then changed
back to Mode 9. For example, enter Mode 2 by writing the registers in the
sequence PxDR, Px_ALT2, Px_ALT1, Px_DDR. Next, change back to Mode 9 by
writing the registers in the sequence PxDR, Px_ALT2, Px_ALT1, Px_DDR.
In Mode 8 operation, if the GPIO is configured for level-sensitive interrupts, a
Write value to Px_DR after configuration must be the same Write value used
when configuring the GPIO.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Interrupt Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
73
Chip Selects and Wait States
The eZ80F91 generates four Chip Selects for external devices. Each Chip Select
can be programmed to access either memory space or I/O space. The Memory
Chip Selects can be individually programmed on a 64 KB boundary. The I/O Chip
Selects can each choose a 256-byte section of I/O space. In addition, each Chip
Select can be programmed for up to 7 wait states.
Memory and I/O Chip Selects
Each of the Chip Selects can be enabled for either the memory address space or
the I/O address space, but not both. To select the memory address space for a
particular Chip Select, CSX_IO (CSx_CTL[4]) must be reset to 0. To select the I/O
address space for a particular Chip Select, CSX_IO must be set to 1. After
RESET, the default is for all Chip Selects to be configured for the memory address
space. For either the memory address space or the I/O address space, the individual Chip Selects must be enabled by setting CSX_EN (CSx_CTL[3]) to 1.
Memory Chip Select Operation
Operation of each of the Memory Chip Selects is controlled by three control registers. To enable a particular Memory Chip Select, the following conditions must be
met:
•
•
•
The Chip Select is enabled by setting CSx_EN to 1
The Chip Select is configured for memory by clearing CSX_IO to 0
The address is in the associated Chip Select range:
CSx_LBR[7:0] ≤ ADDR[23:16] ≤ CSx_UBR[7:0]
•
On-chip Flash is not configured for the same address space, because on-chip
Flash is prioritized higher than all Memory Chip Selects
•
On-chip RAM is not configured for the same address space, because on-chip
RAM is prioritized higher than Flash and all Memory Chip Selects
•
•
No higher priority (lower number) Chip Select meets the above conditions
A memory access instruction must be executing
If all of the foregoing conditions are met to generate a Memory Chip Select, then
the following actions occur:
•
PS019209-0504
The appropriate Chip Select—CS0, CS1, CS2, or CS3—is asserted (driven
Low)
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
74
•
•
MREQ is asserted (driven Low)
Depending upon the instruction, either RD or WR is asserted (driven Low)
If the upper and lower bounds are set to the same value (CSx_UBR = CSx_LBR),
then a particular Chip Select is valid for a single 64 KB page.
Memory Chip Select Priority
A lower-numbered Chip Select is granted priority over a higher-numbered Chip
Select. For example, if the address space of Chip Select 0 overlaps the Chip
Select 1 address space, Chip Select 0 is active. If the address range programmed
for any Chip Select signal overlaps with the address of internal memory, the internal memory is accorded higher priority. If the particular Chip Select(s) are configured with an address range that overlaps with an internal memory address, then
when the internal memory is accessed, the Chip Select signal is not asserted.
Reset States
On RESET, Chip Select 0 is active for all addresses, because its Lower Bound
register resets to 00h and its Upper Bound register resets to FFh. All of the other
Chip Select Lower and Upper Bound registers reset to 00h.
Memory Chip Select Example
The use of Memory Chip Selects is demonstrated in Figure 6. The associated
control register values are indicated in Table 17. In this example, all 4 Chip
Selects are enabled and configured for memory addresses. Also, CS1 overlaps
with CS0. Because CS0 is prioritized higher than CS1, CS1 is not active for much
of its defined address space.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
75
Memory
Location
CS3_UBR = FFh
FFFFFFh
CS3 Active
3 MB Address Space
CS3_LBR = D0h
CS2_UBR = CFh
CS2 Active
3 MB Address Space
CS2_LBR = A0h
CS1_UBR = 9Fh
CS1 Active
2 MB Address Space
CS0_UBR = 7Fh
D00000h
CFFFFFh
A00000h
9FFFFFh
800000h
7FFFFFh
CS0 Active
8 MB Address Space
CS0_LBR = CS1_LBR = 00h
000000h
Figure 6. Example: Memory Chip Select
Table 17. Example: Register Values for Figure 6 Memory Chip Select
Chip
Select
CSx_CTL[3] CSx_CTL[4]
CSx_EN
CSx_IO
CSx_LBR
CSx_UBR Description
CS0
1
0
00h
7Fh
CS0 is enabled as a Memory Chip
Select. Valid addresses range from
000000h–7FFFFFh.
CS1
1
0
00h
9Fh
CS1 is enabled as a Memory Chip
Select. Valid addresses range from
800000h–9FFFFFh.
CS2
1
0
A0h
CFh
CS2 is enabled as a Memory Chip
Select. Valid addresses range from
A00000h–CFFFFFh.
CS3
1
0
D0h
FFh
CS3 is enabled as a Memory Chip
Select. Valid addresses range from
D00000h–FFFFFFh.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
76
I/O Chip Select Operation
I/O Chip Selects can only be active when the CPU is performing I/O instructions.
Because the I/O space is separate from the memory space in the eZ80F91
device, there can never be a conflict between I/O and memory addresses.
The eZ80F91 supports a 16-bit I/O address. The I/O Chip Select logic decodes
the High byte of the I/O address, ADDR[15:8]. Because the upper byte of the
address bus, ADDR[23:16], is ignored, the I/O devices can always be accessed
from within either memory mode (ADL or Z80). The MBASE offset value used for
setting the Z80 MEMORY mode page is also always ignored.
Four I/O Chip Selects are available with the eZ80F91 device. To generate a particular I/O Chip Select, the following conditions must be met:
•
•
•
•
•
The Chip Select is enabled by setting CSx_EN to 1
The Chip Select is configured for I/O by setting CSX_IO to 1
An I/O Chip Select address match occurs—ADDR[15:8] = CSx_LBR[7:0]
No higher-priority (lower-number) Chip Select meets the above conditions
The I/O address is not within the on-chip peripheral address range 0080h–
00FFh. On-chip peripheral registers assume priority for all addresses where:
0080h ≤ ADDR[15:0] ≤ 00FFh
•
An I/O instruction must be executing
If all of the foregoing conditions are met to generate an I/O Chip Select, then the
following actions occur:
•
The appropriate Chip Select—CS0, CS1, CS2, or CS3—is asserted (driven
Low)
•
•
IORQ is asserted (driven Low)
Depending upon the instruction, either RD or WR is asserted (driven Low)
Wait States
For each of the Chip Selects, programmable wait states can be asserted to provide external devices with additional clock cycles to complete their Read or Write
operations. The number of wait states for a particular Chip Select is controlled by
the 3-bit field CSx_WAIT (CSx_CTL[7:5]). The wait states can be independently
programmed to provide 0 to 7 wait states for each Chip Select. The wait states
idle the CPU for the specified number of system clock cycles.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
77
WAIT Input Signal
Similar to the programmable wait states, an external peripheral can drive the
WAIT input pin to force the CPU to provide additional clock cycles to complete its
Read or Write operation. Driving the WAIT pin Low stalls the CPU. The CPU
resumes operation on the first rising edge of the internal system clock following
deassertion of the WAIT pin.
Caution: If the WAIT pin is to be driven by an external device, the corresponding Chip Select for
the device must be programmed to provide at least one wait state. Due to input sampling
of the WAIT input pin (shown in Figure 7), one programmable wait state is required to
allow the external peripheral sufficient time to assert the WAIT pin. It is recommended
that the corresponding Chip Select for the external device be programmed to provide the
maximum number of wait states (seven).
Wait
Pin
D
Q
eZ80
CPU
System Clock
Figure 7. Wait Input Sampling Block Diagram
An example of wait state operation is illustrated in Figure 8. In this example, the
Chip Select is configured to provide a single wait state. The external peripheral
being accessed drives the WAIT pin Low to request assertion of an additional wait
state. If the WAIT pin is asserted for additional system clock cycles, wait states
are added until the WAIT pin is deasserted (active High).
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
78
TCLK
TWAIT
SCLK
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
(output)
CSx
MREQ
RD
INSTRD
Figure 8. Example: Wait State Read Operation
Chip Selects During Bus Request/Bus Acknowledge Cycles
When the CPU relinquishes the address bus to an external peripheral in response
to an external bus request (BUSREQ), it drives the bus acknowledge pin
(BUSACK) Low. The external peripheral can then drive the address bus (and data
bus). The CPU continues to generate Chip Select signals in response to the
address on the bus. External devices cannot access the internal registers of the
eZ80F91.
Bus Mode Controller
The bus mode controller allows the address and data bus timing and signal formats of the eZ80F91 to be configured to connect seamlessly with external
eZ80®-, Z80™-, Intel™-, or Motorola-compatible devices. Bus modes for each of
the chip selects can be configured independently using the Chip Select Bus Mode
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
79
Control Registers. The number of CPU system clock cycles per bus mode state is
also independently programmable. For Intel bus mode, multiplexed address and
data can be selected, in which the lower byte of the address and the data byte
both use the data bus, DATA[7:0]. Each of the bus modes is explained in more
detail in the following sections.
eZ80 Bus Mode
Chip selects configured for eZ80 bus mode do not modify the bus signals from the
CPU. The timing diagrams for external Memory and I/O Read and Write operations are shown in the AC Characteristics section on page 348. The default mode
for each chip select is eZ80 mode.
Z80 Bus Mode
Chip selects configured for Z80 mode modify the eZ80® bus signals to match the
Z80 microprocessor address and data bus interface signal format and timing. During Read operations, the Z80 Bus mode employs three states—T1, T2, and T3—
as described in Table 18.
Table 18. Z80 Bus Mode Read States
STATE T1
The Read cycle begins in State T1. The CPU drives the address onto the address bus
and the associated Chip Select signal is asserted.
STATE T2
During State T2, the RD signal is asserted. Depending upon the instruction, either the
MREQ or IORQ signal is asserted. If the external WAIT pin is driven Low at least one CPU
system clock cycle prior to the end of State T2, additional wait states (TWAIT) are asserted
until the WAIT pin is driven High.
STATE T3
During State T3, no bus signals are altered. The data is latched by the eZ80F91 at the
rising edge of the CPU system clock at the end of State T3.
During Write operations, Z80 Bus mode employs 3 states—T1, T2, and T3—as
described in Table 19.
Table 19. Z80 Bus Mode Write States
STATE T1
The Write cycle begins in State T1. The CPU drives the address onto the address bus,
and the associated Chip Select signal is asserted.
STATE T2
During State T2, the WR signal is asserted. Depending upon the instruction, either the
MREQ or IORQ signal is asserted. If the external WAIT pin is driven Low at least one CPU
system clock cycle prior to the end of State T2, additional wait states (TWAIT) are asserted
until the WAIT pin is driven High.
STATE T3
During State T3, no bus signals are altered.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
80
Z80 bus mode Read and Write timing is illustrated in Figures 9 and 10 . The Z80
bus mode states can be configured for 1 to 15 CPU system clock cycles. In the
figures, each Z80 bus mode state is two CPU system clock cycles in duration. Figures 9 and 10 also illustrate the assertion of 1 wait state (TWAIT) by the external
peripheral during each Z80 bus mode cycle.
T1
T2
TCLK
T3
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
RD
WAIT
WR
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 9. Example: Z80 Bus Mode Read Timing
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
81
T1
T2
TCLK
T3
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
RD
WAIT
WR
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 10. Example: Z80 Bus Mode Write Timing
Intel Bus Mode
Chip selects configured for Intel bus mode modify the CPU bus signals to duplicate a four-state memory transfer similar to that found on Intel-style microcontrollers. The bus signals and eZ80F91 pins are mapped as illustrated in Figure 11. In
Intel bus mode, the user can select either multiplexed or nonmultiplexed address
and data buses. In nonmultiplexed operation, the address and data buses are
separate. In multiplexed operation, the lower byte of the address, ADDR[7:0], also
appears on the data bus, DATA[7:0], during State T1 of the Intel bus mode cycle.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
82
Bus Mode
Controller
eZ80 Bus Mode
Signals (Pins)
Intel Bus
Signal Equvalents
INSTRD
ALE
RD
RD
WR
WR
WAIT
READY
MREQ
MREQ
IORQ
IORQ
ADDR[23:0]
ADDR[23:0]
ADDR[7:0]
DATA[7:0]
Multiplexed
Bus
Controller
DATA[7:0]
Figure 11. Intel Bus Mode Signal and Pin Mapping
Intel Bus Mode—Separate Address and Data Buses
During Read operations with separate address and data buses, the Intel bus
mode employs 4 states—T1, T2, T3, and T4—as described in Table 20.
Table 20. Intel Bus Mode Read States—Separate Address and Data Buses
STATE T1
The Read cycle begins in State T1. The CPU drives the address onto the address bus and
the associated Chip Select signal is asserted. The CPU drives the ALE signal High at the
beginning of T1. During the middle of T1, the CPU drives ALE Low to facilitate the latching
of the address.
STATE T2
During State T2, the CPU asserts the RD signal. Depending on the instruction, either the
MREQ or IORQ signal is asserted.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
83
Table 20. Intel Bus Mode Read States—Separate Address and Data Buses (Continued)
STATE T3
During State T3, no bus signals are altered. If the external READY (WAIT) pin is driven
Low at least one CPU system clock cycle prior to the beginning of State T3, additional wait
states (TWAIT) are asserted until the READY pin is driven High.
STATE T4
The CPU latches the Read data at the beginning of State T4. The CPU deasserts the RD
signal and completes the Intel bus mode cycle.
During Write operations with separate address and data buses, the Intel bus
mode employs 4 states—T1, T2, T3, and T4—as described in Table 21.
Table 21. Intel Bus Mode Write States—Separate Address and Data Buses
STATE T1
The Write cycle begins in State T1. The CPU drives the address onto the address bus, the
associated Chip Select signal is asserted, and the data is driven onto the data bus. The
CPU drives the ALE signal High at the beginning of T1. During the middle of T1, the CPU
drives ALE Low to facilitate the latching of the address.
STATE T2
During State T2, the CPU asserts the WR signal. Depending on the instruction, either the
MREQ or IORQ signal is asserted.
STATE T3
During State T3, no bus signals are altered. If the external READY (WAIT) pin is driven
Low at least one CPU system clock cycle prior to the beginning of State T3, additional wait
states (TWAIT) are asserted until the READY pin is driven High.
STATE T4
The CPU deasserts the WR signal at the beginning of State T4. The CPU holds the data
and address buses through the end of T4. The bus cycle is completed at the end of T4.
Intel™ bus mode timing is illustrated for a Read operation in Figure 12 and for a
Write operation in Figure 13. If the READY signal (external WAIT pin) is driven
Low prior to the beginning of State T3, additional wait states (TWAIT) are asserted
until the READY signal is driven High. The Intel bus mode states can be configured for 2 to 15 CPU system clock cycles. In the figures, each Intel™ bus mode
state is 2 CPU system clock cycles in duration. Figures 12 and 13 also illustrate
the assertion of one wait state (TWAIT) by the selected peripheral.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
84
T1
T2
T3
TWAIT
T4
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
ALE
RD
READY
WR
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 12. Example: Intel Bus Mode Read Timing—Separate Address and Data Buses
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
85
T1
T2
T3
TWAIT
T4
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
ALE
WR
READY
RD
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 13. Example: Intel Bus Mode Write Timing—Separate Address and Data Buses
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
86
Intel™ Bus Mode—Multiplexed Address and Data Bus
During Read operations with multiplexed address and data, the Intel™ bus mode
employs 4 states—T1, T2, T3, and T4—as described in Table 22.
Table 22. Intel™ Bus Mode Read States—Multiplexed Address and Data Bus
STATE T1
The Read cycle begins in State T1. The CPU drives the address onto the DATA bus and
the associated Chip Select signal is asserted. The CPU drives the ALE signal High at the
beginning of T1. During the middle of T1, the CPU drives ALE Low to facilitate the latching
of the address.
STATE T2
During State T2, the CPU removes the address from the DATA bus and asserts the RD
signal. Depending upon the instruction, either the MREQ or IORQ signal is asserted.
STATE T3
During State T3, no bus signals are altered. If the external READY (WAIT) pin is driven
Low at least one CPU system clock cycle prior to the beginning of State T3, additional wait
states (TWAIT) are asserted until the READY pin is driven High.
STATE T4
The CPU latches the Read data at the beginning of State T4. The CPU deasserts the RD
signal and completes the Intel™ bus mode cycle.
During Write operations with multiplexed address and data, the Intel™ bus mode
employs 4 states—T1, T2, T3, and T4—as described in Table 23.
Table 23. Intel™ Bus Mode Write States—Multiplexed Address and Data Bus
STATE T1
The Write cycle begins in State T1. The CPU drives the address onto the DATA bus and
drives the ALE signal High at the beginning of T1. During the middle of T1, the CPU drives
ALE Low to facilitate the latching of the address.
STATE T2
During State T2, the CPU removes the address from the DATA bus and drives the Write
data onto the DATA bus. The WR signal is asserted to indicate a Write operation.
STATE T3
During State T3, no bus signals are altered. If the external READY (WAIT) pin is driven
Low at least one CPU system clock cycle prior to the beginning of State T3, additional wait
states (TWAIT) are asserted until the READY pin is driven High.
STATE T4
The CPU deasserts the Write signal at the beginning of T4 identifying the end of the Write
operation. The CPU holds the data and address buses through the end of T4. The bus
cycle is completed at the end of T4.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
87
Signal timing for Intel™ bus mode with multiplexed address and data is illustrated
for a Read operation in Figure 14 and for a Write operation in Figure 15. In these
figures, each Intel™ bus mode state is 2 CPU system clock cycles in duration.
Figures 14 and 15 also illustrate the assertion of one wait state (TWAIT) by the
selected peripheral.
T1
T2
T3
TWAIT
T4
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
ALE
RD
READY
WR
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 14. Example: Intel™ Bus Mode Read Timing—Multiplexed Address and Data Bus
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
88
T1
T2
T3
TWAIT
T4
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
ALE
WR
READY
RD
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 15. Example: Intel™ Bus Mode Write Timing—Multiplexed Address and Data Bus
Motorola Bus Mode
Chip selects configured for Motorola bus mode modify the CPU bus signals to
duplicate an eight-state memory transfer similar to that found on Motorola-style
microcontrollers. The bus signals (and eZ80F91 I/O pins) are mapped as illustrated in Figure 16.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
89
Bus Mode
Controller
eZ80 Bus Mode
Signals (Pins)
Motorola Bus
Signal Equvalents
INSTRD
AS
RD
DS
WR
R/W
WAIT
DTACK
MREQ
MREQ
IORQ
IORQ
ADDR[23:0]
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
DATA[7:0]
Figure 16. Motorola Bus Mode Signal and Pin Mapping
During Write operations, the Motorola bus mode employs 8 states—S0, S1, S2,
S3, S4, S5, S6, and S7—as described in Table 24.
Table 24. Motorola Bus Mode Read States
STATE S0
The Read cycle starts in state S0. The CPU drives R/W High to identify a Read cycle.
STATE S1
Entering state S1, the CPU drives a valid address on the address bus, ADDR[23:0].
STATE S2
On the rising edge of state S2, the CPU asserts AS and DS.
STATE S3
During state S3, no bus signals are altered.
STATE S4
During state S4, the CPU waits for a cycle termination signal DTACK (WAIT), a peripheral
signal. If the termination signal is not asserted at least one full CPU clock period prior to
the rising clock edge at the end of S4, the CPU inserts WAIT (TWAIT) states until DTACK is
asserted. Each wait state is a full bus mode cycle.
STATE S5
During state S5, no bus signals are altered.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
90
Table 24. Motorola Bus Mode Read States (Continued)
STATE S6
During state S6, data from the external peripheral device is driven onto the data bus.
STATE S7
On the rising edge of the clock entering state S7, the CPU latches data from the
addressed peripheral device and deasserts AS and DS. The peripheral device deasserts
DTACK at this time.
The eight states for a Write operation in Motorola bus mode are described in
Table 25.
Table 25. Motorola Bus Mode WRITE States
STATE S0
The Write cycle starts in S0. The CPU drives R/W High (if a preceding Write cycle leaves
R/W Low).
STATE S1
Entering S1, the CPU drives a valid address on the address bus.
STATE S2
On the rising edge of S2, the CPU asserts AS and drives R/W Low.
STATE S3
During S3, the data bus is driven out of the high-impedance state as the data to be written
is placed on the bus.
STATE S4
At the rising edge of S4, the CPU asserts DS. The CPU waits for a cycle termination signal
DTACK (WAIT). If the termination signal is not asserted at least one full CPU clock period
prior to the rising clock edge at the end of S4, the CPU inserts WAIT (TWAIT) states until
DTACK is asserted. Each wait state is a full bus mode cycle.
STATE S5
During S5, no bus signals are altered.
STATE S6
During S6, no bus signals are altered.
STATE S7
Upon entering S7, the CPU deasserts AS and DS. As the clock rises at the end of S7, the
CPU drives R/W High. The peripheral device deasserts DTACK at this time.
Signal timing for Motorola bus mode is illustrated for a Read operation in
Figure 17 and for a Write operation in Figure 18. In these two figures, each Motorola bus mode state is 2 CPU system clock cycles in duration.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
91
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
AS
DS
R/W
DTACK
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 17. Motorola Bus Mode Read Timing Example
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
92
S0
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
System Clock
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
CSx
AS
DS
R/W
DTACK
MREQ
or IORQ
Figure 18. Motorola Bus Mode Write Timing Example
Switching Between Bus Modes
When switching bus modes between Intel™ to Motorola, Motorola to Intel™, eZ80
to Motorola, or eZ80 to Intel™, there is one extra SCLK cycle added to the bus
access. An extra clock cycle is not required for repeated access in any of the bus
modes (for example Intel™ to Intel™). An extra clock cycle is not required for
Intel™ (or Motorola) to eZ80 bus mode (under normal operation). The extra clock
cycle is not shown in the timing examples. Due to the asynchronous nature of
these bus protocols, the extra delay does not impact peripheral communication.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
93
Chip Select Registers
Chip Select x Lower Bound Register
For Memory Chip Selects, the Chip Select x Lower Bound register, detailed in
Table 26, defines the lower bound of the address range for which the corresponding Memory Chip Select (if enabled) can be active. For I/O Chip Selects, this register defines the address to which ADDR[15:8] is compared to generate an I/O
Chip Select. All Chip Select lower bound registers reset to 00h.
Table 26. Chip Select x Lower Bound Register
(CS0_LBR = 00A8h, CS1_LBR = 00ABh, CS2_LBR = 00AEh, CS3_LBR = 00B1h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CS0_LBR Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS1_LBR Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS2_LBR Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS3_LBR Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
CSX_LBR
00h–
FFh
For Memory Chip Selects (CSx_IO = 0)
This byte specifies the lower bound of the Chip Select address
range. The upper byte of the address bus, ADDR[23:16], is
compared to the values contained in these registers for
determining whether a Memory Chip Select signal should be
generated.
For I/O Chip Selects (CSx_IO = 1)
This byte specifies the Chip Select address value. ADDR[15:8] is
compared to the values contained in these registers for
determining whether an I/O Chip Select signal should be
generated.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
94
Chip Select x Upper Bound Register
For Memory Chip Selects, the Chip Select x Upper Bound registers, detailed in
Table 27, defines the upper bound of the address range for which the corresponding Chip Select (if enabled) can be active. For I/O Chip Selects, this register produces no effect. The reset state for the Chip Select 0 Upper Bound register is FFh,
while the reset state for the other Chip Select upper bound registers is 00h.
Table 27. Chip Select x Upper Bound Register
(CS0_UBR = 00A9h, CS1_UBR = 00ACh, CS2_UBR = 00AFh, CS3_UBR = 00B2h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CS0_UBR Reset
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CS1_UBR Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS2_UBR Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS3_UBR Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
CSX_UBR
00h–
FFh
For Memory Chip Selects (CSX_IO = 0)
This byte specifies the upper bound of the Chip Select
address range. The upper byte of the address bus,
ADDR[23:16], is compared to the values contained in these
registers for determining whether a Chip Select signal should
be generated.
For I/O Chip Selects (CSx_IO = 1)
No effect.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
95
Chip Select x Control Register
The Chip Select x Control register, detailed in Table 28, enables the Chip Selects,
specifies the type of Chip Select, and sets the number of wait states. The reset
state for the Chip Select 0 Control register is E8h, while the reset state for the 3
other Chip Select control registers is 00h.
Table 28. Chip Select x Control Register
(CS0_CTL = 00AAh, CS1_CTL = 00ADh, CS2_CTL = 00B0h, CS3_CTL = 00B3h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CS0_CTL Reset
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
CS1_CTL Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS2_CTL Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CS3_CTL Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
[7:5]
CSX_WAIT
000
0 wait states are asserted when this Chip Select is active.
001
1 wait state is asserted when this Chip Select is active.
010
2 wait states are asserted when this Chip Select is active.
011
3 wait states are asserted when this Chip Select is active.
100
4 wait states are asserted when this Chip Select is active.
101
5 wait states are asserted when this Chip Select is active.
110
6 wait states are asserted when this Chip Select is active.
111
7 wait states are asserted when this Chip Select is active.
0
Chip Select is configured as a Memory Chip Select.
1
Chip Select is configured as an I/O Chip Select.
3
CSX_EN
0
Chip Select is disabled.
1
Chip Select is enabled.
[2:0]
000
Reserved.
4
CSX_IO
PS019209-0504
Value Description
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
96
Chip Select x Bus Mode Control Register
The Chip Select Bus Mode register, detailed in Table 29, configures the Chip
Select for eZ80, Z80, Intel™, or Motorola bus modes. Changing the bus mode
allows the eZ80F91 device to interface to peripherals based on the Z80-, Intel™-,
or Motorola-style asynchronous bus interfaces. When a bus mode other than
eZ80 is programmed for a particular Chip Select, the CSx_WAIT setting in that
Chip Select Control Register is ignored.
Table 29. Chip Select x Bus Mode Control Register
(CS0_BMC = 00F0h, CS1_BMC = 00F1h, CS2_BMC = 00F2h, CS3_BMC = 00F3h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CS0_BMC Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
CS1_BMC Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
CS2_BMC Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
CS3_BMC Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
[7:6]
BUS_MODE
PS019209-0504
Value Description
00
eZ80 bus mode.
01
Z80 bus mode.
10
Intel™ bus mode.
11
Motorola bus mode.
5
AD_MUX
0
Separate address and data.
1
Multiplexed address and data—appears on data bus
DATA[7:0].
4
0
Reserved.
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
97
Bit
Position
[3:0]
BUS_CYCLE
Value Description
0000
Not valid.
0001
Each bus mode state is 1 eZ80® clock cycle in duration.1, 2, 3
0010
Each bus mode state is 2 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
0011
Each bus mode state is 3 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
0100
Each bus mode state is 4 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
0101
Each bus mode state is 5 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
0110
Each bus mode state is 6 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
0111
Each bus mode state is 7 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1000
Each bus mode state is 8 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1001
Each bus mode state is 9 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1010
Each bus mode state is 10 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1011
Each bus mode state is 11 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1100
Each bus mode state is 12 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1101
Each bus mode state is 13 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1110
Each bus mode state is 14 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
1111
Each bus mode state is 15 eZ80® clock cycles in duration.
Notes:
1. Setting the BUS_CYCLE to 1 in Intel bus mode causes the ALE pin to not function properly.
2. Use of the external WAIT input pin in Z80 Mode requires that BUS_CYCLE is set to a value
greater than 1.
3. BUS_CYCLE produces no effect in eZ80 mode.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Chip Selects and Wait States
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
98
Bus Arbiter
The Bus Arbiter within the eZ80F91 allows external bus masters to gain control of
the CPU memory interface bus. During normal operation, the eZ80F91 device is
the bus master. External devices can request master use of the bus by asserting
the BUSREQ pin. The Bus Arbiter forces the CPU to release the bus after completing the current instruction. When the CPU releases the bus, the Bus Arbiter
asserts the BUSACK pin to notify the external device that it can master the bus.
When an external device assumes control of the memory interface bus, the bus
acknowledge cycle is complete. Table 30 shows the status of the pins on the
eZ80F91 device during bus acknowledge cycles.
During a bus acknowledge cycle, the bus interface pins of the eZ80F91 device
can be used by an external bus master to control the memory and I/O Chip
Selects.
Table 30. eZ80F91 Pin Status During Bus Acknowledge Cycles
PS019209-0504
Pin Symbol
Signal Direction
Description
ADDR23..ADDR0
Input
Allows external bus master to utilize the
Chip Select logic of the eZ80F91.
CS0
Output
Normal operation.
CS1
Output
Normal operation.
CS2
Output
Normal operation.
CS3
Output
Normal operation.
DATA7..0
Tristate
Allows external bus master to communicate
with external peripherals.
IORQ
Input
Allows external bus master to utilize the
Chip Select logic of the eZ80F91.
MREQ
Input
Allows external bus master to utilize the
Chip Select logic of the eZ80F91.
RD
Tristate
Allows external bus master to communicate
with external peripherals.
WR
Tristate
Allows external bus master to communicate
with external peripherals.
INSTRD
Tristate
Allows external bus master to communicate
with external peripherals.
PRELIMINARY
Bus Arbiter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
99
Normal bus operation of the eZ80F91 device using CS0 to communicate to an
external peripheral is shown in Figure 19. Figure 20 shows an external bus master communicating with an external peripheral during bus acknowledge cycles.
WAIT
RD
WR
eZ80F91 MCU
External
Peripheral
DATA
ADDRESS
IORQ
MREQ
eZ80F91
Chip Select
Wait State
Generator
CS0
CS1
CS2
CS3
Figure 19. Memory Interface Bus Operation During CPU Bus Cycles, Normal Operation
WAIT
RD
WR
External
Master
External
Peripheral
DATA
ADDRESS
IORQ
MREQ
eZ80F91
Chip Select
Wait State
Generator
CS0
CS1
CS2
CS3
Figure 20. Memory Interface Bus Operation During Bus Acknowledge Cycles
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Bus Arbiter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
100
During bus acknowledge cycles, the Memory and I/O Chip Select logic is controlled by the external address bus and external IORQ and MREQ signals.
The following Chip Select features are not available during bus acknowledge
cycles:
1. The Chip Select logic does not insert wait states during bus acknowledge
cycles regardless of the WAIT configuration for the decoded Chip Select.
2. The bus mode controller does not function during bus acknowledge cycles.
3. Internal registers and memory addresses in the eZ80F91 device are not
accessible during bus acknowledge cycles.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Bus Arbiter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
101
Random Access Memory
The eZ80F91 device features 8 KB (8192 bytes) of single-port data Random
Access Memory (RAM) for general-purpose use and 8 KB of RAM for the Ethernet
MAC. RAM can be enabled or disabled, and it can be relocated to the top of any
64 KB page in memory. Data is passed to and from RAM via the 8-bit data bus.
On-chip RAM operates with zero wait states. EMAC RAM is accessed via the bus
arbiter and can execute with zero or one wait states.
General-purpose RAM occupies memory addresses in the RAM Address Upper
Byte register, in the range {RAM_ADDR_U[7:0], E000h} to {RAM_ADDR_U[7:0],
FFFFh}. EMAC RAM occupies memory addresses in the range
{RAM_ADDR_U[7:0], C000h} to {RAM_ADDR_U[7:0], DFFFh}. Following a
RESET, RAM is enabled when RAM_ADDR_U is set to FFh. Figure 21 illustrates
a memory map for on-chip RAM. In this example, RAM_ADDR_U is set to 7Ah.
Figure 21 is not drawn to scale, as RAM occupies only a very small fraction of the
available 16 MB address space.
Memory
Location
FFFFFFh
7AFFFFh
7AE000h
7ADFFFh
8 KB
General-Purpose
RAM
8 KB
EMAC SRAM
RAM_ADDR_U
7Ah
7AC000h
000000h
Figure 21. Example: eZ80F91 On-Chip RAM Memory Addressing
When enabled, on-chip RAM assumes priority over on-chip Flash Memory and
any Memory Chip Selects that can also be enabled in the same address space. If
an address is generated in a range that is covered by both the RAM address
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Random Access Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
102
space and a particular Memory Chip Select address space, the Memory Chip
Select is not activated. On-chip RAM is not accessible to external devices during
bus acknowledge cycles.
RAM Control Registers
RAM Control Register
Internal data RAM can be disabled by clearing the GPRAM_EN bit. The default
upon RESET is for RAM to be enabled. See Table 31.
Table 31. RAM Control Register
(RAM_CTL = 00B4h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
7
GPRAM_EN
0
On-chip general-purpose RAM is disabled.
1
On-chip general-purpose RAM is enabled.
6
ERAM_EN
0
On-chip EMAC RAM is disabled.
1
On-chip EMAC RAM is enabled.
[5:0]
000000 Reserved
PRELIMINARY
Random Access Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
103
RAM Address Upper Byte Register
The RAM_ADDR_U register defines the upper byte of the address for on-chip
RAM. If enabled, RAM addresses assume priority over all Chip Selects. The
external Chip Select signals are not asserted if the corresponding RAM address is
enabled. See Table 32.
Table 32. RAM Address Upper Byte Register
(RAM_ADDR_U = 00B5h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
00h–
RAM_ADDR_U FFh
PS019209-0504
This byte defines the upper byte of the RAM address. When
enabled, the general-purpose RAM address space ranges
from {RAM_ADDR_U, E000h} to {RAM_ADDR_U, FFFFh}.
When enabled, the EMAC RAM address space ranges from
{RAM_ADDR_U, C000h} to {RAM_ADDR_U, DFFFh}.
PRELIMINARY
Random Access Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
104
MBIST Control
There are two Memory Built-In Self-Test (MBIST) controllers for the RAM blocks
on the eZ80F91. MBIST_GPR is for General Purpose RAM and MBIST_EMR is
for EMAC RAM. Writing a 1 to MBIST_ON starts the MBIST testing. Writing a 0 to
MBIST_ON stops the MBIST testing. Upon completion of the MBIST testing,
MBIST_ON is automatically reset to 0. If RAM passes MBIST testing,
MBIST_PASS is 1. The value in MBIST_PASS is only valid when MBIST_DONE
is High. See Table 33.
Table 33. MBIST Control Register
(MBIST_GPR = 00B6h, MBIST_EMR = 00B7h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
7
MBIST_ON
0
MBIST Testing of the RAM is disabled.
1
MBIST Testing of the RAM is enabled.
6
MBIST_DONE
0
MBIST Testing has not completed.
1
MBIST Testing has completed.
5
MBIST_PASS
0
MBIST Testing has failed.
1
MBIST Testing has passed.
[4:0]
00000
Reserved
PRELIMINARY
Random Access Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
105
Flash Memory
Flash Memory Arrangement in the eZ80F91 Device
The eZ80F91 device features 256 KB (262,144 bytes) of nonvolative Flash memory with Read/Write/Erase capability. The main Flash memory array is arranged in
128 pages with 8 rows per page and 256 bytes per row. In addition to main Flash
memory, there are two separately-addressable rows which comprise a 512-byte
information page.
256 KB of main storage can be protected in eight 32 KB blocks. Protecting a 32 KB
block prevents Write or Erase operations. The lower 32 KB block (00000h–
07FFFh) can be protected using the external WP pin. This portion of memory is
called the Boot Block because the CPU always starts executing code from this
location at startup. If the application requires external program memory, then the
Boot Block must at least contain a jump instruction to move the Program Counter
outside of the Flash memory space.
The Flash memory arrangement is illustrated in Figure 22.
8
32 KB blocks
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
16
2 KB pages
per block
8
256-byte rows
per page
F
7
E
D
6
C
B
5
A
9
4
8
7
3
6
5
2
4
3
1
2
1
0
0
256
single-byte columns
per row
255 254
1
0
Figure 22. eZ80F91 Flash Memory Arrangement
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
106
Flash Memory Overview
The eZ80F91 device includes a Flash memory controller that automatically converts standard CPU Read and Write cycles to the specific protocol required for the
Flash memory array. As such, standard memory Read and Write instructions
access the Flash memory array as if it is internal RAM. The controller also supports I/O access to the Flash memory array, in effect presenting it as an indirectlyaddressable bank of I/O registers. These access methods are also supported via
the ZDI and OCI interfaces.
In addition, eZ80Acclaim! Flash Microcontrollers support a Flash Read–While–
Write methodology. In essence, the eZ80® CPU can continue to read and execute
code from an area of Flash memory while a nonconflicting area of Flash memory
is being programmed.
The Flash memory controller contains a frequency divider, a Flash register interface, and a Flash control state machine. A simplified block diagram of the Flash
controller is illustrated in Figure 23.
Clock Divider
8-bit downcounter
System Clock
eZ80 Core
Interface
ADDR
DOUT
17
8
FADDR
17
FDIN
8
FCNTL
Flash
MAIN_INFO
State
Machine
9
FDOUT
8
Flash
256 KB
+
512 bytes
Flash
Control
Registers
CPUD OUT
8
FLASH_IRQ
Figure 23. Flash Memory Block Diagram
Reading Flash Memory
The main Flash memory array can be read using both Memory and I/O operations. As an auxiliary storage area, the information page is only accessible via I/O
operations. In all cases, wait states are automatically inserted to allow for read
access time.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
107
Memory Read
A memory Read operation uses the address bus and data bus of the eZ80F91
device to read a single data byte from Flash memory. This Read operation is similar to reads from RAM. To perform Flash memory reads, the FLASH_CTRL register must be configured to enable memory access to Flash with the appropriate
number of wait states. See Table 37 on page 113.
Only the main area of Flash memory is accessible via memory reads. The information page must be read using I/O access.
I/O Read
A single-byte I/O Read operation uses I/O registers for setting the column, page,
and row address to be read. A Read of the FLASH_DATA register returns the contents of Flash memory at the designated address. Each access to the
FLASH_DATA register causes an autoincrement of the Flash address stored in
the Flash address registers (FLASH_PAGE, FLASH_ROW, FLASH_COL). To
allow for Flash memory access time, the FLASH_CTRL register must be configured with the appropriate number of wait states. See Table 37 on page 113.
Programming Flash Memory
Flash memory is programmed using standard I/O or memory Write operations that
the Flash memory controller automatically translates to the detailed timing and
protocol required for Flash memory. The more efficient multibyte (row) programming mode is only available via I/O Writes.
Note: To ensure data integrity and device reliability, two main restrictions exist on programming of Flash memory:
1. The cumulative programming time since the last erase cannot exceed 31 ms
for any given row.
2. The same byte cannot be programmed more than twice since the last erase.
Single-Byte I/O Write
A single-byte I/O Write operation uses I/O registers for setting the column, page,
and row address to be written. The FLASH_DATA register stores the data to be
written. While the CPU executes an I/O instruction to load the data into the
FLASH_DATA register, the Flash controller asserts the internal WAIT signal to
stall the CPU until the Flash Write operation is complete. A single-byte Write takes
between 66 µs and 85 µs to complete. Programming an entire row (256 bytes)
using single-byte Writes therefore takes no more than 21.8 ms. This duration of
time does not include the time required by the CPU to transfer data to the registers, which is a function of the instructions employed and the system clock frequency. Each access to the FLASH_DATA register causes an autoincrement of
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
108
the Flash address stored in the Flash Address registers (FLASH_PAGE,
FLASH_ROW, FLASH_COL).
A typical sequence that performs a single-byte I/O Write is shown below. Because
the Write is self-timed, Step 2 of the sequence can be repeated back-to-back
without requiring polling or interrupts.
1. Write the FLASH_PAGE, FLASH_ROW, and FLASH_COL registers with the
address of the byte to be written.
2. Write the data value to the FLASH_DATA register.
Multibyte I/O Write (Row Programming)
Multibyte I/O Write operations use the same I/O registers as single-byte Writes.
Multibyte I/O Writes allow the programming of a full row and are enabled by setting the ROW_PGM bit of the Flash Program Control Register. For multibyte I/O
Writes, the CPU sets the address registers, enables row programming, and then
executes an I/O instruction (with repeat) to load the block of data into the
FLASH_DATA register. For each individual byte written to the FLASH_DATA register during the block move, the Flash controller asserts the internal WAIT signal
to stall the CPU until the current byte is programmed. Each access to the
FLASH_DATA register causes an autoincrement of the Flash address stored in
the Flash Address registers (FLASH_PAGE, FLASH_ROW, FLASH_COL).
During row programming, the Flash controller continuously asserts the Flash
memory’s high voltage signal until all bytes are programmed (column address <
255). As a result, the row programs more quickly than if the high-voltage signal is
toggled for each byte. The per-byte programming time during row programming is
between 41 µs and 52 µs. As such, programming 256 bytes of a row in this mode
takes no more than 13.4 ms, leaving 17.6 ms for CPU instruction overhead to fetch
the 256 bytes.
A typical sequence that performs a multibyte I/O Write is shown below.
1. Check the FLASH_IRQ register to ensure that any previous row program is
completed.
2. Write the FLASH_PAGE, FLASH_ROW, and FLASH_COL registers with the
address of the first byte to be written.
3. Set the ROW_PGM bit in the FLASH_PGCTL register to enable row
programming mode.
4. Write the next data value to the FLASH_DATA register.
5. If the end of the row has not been reached, return to Step 4.
During row programming, software must monitor the row time-out error bit either
by enabling this interrupt or via polling. If a row time-out occurs, the Flash control-
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
109
ler aborts the row programming operation, and software must assure that no further Writes are performed to the row without it first being erased. It is suggested
that row programming only be used one time per row and not in combination with
single-byte Writes to the same row without first erasing it. Otherwise, the burden
is on software to ensure that the 31 ms maximum cumulative programming time
between erases is not exceeded for a row.
Memory Write
A single-byte memory Write operation uses the address bus and data bus of the
eZ80F91 device for programming a single data byte to Flash memory. While the
CPU executes a Load instruction, the Flash controller asserts the internal WAIT
signal to stall the CPU until the Write is complete. A single-byte Write takes
between 66 µs and 85 µs to complete. Programming an entire row using memory
Writes therefore takes no more than 21.8 ms. This duration of time does not
include time required by the CPU to transfer data to the registers, which is a function of the instructions employed and the system clock frequency.
The memory Write function does not support multibyte row programming.
Because memory Writes are self-timed, they can be performed back-to-back without requiring polling or interrupts.
Erasing Flash Memory
Erasing bytes in Flash memory returns them to a value of FFh. Both the MASS
and PAGE ERASE operations are self-timed by the Flash controller, leaving the
CPU free to execute other operations in parallel. The DONE status bit in the Flash
Interrupt Control Register can be polled by software or used as an interrupt
source to signal completion of an Erase operation. If the CPU attempts to access
Flash memory while an erase is in progress, the Flash controller forces a wait
state until the Erase operation is completed.
Mass Erase
Performing a MASS ERASE operation on Flash memory erases all bits contained
in Flash, including the information page. This self-timed operation takes approximately 200 ms to complete.
Page Erase
The smallest erasable unit in Flash memory is a page. The pages to be erased,
whether they are the 128 main Flash memory pages or the information page, is
determined by the setting of the FLASH_PAGE register. This self-timed operation
takes approximately 10 ms to complete.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
110
Information Page Characteristics
As noted earlier, the information page is not accessible using memory access
instructions and must be accessed via the I/O register. The Flash Page Select
Register contains a bit which selects the information page for I/O access.
There are two ways to erase the information page. The user can execute a MASS
ERASE operation, or the user can configure the Flash Page Select Register to
select the information page, and then execute a PAGE ERASE.
Flash Control Registers
The Flash Control Register interface contains all of the registers used in Flash
memory. The definitions in this section describe each register.
Flash Key Register
Writing the two-byte sequence B6h, 49h in immediate succession to this register
unlocks the Flash Divider and Flash Write/Erase Protection registers. If these values are not written by consecutive CPU I/O Writes (I/O reads and memory Read/
Writes have no effect), the Flash Divider and Flash Write/Erase Protection registers remain locked. This prevents accidental overwrites of these critical Flash control register settings. Writing a value to either the Flash Frequency Divider register
or the Flash Write/Erase Protection register automatically relocks both of the registers. See Table 34.
Table 34. Flash Key Register
(FLASH_KEY = 00F5h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
FLASH_KEY
B6h,
49h
Sequential Write operations of the values B6h, 49h to this
register will unlock the Flash Frequency Divider and Flash
Write/Erase Protection registers.
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
111
Flash Data Register
The Flash Data register stores the data values to be programmed into Flash
memory via I/O Write operations. An I/O Read of the Flash Data register returns
data from Flash memory. The Flash memory address used for I/O access is determined by the contents of the page, row, and column registers. Each access to the
FLASH_DATA register causes an autoincrement of the Flash address stored in
the Flash Address registers (FLASH_PAGE, FLASH_ROW, FLASH_COL). See
Table 35.
Table 35. Flash Data Register
(FLASH_DATA = 00F6h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
FLASH_DATA
00hFFh
Data value to be written to Flash memory during an I/O Write
operation, or the data value that is read in Flash memory,
indicated by the Flash Address registers (FLASH_PAGE,
FLASH_ROW, FLASH_COL).
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
112
Flash Address Upper Byte Register
The FLASH_ADDR_U register defines the upper 6 bits of the Flash memory
address space. Changing the value of FLASH_ADDR_U allows on-chip 256 KB
Flash memory to be mapped to any location within the 16 MB linear address
space of the eZ80F91 device. If on-chip Flash memory is enabled, the Flash
address assumes priority over any external Chip Selects. The external Chip
Select signals are not asserted if the corresponding Flash address is enabled.
Internal Flash memory does not hold priority over internal SRAM. See Table 36.
Table 36. Flash Address Upper Byte Register
(FLASH_ADDR_U = 00F7h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
[7:2]
00h–
FLASH_ADDR_U FCh
These bits define the upper byte of the Flash address. When
on-chip Flash is enabled, the Flash address space begins at
address {FLASH_ADDR_U, 00b, 0000h}. On-chip Flash has
priority over all external Chip Selects.
[1:0]
Reserved (enforces alignment on a 256KB boundary).
00
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
113
Flash Control Register
The Flash Control register enables or disables memory access to Flash memory.
I/O access to the Flash control registers and to Flash memory is still possible
while Flash memory space access is disabled.
The minimum access time of internal Flash memory is 60 ns. The Flash Control
Register must be configured to provide the appropriate number of wait states
based on the system clock frequency of the eZ80F91 device. Because the maximum SCLK frequency is 50 MHZ (20 ns), the default upon RESET is for four wait
states to be inserted for Flash memory access (Flash memory access + one eZ80
Bus Cycle = 60 ns + 20 ns = 80 ns; 80 ns ÷ 20 ns = 4 wait states). See Table 37.
Table 37. Flash Control Register
(FLASH_CTRL = 00F8h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
[7:5]
FLASH_WAIT
PS019209-0504
Value Description
000
0 wait states are inserted when the Flash is active.
001
1 wait state is inserted when the Flash is active.
010
2 wait states are inserted when the Flash is active.
011
3 wait states are inserted when the Flash is active.
100
4 wait states are inserted when the Flash is active.
101
5 wait states are inserted when the Flash is active.
110
6 wait states are inserted when the Flash is active.
111
7 wait states are inserted when the Flash is active.
[4]
0
Reserved
[3]
FLASH_EN
0
Flash memory access is disabled.
1
Flash memory access is enabled.
[2:0]
000
Reserved
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
114
Flash Frequency Divider Register
The 8-bit frequency divider allows the programming of Flash memory over a
range of system clock frequencies. Flash can be programmed with system clock
frequencies ranging from 154 kHz to 50 MHz. The Flash controller requires an
input clock with a period that falls within the range of 5.1−6.5 µs. The period of the
Flash controller clock is set in the Flash Frequency Divider Register. Writes to this
register are allowed only after it is unlocked via the FLASH_KEY register. The
Flash Frequency Divider Register value required vs. the system clock frequency
is shown in Table 38. System clock frequencies outside of the ranges shown are
not supported. Register values for the Flash Frequency Divider are shown in
Table 39.
Table 38. Flash Frequency Divider Values
System Clock Frequency
Flash Frequency Divider Value
154–196 kHz
1
308–392 kHz
2
462–588 kHz
3
616 kHz–50 MHz
CEILING [System Clock Frequency (MHz) x 5.1 (µs)]*
Note: *The CEILING function rounds fractional values up to the next whole number. For example,
CEILING(3.01) is 4.
Table 39. Flash Frequency Divider Register
(FLASH_FDIV = 00F9h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only. *Key sequence required to enable Writes
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
FLASH_FDIV
01h–
FFh
Divider value for generating the required 5.1-6.5 µs Flash
controller clock period.
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
115
Flash Write/Erase Protection Register
The Flash Write/Erase Protection register prevents accidental Write or Erase
operations. The protection is limited to a resolution of eight 32 KB blocks. Setting a
bit to 1 protects that 32 KB block of Flash memory from accidental Writes or
erases. The default upon RESET is for all Flash memory blocks to be protected.
The WP pin works in conjunction with FLASH_PROT[0] to protect the lowest
block (also called the Boot Block) of Flash memory. If either the WP is held
asserted or FLASH_PROT[0] is set, the Boot Block is protected from Write and
Erase operations.
Note: A protect bit is not available for the information page. The information page is,
however, protected from a MASS ERASE if any pages are protected in
FLASH_PROT or WP is asserted.
Writes to this register are allowed only after it is unlocked via the FLASH_KEY
register. Any attempted Writes to this register while locked will set it to FFh,
thereby protecting all blocks. See Table 40.
Table 40. Flash Write/Erase Protection Register
(FLASH_PROT = 00FAh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write if unlocked, R = Read Only if locked. *Key sequence required to unlock.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7]
BLK7_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 38000h to 3FFFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 38000h to 3FFFFh.
[6]
BLK6_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 30000h to 37FFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 30000h to 37FFFh.
[5]
BLK5_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 28000h to 2FFFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 28000h to 2FFFFh.
[4]
BLK4_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 20000h to 27FFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 20000h to 27FFFh.
Note: The lower 32 KB block (00000h to 07FFFh—BLK0) is called the Boot Block and can be
protected using the external WP pin.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
116
Bit
Position
Value Description
[3]
BLK3_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 18000h to 1FFFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 18000h to 1FFFFh.
[2]
BLK2_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 10000h to 17FFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 10000h to 17FFFh.
[1]
BLK1_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 08000h to 0FFFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 08000h to 0FFFFh.
[0]
BLK0_PROT
0
Disable Write/Erase Protect on block 00000h to 07FFFh.
1
Enable Write/Erase Protect on block 00000h to 07FFFh.
Note: The lower 32 KB block (00000h to 07FFFh—BLK0) is called the Boot Block and can be
protected using the external WP pin.
Flash Interrupt Control Register
There are two sources of interrupts from the Flash controller. These two sources
are:
•
•
Page Erase, Mass Erase, or Row Program completed successfully.
An error condition occurred
Either or both of these two interrupt sources can be enabled by setting the appropriate bits in the Flash Interrupt Control register.
The Flash Interrupt Control register contains four status bits to indicate the following error conditions:
Row Program Time-Out. This bit signals a time-out during Row Programming. If
the current row program operation does not complete within 4864 Flash controller
clocks, the Flash controller terminates the row program operation by clearing bit 2
of the Flash Program Control Register and setting the RP_TM0 error bit to 1.
Write Violation. This bit indicates an attempt to write to a protected block of Flash
memory (the Write was not performed).
Page Erase Violation. This bit indicates an attempt to erase a protected block of
Flash memory (the requested page was not erased).
Mass Erase Violation. This bit indicates an attempt to MASS ERASE when there
are one or more protected blocks in Flash memory (the MASS ERASE was not
performed).
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
117
If the error condition interrupt is enabled, any of these four error conditions result
in an interrupt request being sent to the eZ80F91device’s interrupt controller.
Reading the Flash Interrupt Control register clears all error condition flags and the
DONE flag. See Table 41.
Table 41. Flash Interrupt Control Register
(FLASH_IRQ = 00FBh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only. Read resets bits [5] and [3:0].
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7]
DONE_IEN
0
Flash Erase/Row Program Done Interrupt is disabled.
1
Flash Erase/Row Program Done Interrupt is enabled.
[6]
ERR_IEN
0
Error Condition Interrupt is disabled.
1
Error Condition Interrupt is enabled.
[5]
DONE
0
Erase/Row Program Done Flag is not set.
1
Erase/Row Program Done Flag is set.
[4]
0
Reserved.
[3]
WR_VIO
0
The Write Violation Error Flag is not set.
1
The Write Violation Error Flag is set.
[2]
RP_TMO
0
The Row Program Time-Out Error Flag is not set.
1
The Row Program Time-Out Error Flag is set.
[1]
PG_VIO
0
The Page Erase Violation Error Flag is not set.
1
The Page Erase Violation Error Flag is set.
[0]
MASS_VIO
0
The Mass Erase Violation Error Flag is not set.
1
The Mass Erase Violation Error Flag is set.
Note: The lower 32 KB block (00000h to 07FFFh) is called the Boot Block and can be protected
using the external WP pin. Attempts to page erase BLK0 or mass erase Flash when WP is
asserted result in failure and signal an erase violation.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
118
Flash Page Select Register
The msb of this register is used to select whether I/O Flash access and PAGE
ERASE operations are directed to the 512-byte information page or to the main
Flash memory array. The lower 7 bits are used to select one of the main 128
pages for PAGE ERASE or I/O operations.
To perform a PAGE ERASE, the software must set the proper page value prior to
setting the page erase bit in the Flash Control Register. In addition, each access
to the FLASH_DATA register causes an autoincrement of the Flash address
stored in the Flash Address registers (FLASH_PAGE, FLASH_ROW,
FLASH_COL). See Table 42.
Table 42. Flash Page Select Register
(FLASH_PAGE = 00FCh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
[7]
INFO_EN
0
Flash I/O access to main Flash memory.
1
Flash I/O access to the information page. PAGE ERASE and
MASS ERASE operations only affect the information page.
[6:0]
FLASH_PAGE
00h–
FFh
Page address of Flash memory to be used during the PAGE
ERASE or I/O access of main Flash memory. When INFO_EN
is set to 1, this field is ignored.
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
119
Flash Row Select Register
The Flash Row Select Register is a 3-bit value used to define one of the 8 rows of
Flash on a single page. This register is used for all I/O access to Flash memory. In
addition, each access to the FLASH_DATA register causes an autoincrement of
the Flash address stored in the Flash Address registers (FLASH_PAGE,
FLASH_ROW, FLASH_COL). See Table 43.
Table 43. Flash Row Select Register
(FLASH_ROW = 00FDh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:3]
00h
Reserved.
[2:0]
0h–7h Row address of Flash memory to be used during an I/O access
FLASH_ROW
of Flash memory. When INFO_EN is 1 in the Flash Page
Select Register, values for this field are restricted to 0h–1h,
which selects between the two rows in the information page.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
120
Flash Column Select Register
The Flash Column Select Register is an 8-bit value used to define one of the 256
bytes of Flash memory contained in a single row. This register is used for all I/O
access to Flash memory. In addition, each access to the FLASH_DATA register
causes an autoincrement of the Flash address stored in the Flash Address registers (FLASH_PAGE, FLASH_ROW, FLASH_COL). See Table 44.
Table 44. Flash Column Select Register
(FLASH_COL = 00FEh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
FLASH_COL
00h–
FFh
Column address of Flash memory to be used during an I/O
access of Flash memory.
Flash Program Control Register
The Flash Program Control Register is used to perform the functions of MASS
ERASE, PAGE ERASE, and ROW PROGRAM.
MASS ERASE and PAGE ERASE are self-clearing functions. MASS ERASE
requires approximately 200 ms to erase the full 256 KB of main Flash and the 512byte information page. PAGE ERASE requires approximately 10 ms to erase a
2 KB page. Upon completion of either a MASS ERASE or PAGE ERASE, the
value of each corresponding bit is reset to 0.
While Flash is being erased, any Read or Write access to Flash forces the CPU
into a wait state until the Erase operation is complete and the Flash can be
accessed. Reads and Writes to areas other than Flash memory can proceed as
usual while an Erase operation is underway.
During row programming, any reads of Flash memory force a WAIT condition until
the row programming operation completes or times out. See Table 45.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
121
Table 45. Flash Program Control Register
(FLASH_PGCTL = 00FFh)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R
5
0
R
4
0
R
3
0
R
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:3]
00h
Reserved.
[2]
ROW_PGM
0
Row Program Disable or Row Program completed.
1
Row Program Enable. This bit automatically resets to 0 when
the row address reaches 256 or when the Row Program
operation times out.
[1]
PG_ERASE
0
Page Erase Disable (Page Erase completed).
1
Page Erase Enable. This bit automatically resets to 0 when
the PAGE ERASE operation is complete.
[0]
0
MASS_ERASE
1
PS019209-0504
Mass Erase Disable (Mass Erase completed).
Mass Erase Enable. This bit automatically resets to 0 when
the MASS ERASE operation is complete.
PRELIMINARY
Flash Memory
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
122
Watch-Dog Timer
Watch-Dog Timer Overview
The Watch-Dog Timer (WDT) helps protect against corrupt or unreliable software,
power faults, and other system-level problems which can place the CPU into
unsuitable operating states. The eZ80F91 WDT features:
•
•
Four programmable time-out periods: 218, 222, 225, and 227 clock cycles
•
A selectable time-out response: a time-out can be configured to generate
either a RESET or a nonmaskable interrupt (NMI)
•
A WDT time-out RESET indicator flag
Three selectable WDT clock sources:
– Internal RC oscillator
– System clock
– Real-Time Clock source (on-chip 32 Khz crystal oscillator or 50/60 Hz
signal)
Figure 24 illustrates a block diagram of the Watch-Dog Timer.
Data[7:0]
Control Register/
Reset Register
WDT_CLK
RTC Clock
System Clock
WDT
Oscillator
28-Bit
Upcounter
WDT Control Logic
Time-out Compare Logic
(WDT_PERIOD)
RESET
®
NMI to eZ80 CPU
Figure 24. Watch-Dog Timer Block Diagram
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Watch-Dog Timer
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
123
Watch-Dog Timer Operation
Enabling and Disabling the WDT
The Watch-Dog Timer is disabled upon a RESET. To enable the WDT, the application program must set WDT_EN, which corresponds to bit 7 of the WDT_CTL register. After WDT_EN is set, no Writes are allowed to the WDT_CTL register. When
enabled, the WDT cannot be disabled, except by a RESET.
Time-Out Period Selection
There are four choices of time-out periods for the WDT—218, 222, 225, and 227
timer clock cycles. The WDT time-out period is defined by the WDT_PERIOD field
of the WDT_CTL register (WDT_CTL[1:0]). The approximate time-out periods for
two different WDT clock sources are listed in Table 46. The approximate time-out
period for the third WDT clock source is listed in Table 47.
Table 46. Watch-Dog Timer Approximate Time-Out Delays
Divider
Value
Time Out
Delay
32.768 KHz Crystal Oscillator
218
8.00 s
32.768 KHz Crystal Oscillator
222
128 s
32.768 KHz Crystal Oscillator
225
1024 s
32.768 KHz Crystal Oscillator
227
4096 s
50 MHz System Clock
218
5.2 ms
50 MHz System Clock
222
83.9 ms
50 MHz System Clock
225
0.67 s
50 MHz System Clock
227
2.68 s
Clock Source
Table 47. Watch-Dog Timer Approximate Time-Out Delays w/ Internal RC Oscillator
Divider
Value
Minimum
Time-Out Delay
Typical
Time-Out Delay
Internal RC Oscillator
218
16s
26 s
Internal RC Oscillator
222
262s
419s
Internal RC Oscillator
225
2100 s
3360s
Internal RC Oscillator
227
8390s
13400s
Clock Source
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Watch-Dog Timer
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
124
RESET Or NMI Generation
A WDT time-out causes a RESET or sends a nonmaskable interrupt (NMI) signal
to the CPU. The default operation is for the WDT to cause a RESET.
If the NMI_OUT bit in the WDT_CTL register is set to 0, then upon a WDT timeout, the RST_FLAG bit in the WDT_CTL register is set to 1. The RST_FLAG bit
can be polled by the CPU to determine the source of the RESET event.
If the NMI_OUT bit in the WDT_CTL register is set to 1, then upon time-out, the
WDT asserts an NMI for CPU processing. The NMI_FLAG bit can be polled by the
CPU to determine the source of the NMI event.
Watch-Dog Timer Registers
Watch-Dog Timer Control Register
The Watch-Dog Timer Control register, detailed in Table 48, is an 8-bit Read/Write
register used to enable the Watch-Dog Timer, set the time-out period, indicate the
source of the most recent RESET or NMI, and select the required operation upon
WDT time-out.
The default clock source for the Watch-Dog Timer is the WDT oscillator
(WDT_CLK = 10b). To power-down the WDT oscillator, another clock source must
be selected. The power-up sequence of the WDT oscillator takes approximately
20 ms.
Table 48. Watch-Dog Timer Control Register
(WDT_CTL = 0093h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0/1
0
1
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
7
WDT_EN
0
WDT is disabled.
1
WDT is enabled. When enabled, the WDT cannot be disabled
without a RESET.
6
NMI_OUT
0
WDT time-out resets the CPU.
1
WDT time-out generates a nonmaskable interrupt (NMI) to the
CPU.
PRELIMINARY
Watch-Dog Timer
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
125
Bit
Position
Value Description
5
RST_FLAG
0
RESET caused by external full-chip reset or ZDI reset.
1
RESET caused by WDT time-out. This flag is set by the WDT
time-out, only if the NMI_OUT flag is set to 0. The CPU can
poll this bit to determine the source of the RESET. This flag is
cleared by a non-WDT generated reset.
4
NMI_FLAG
0
NMI caused by external source.
1
NMI caused by WDT time-out. This flag is set by the WDT
time-out, only if the NMI_OUT flag is set to 1. The CPU can
poll this bit to determine the source of the NMI. This flag is
cleared by a non-WDT NMI.
[3:2]
WDT_CLK
00
WDT clock source is system clock.
01
WDT clock source is Real-Time Clock source (32KHz on-chip
oscillator or 50/60Hz input as set by RTC_CTRL[4]).
10
WDT clock source is internal RC oscillator (10KHz typical).
11
Reserved
00
WDT time-out period is 227 clock cycles.
01
WDT time-out period is 225 clock cycles.
10
WDT time-out period is 222 clock cycles.
11
WDT time-out period is 218 clock cycles.
[1:0]
WDT_PERIOD
Note: When the WDT is enabled, no Writes are allowed to the WDT_CTL register.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Watch-Dog Timer
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
126
Watch-Dog Timer Reset Register
The Watch-Dog Timer Reset register, detailed in Table 49, is an 8-bit Write Only
register. The Watch-Dog Timer is reset when an A5h value followed by a 5Ah value
is written to this register. Any amount of time can occur between the writing of the
A5h value and the 5Ah value, so long as the WDT time-out does not occur prior to
completion. Any value other than 5Ah written to the Watch-Dog Timer Reset register after the A5h value requires that the sequence of Writes (A5h,5Ah) be restarted
for the timer to be reset.
Table 49. Watch-Dog Timer Reset Register
(WDT_RR = 0094h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: X = Undefined; W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
WDT_RR
PS019209-0504
Value Description
A5h
The first Write value required to reset the WDT prior to a timeout.
5Ah
The second Write value required to reset the WDT prior to a
time-out. If an A5h,5Ah sequence is written to WDT_RR, the
WDT timer is reset to its initial count value, and counting
resumes.
PRELIMINARY
Watch-Dog Timer
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
127
Programmable Reload Timers
Programmable Reload Timers Overview
The eZ80F91 device features four programmable reload timers. The core of each
timer is a 16-bit downcounter. In addition, each timer features a selectable clock
source, adjustable prescaling and can operate in either SINGLE PASS or CONTINUOUS mode.
In addition to the basic timer functionality, some of the timers support specialty
modes that perform event counting, input capture, output compare, and PWM
generation functions. PWM mode supports four individually-configurable outputs
and a power trip function.
Each of the 4 timers available on the eZ80F91 device can be controlled individually. They do not share the same counters, reload registers, control registers, or
interrupt signals. A simplified block diagram of a programmable reload timer is
illustrated in Figure 25.
Each timer features its own interrupt, which is triggered either by the timer reaching zero or after a successful comparison occurs. As with the other eZ80F91 interrupts, the priority is fully programmable.
Input Capture
Registers
CONTROL
R
E
L
O
A
D
16-Bit
Down Counter
ICx
Comparator
OCx
16
16
DIV
SCLK
Output Compare
Registers
M
U
X
RTC CLK
ECx
EOC
IC
PWM
OC PWR Trip
PWM
Control
PWM
IRQ Control
IRQ
Figure 25. Programmable Reload Timer Block Diagram
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
128
Basic Timer Operation
Basic timer operation is controlled by a timer control register and a programmable
reload value. The CPU uses the control register to set up the prescaling, the input
clock source, the end-of-count behavior, and to start the timer. The 16-bit reload
value is used to determine the duration of the timer’s count before either halting or
reloading.
After choosing a timer period and writing the appropriate values to the reload registers, the CPU must set the timer enable bit (TMRx_CTL[TIM_EN]), allowing the
count to begin. The reload bit (TMRx_CTL[RLD]) should also be asserted so that
the timer counts down from the reload value, rather than from 0000h. On the system clock cycle, after the assertion of the reload bit, the timer loads with the 16-bit
reload value and begins counting down. The reload bit is automatically cleared
after the loading operation. The timer can be enabled and reloaded on the same
cycle; however, the timer does not require disabling to reload; reloading can be
performed at any time. It is also possible to halt the timer by deasserting the timer
enable bit and resuming the count at a later time from the same point by reasserting the bit.
Reading the Current Count Value
The CPU can read the current count value while the timer is running. Because the
count is a 16-bit value, the hardware latches the value of the upper byte into temporary storage when the lower byte is read. This value in temporary storage is the
value returned when the upper byte is read. Therefore, the firmware should read
the lower byte first. If it attempts to read the upper byte first, it does not obtain the
current upper byte of the count. Instead, it obtains the last latched value. This
Read operation does not affect timer operation.
Setting Timer Duration
There are three factors to consider when determining Programmable Reload
Timer duration: clock frequency, clock divider ratio, and initial count value. Minimum duration of the timer is achieved by loading 0001h. Maximum duration is
achieved by loading 0000h, because the timer first rolls over to FFFFh, then continues counting down to 0000h before the end-of-count is signaled. Depending
upon the TMRx_CTL[CLK_SEL] bits of the control register, the clock is either the
system clock, the on-chip RC oscillator output or an input from a pin.
The time-out period of the timer is returned by the following equation:
Time-Out Period =
PS019209-0504
Clock Divider Ratio x Reload Value
System Clock Frequency
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
129
To calculate the time-out period with the above equation when using an initial
value of 0000h, enter a reload value of 65536 (FFFFh + 1).
Minimum time-out duration is 4 times longer than the input clock period and is
generated by setting the clock divider ratio to 1:4 and the reload value to 0001h.
Maximum time-out duration is 224 (16,777,216) times longer than the input clock
period, and is generated by setting the clock divider ratio to 1:256 and the reload
value to 0000h.
Single Pass Mode
In SINGLE PASS mode, when the end-of-count value (0000h), is reached, counting halts, the timer is disabled, and the TMRx_CTL[TIM_EN] bit resets to 0. To
reenable the timer, the CPU must set the TIM_EN bit to 1. An example of a PRT
operating in SINGLE PASS mode is illustrated in Figure 26. Timer register information is indicated in Table 50.
System Clock
Clock Enable
TMR3_CTL Write
(Timer Enable)
T3 Count
0
4
3
2
1
0
Interrupt Request
Figure 26. Example: PRT SINGLE PASS Mode Operation
Table 50. Example: PRT SINGLE PASS Mode Parameters
PS019209-0504
Parameter
Control Register(s)
Value
Timer Enable
TMRx_CTL[TIM_EN]
1
Reload
TMRx_CTL[RLD]
1
Prescaler Divider = 4
TMRx_CTL[CLK_DIV]
00b
SINGLE PASS Mode
TMRx_CTL[TIM_CONT]
0
End of Count Interrupt Enable
TMRx_IER[IRQ_EOC_EN]
1
Timer Reload Value
{TMRx_RR_H, TMRx_RR_L}
0004h
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
130
Continuous Mode
In CONTINUOUS mode, when the end-of-count value, 0000h, is reached, the
timer automatically reloads the 16-bit start value from the Timer Reload registers,
TMRx_RR_H and TMRx_RR_L. Downcounting continues on the next clock edge
and the timer continues to count until disabled. An example of the timer operating
in CONTINUOUS mode is illustrated in Figure 27. Timer register information is
indicated in Table 51.
System Clock
Clock Enable
TMR3_CTL Write
(Timer Enable)
T3 Count
X
4
3
2
1
4
3
2
1
Interrupt
Request
Figure 27. Example: PRT CONTINUOUS Mode Operation
Table 51. Example : PRT CONTINUOUS Mode Parameters
Parameter
Control Register(s)
Value
Timer Enable
TMRx_CTL[TIM_EN]
1
Reload
TMRx_CTL[RLD]
1
Prescaler Divider = 4
TMRx_CTL[CLK_DIV]
00b
CONTINUOUS Mode
TMRx_CTL[TIM_CONT]
1
End of Count Interrupt Enable
TMRx_IER[IRQ_EOC_EN]
1
Timer Reload Value
{TMRx_RR_H, TMRx_RR_L}
0004h
Timer Interrupts
The terminal count flag, TMRx_IIR[EOC], is set to 1 whenever the timer reaches
0000h, its end-of-count value in SINGLE PASS mode, or when the timer reloads
the start value in CONTINUOUS mode. The terminal count flag is only set when
the timer reaches 0000h (or reloads) from 0001h. The timer interrupt flag is not set
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
131
to 1 when the timer is loaded with the value 0000h, which selects the maximum
time-out period.
The CPU can be programmed to poll the EOC bit for the time-out event. Alternatively, an interrupt service request signal can be sent to the CPU by setting the
TMRx_IER[EOC] bit to 1. Then, when the end-of-count value (0000h) is reached
and the EOC bit is set to 1, an interrupt service request signal is passed to the
CPU. The interrupt service request signal is deactivated by an CPU Read of the
timer interrupt identification register, TMRx_IIR. All bits in that register are reset by
the Read.
The response of the CPU to this interrupt service request is a function of the
CPU’s interrupt enable flag, IEF1. For more information about this flag, refer to the
eZ80® CPU User Manual (UM0077), which is available on zilog.com.
Timer Input Source Selection
Timers 0–3 feature programmable input source selection. By default, the input is
taken from the eZ80F91’s system clock. The timers can also use the Real-Time
Clock source (50, 60, or 32768 Hz) as their clock sources. The input source for
these timers is set using the timer control register. (TMRx_CTL[CLK_SEL])
Timer Output
The timer count can be directed to the GPIO output pins if required. To enable the
Timer Out feature, the GPIO port pin must be configured as an output and for
alternate functions. The GPIO output pin toggles each time the timer reaches its
end-of-count value. In CONTINUOUS mode operation, enabling the Timer Output
feature results in a Timer Output signal period that is twice the timer time-out
period. Examples of the Timer Output operation are illustrated in Figure 28 and
Table 52. The initial value for the timer output is zero.
Logic to support timer output exists in all timers, but for the eZ80F91 device, only
Timer 0 and 2 route the actual timer output to the pins. Because Timer 3 uses the
TOUT pins for PWMxN signals, the timer outputs are not available when using
complementary PWM outputs. See Table 53 for details.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
132
System Clock
Clock Enable
TMR3_CTL Write
(Timer Enable)
T3 Count
0
4
3
2
1
4
3
2
1
Timer Out
(internal)
Timer Out
(at pad)
Figure 28. Example: PRT Timer Output Operation
Table 52. Example: PRT Timer Out Parameters
Parameter
Control Register(s)
Value
Timer Enable
TMRx_CTL[TIM_EN]
1
Reload
TMRx_CTL[RLD]
1
Prescaler Divider = 4
TMRx_CTL[CLK_DIV]
00b
CONTINUOUS Mode
TMRx_CTL[TIM_CONT]
1
Timer Reload Value
{TMRx_RR_H, TMRx_RR_L}
0003h
Break Point Halting
When the eZ80F91 device is running in DEBUG mode, encountering a break
point causes all CPU functions to halt. By default, however, the timers keep running. This instance can make debugging timer-related firmware much more difficult. Therefore, the control register contains a BRK_STP bit. Setting this bit
causes the count value to be held during debug break points.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
133
Specialty Timer Modes
The features described above are common to all timers in the eZ80F91 device. In
addition to these common features, some of the timers have additional functionality. The following is a list of the special features for each timer.
•
Timer 0
– no special functions
•
Timer 1
– 1 event counter (EC0)
– 2 input captures (IC0 and IC1)
•
Timer 2
– 1 event counter (EC1)
•
Timer 3
– 2 input captures (IC2 and IC3)
– 4 output compares (OC0, OC1, OC2, and OC3)
– 4 PWM outputs (PWM0, PWM1, PWM2, and PWM3)
Timer 3 contains three specialty modes. Each of these modes is enabled using
bits in their respective control registers (TMR3_CAP_CTL, TMR3_OC_CTL1,
TMR3_PWM_CTL1). When PWM mode is enabled, the OUTPUT COMPARE and
INPUT CAPTURE modes are not available. This instance is due to address space
sharing requirements. However, INPUT CAPTURE and OUTPUT COMPARE
modes can run concurrently.
Timers with specialty modes offer multiple ways to generate an interrupt. When
the interrupt controller services a timer interrupt, the firmware must read the
timer’s interrupt identification register (TMRx_IIR) to determine the cause, or
causes, for an interrupt request. This register is cleared each time it is read, allowing subsequent events to be identified without interference from prior events.
Event Counter
When a timer is configured to take its input from a port input pin (ECx), it functions
as an event counter. For event counting, the clock prescaler is automatically
bypassed and edges (events) cause the timer to decrement. The user must select
the rising or the falling edge for counting. Also, the port pins must be configured as
inputs.
Input sampling on the port pins results in the counter being updated on the third
rising edge of the system clock after the edge event occurs at the port pin. Due to
the sampling, the frequency of the event input is limited to one-half the system
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
134
clock frequency under ideal conditions. In practice, the event frequency must be
less than this value, due to duty cycle variation and system clock jitter.
This EVENT COUNT mode is identical to basic timer operation, except for the
clock source. Therefore, interrupts are managed in the same manner.
RTC Oscillator Input
When the timer clock source is the Real-Time Clock signal, the timer functions
just as it does in EVENT COUNT mode, except that it samples the internal RTC
clock rather than the ECx pin.
Input Capture
INPUT CAPTURE mode allows the CPU to determine the timing of specified
events on a set of external pins.
A timer intended for use in INPUT CAPTURE mode is set up the same way as in
BASIC mode, with one exception. The CPU must also write the TMRx_CAP_CTL
register to select the edge on which to capture: rising, falling, or both. When one
of these events occurs on an input capture pin, the current 16 bit timer value is
latched into the capture value register pair (TMRx_CAP_A or TMRx_CAP_B
depending on the IC pin exhibiting the event).
Reading the Low byte of the register pair causes the timer to ignore other capture
events on the associated external pin until the High byte is read. This instance
prevents a subsequent capture event from overwriting the High byte between the
two Reads and generating an invalid capture value. The capture value registers
are Read Only.
A capture flag (ICA or ICB) in the TMRx_IIR register is set whenever a capture
event occurs. Setting the interrupt identification register bit
TMRx_IER[IRQ_ICx_EN] enables the capture event to generate a timer interrupt.
Output Compare
The output compare function reverses the input capture function. Rather than
store a timer value when an external event occurs, OUTPUT COMPARE mode
waits until the timer reaches a specified value, then generates an external event.
Although the same base timer is used, up to four separate external pins can be
driven, each with its own compare value.
To use OUTPUT COMPARE mode, the CPU must first configure the basic timer
parameters. Then it must load up to four 16-bit compare values into the four
TMR3_OCx register pairs. Next, it must load the TMR3_ OC_CTL2 register to
specify the event that occurs upon comparison. The user can select the following
events: SET, CLEAR, and TOGGLE. Finally, the CPU must enable OUTPUT
COMPARE mode by asserting TMR3_OC_CTL1[OC_EN].
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
135
The initial value for the OCx pins in OUTPUT COMPARE mode is 0 by default. It
is possible to initialize this value to 1, or force a value at a later time. Setting the
TMR3_OC_CTL2[OCx_MODE] value to 0 forces the OCx pin to the selected state
provided by the TMR3_OC_CTL1[OCx_INIT] bits. Regardless of any compare
events, the pin stays at the forced value until OCx_MODE is changed. After
release, it retains the forced value until modified by an OUTPUT COMPARE
event.
Asserting TMR3_OC_CTL1[MAST_MODE] selects MASTER MODE for all OUTPUT COMPARE events, and sets output 0 as the master. As a result, outputs 1, 2,
and 3 are caused to disregard output-specific configuration and comparison values and instead mimic the current settings for output 0.
The OCx bits in the TMR3_IIR register are set whenever the corresponding timer
compares occur. TMR3_IER[IRQ_OCx_EN] allows the compare event to generate a timer interrupt.
Timer Port Pin Allocation
The eZ80F91 device timers interface to the outside world via Ports A and B.
These ports are also used for general purpose I/O as well as other assorted functions. Table 53 lists the timer pins and their respective functions.
Table 53. GPIO Mode Selection When Using Timer Pins
Timer Function
PS019209-0504
Port
GPIO Port
Bits
GPIO Port
Mode
PWM_CTL1
MPWM_EN = 0
PWM_CTL1
MPWM_EN = 1
A
PA0
7
OC0
PWM0
PA1
7
OC1
PWM1
PA2
7
OC2
PWM2
PA3
7
OC3
PWM3
PWM_CTL1
PAIR_EN = 0
PWM_CTL1
PAIR_EN = 1
PA4
7
TOUT0
PWM0
PA5
7
TOUT1
PWM1
PA6
7
EC1
PWM2
PA7
7
PRELIMINARY
PWM3
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
136
Table 53. GPIO Mode Selection When Using Timer Pins (Continued)
Timer Function
Port
GPIO Port
Bits
GPIO Port
Mode
PWM_CTL1
MPWM_EN = 0
PWM_CTL1
MPWM_EN = 1
B
PB0
7
IC0/EC0
PB1
7
IC1
PB4
7
IC2
PB5
7
IC3
Timer Registers
The CPU monitors and controls the timer using seven 8-bit registers. These registers are the control register, the interrupt identification register, the interrupt
enable register and the reload register pair (High and Low byte). There are also a
pair of data registers used to read the current timer count value.
The variable x can be 0, 1, 2, or 3 to represent each of the 4 available timers.
Basic Timer Register Set
Each timer requires a different set of registers for configuration and control. However, all timers contain the following seven registers, each of which is necessary
for basic operation:
•
•
•
•
•
Timer Control Register (TMRx_CTL)
Interrupt Identification Register (TMRx_IIR)
Interrupt Enable Register (TMRx_IER)
Timer Data Registers (TMRx_DR_H and TMRx_DR_L)
Timer Reload Registers (TMRx_RR_H and TMRx_RR_L)
The Timer Data Register is Read Only, while the Timer Reload Register is Write
Only. The address space for these two registers is shared.
Register Set for Capture in Timer 1
In addition to the basic register set, Timer 1 uses the following five registers for its
INPUT CAPTURE mode:
•
•
PS019209-0504
Capture Control Register (TMR1_CAP_CTL)
Capture Value Registers (TMR1_CAP_B_H, TMR1_CAP_B_L,
TMR1_CAP_A_H, TMR1_CAP_A_L)
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
137
Register Set for Capture/Compare/PWM in Timer 3
In addition to the basic register set, Timer 3 uses 19 registers for INPUT CAPTURE, OUTPUT COMPARE, and PWM modes. PWM and capture/compare functions cannot be used concurrently, so their register address space is shared.
INPUT CAPTURE and OUTPUT COMPARE can be used concurrently—their
address space is not shared.
The INPUT CAPTURE mode registers are equivalent to those used in Timer 1
above (substitute TMR3 for TMR1).
OUTPUT COMPARE mode uses the following nine registers:
•
Output Compare Control Registers
– TMR3_OC_CTL1
– TMR3_OC_CTL2
•
Compare Value Registers
– TMR3_OC3_H
– TMR3_OC3_L
– TMR3_OC2_H
– TMR3_OC2_L
– TMR3_OC1_H
– TMR3_OC1_L
– TMR3_OC0_H
– TMR3_OC0_L
Multiple PWM mode uses the following 19 registers:
PS019209-0504
•
PWM Control Registers
– TMR3_PWM_CTL1
– TMR3_PWM_CTL2
– TMR3_PWM_CTL3
•
PWM Rising Edge Values
– TMR3_PWM3R_H
– TMR3_PWM3R_L
– TMR3_PWM2R_H
– TMR3_PWM2R_L
– TMR3_PWM1R_H
– TMRx_PWM1R_L
– TMR3_PWM0R_H
– TMR3_PWM0R_L
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
138
•
PWM Falling Edge Values
– TMR3_PWM3F_H
– TMRx_PWM3F_L
– TMR3_PWM2F_H
– TMR3_PWM2F_L
– TMR3_PWM1F_H
– TMR3_PWM1F_L
– TMR3_PWM0F_H
– TMR3_PWM0F_L
Timer Control Register
The Timer x Control Register, detailed in Table 54, is used to control operation of
the timer, including enabling the timer, selecting the clock source, selecting the
clock divider, selecting between CONTINUOUS and SINGLEPASS modes, and
enabling the auto-reload feature.
Table 54. Timer Control Register
(TMR0_CTL = 0060h, TMR1_CTL = 0065h, TMR2_CTL = 006Fh, TMR3_CTL = 0074h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
7
0
BRK_STOP
1
The timer continues to operate during debug break points.
[6:5]
CLK_SEL
00
Timer source is the system clock divided by the prescaler.
01
Timer source is the Real Time Clock Input.
10
Timer source is the Event Count (ECx) input—falling edge.
For Timer 1 this is EC0.
For Timer 2, this is EC1.
11
Timer source is the Event Count (ECx) input—rising edge.
For Timer 1 this is EC0.
For Timer 2, this is EC1.
The timer stops operation and holds count value during debug
break points.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
139
[4:3]
CLK_DIV
00
System clock divider = 4.
01
System clock divider = 16.
10
System clock divider = 64.
11
System clock divider = 256.
2
0
TIM_CONT
The timer operates in SINGLE PASS mode. TIM_EN (bit 0) is
reset to 0, and counting stops when the end-of-count value is
reached.
1
The timer operates in CONTINUOUS mode. The timer reload
value is written to the counter when the end-of-count value is
reached.
1
RLD
0
Reload function is not forced.
1
Force reload. When a 1 is written to this bit, the values in the
reload registers are loaded into the downcounter.
0
TIM_EN
0
The programmable reload timer is disabled.
1
The programmable reload timer is enabled.
Timer Interrupt Enable Register
The Timer x Interrupt Enable Register, detailed in Table 55, is used to control
operation of the timer interrupts. Only bits related to functions present in a given
timer are active.
Table 55. Timer Interrupt Enable
(TMR0_IER = 0061h, TMR1_IER = 0066h, TMR2_IER = 0070h, TMR3_IER = 0075h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Unused.
6
0
IRQ_OC3_EN
Interrupt requests for OC3 are disabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
1
Interrupt requests for OC3 are enabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
140
5
0
IRQ_OC2_EN
Interrupt requests for OC2 are disabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
1
Interrupt requests for OC2 are enabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
4
0
IRQ_OC1_EN
Interrupt requests for OC1 are disabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
1
Interrupt requests for OC1 are enabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
3
0
IRQ_OC0_EN
Interrupt requests for OC0 are disabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
1
Interrupt requests for OC0 are enabled (valid only in
OUTPUT COMPARE mode). OC operations occur in Timer
3.
0
Interrupt requests for ICx are disabled (valid only in INPUT
CAPTURE mode).
Timer 1: the capture pin is IC1.
Timer 3: the capture pin is IC3.
1
Interrupt requests for ICx are enabled (valid only in INPUT
CAPTURE mode).
For Timer 1: the capture pin is IC1.
For Timer 3: the capture pin is IC3.
0
Interrupt requests for ICA or PWM power trip are disabled
(valid only in INPUT CAPTURE and PWM modes).
For Timer 1: the capture pin is IC0.
For Timer 3: the capture pin is IC2.
1
Interrupt requests for ICA or PWM power trip are enabled
(valid only in INPUT CAPTURE and PWM modes).
For Timer 1: the capture pin is IC0.
For Timer 3: the capture pin is IC2.
2
IRQ_ICB_EN
1
IRQ_ICA_EN
0
0
IRQ_EOC_EN
1
PS019209-0504
Interrupt on end-of-count is disabled.
Interrupt on end-of-count is enabled.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
141
Timer Interrupt Identification Register
The TImer x Interrupt Identification Register, detailed in Table 56, is used to flag
timer events so that the CPU can determine the cause of a timer interrupt. This
register is cleared by a CPU Read.
Table 56. Timer Interrupt Identification Register
(TMR0_IIR = 0062h, TMR1_IIR = 0067h, TMR2_IIR = 0071h, TMR3_IIR = 0076h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only;
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Unused.
6
OC3
0
Output compare, OC3, does not occur.
1
Output compare, OC3, occurs.
5
OC3
0
Output compare, OC2, does not occur.
1
Output compare, OC2, occurs.
4
OC1
0
Output compare, OC1, does not occur.
1
Output compare, OC1, occurs.
3
OC0
0
Output compare, OC0, does not occur.
1
Output compare, OC0, occurs.
2
ICB
0
Input capture, ICB, does not occur.
For Timer 1, the capture pin is IC1.
For Timer 3, the capture pin is IC3.
1
Input capture, ICB, occurs.
For Timer 1, the capture pin is IC1.
For Timer 3, the capture pin is IC3.
0
Input capture, ICA, or PWM power trip does not occur.
For Timer 1, the capture pin is IC0.
For Timer 3, the capture pin is IC2.
1
Input capture, ICA, or PWM power trip occurs.
For Timer 1, the capture pin is IC0.
For Timer 3, the capture pin is IC2.
0
End-of-count does not occur.
1
End-of-count occurs.
1
ICA
0
EOC
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
142
Timer Data Register—Low Byte
The Timer x Data Register—Low Byte returns the Low byte of the current count
value of the selected timer. The Timer Data Register—Low Byte, detailed in Table
57, can be read while the timer is in operation. Reading the current count value
does not affect timer operation. To read the 16-bit data of the current count value,
{TMRx_DR_H[7:0], TMRx_DR_L[7:0]}, first read the Timer Data Register—Low
Byte, followed by the Timer Data Register—High Byte. The Timer Data Register—
High Byte value is latched into temporary storage when a Read of the Timer Data
Register—Low Byte occurs.
This register shares its address with the corresponding timer reload register.
Table 57. Timer Data Register—Low Byte
(TMR0_DR_L = 0063h, TMR1_DR_L = 0068h, TMR2_DR_L = 0072h,
TMR3_DR_L = 0077h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMR_DR_L
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte timer data
value, {TMRx_DR_H[7:0], TMRx_DR_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is bit 7
of the 16-bit timer data value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16bit timer data value.
Timer Data Register—High Byte
The Timer x Data Register—High Byte returns the High byte of the count value of
the selected timer as it existed at the time that the Low byte was read. The Timer
Data Register—High Byte, detailed in Table 58, can be read while the timer is in
operation. Reading the current count value does not affect timer operation. To
read the 16-bit data of the current count value, {TMRx_DR_H[7:0],
TMRx_DR_L[7:0]}, first read the Timer Data Register—Low Byte followed by the
Timer Data Register—High Byte. The Timer Data Register—High Byte value is
latched into temporary storage when a Read of the Timer Data Register—Low
Byte occurs.
This register shares its address with the corresponding timer reload register.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
143
Table 58. Timer Data Register—High Byte
(TMR0_DR_H = 0064h, TMR1_DR_H = 0069h, TMR2_DR_H = 0073h,
TMR3_DR_H = 0078h)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R
5
0
R
4
0
R
3
0
R
2
0
R
1
0
R
0
0
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMR_DR_H
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte timer data
value, {TMRx_DR_H[7:0], TMRx_DR_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is bit 15
(msb) of the 16-bit timer data value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit
timer data value.
Timer Reload Register—Low Byte
The Timer x Reload Register—Low Byte, detailed in Table 59, stores the least-significant byte (LSB) of the 2-byte timer reload value. In CONTINUOUS mode, the
timer reload value is reloaded into the timer upon end-of-count. When the reload
bit (TMRx_CTL[RLD]) is set to 1 forcing the reload function, the timer reload value
is written to the timer on the next rising edge of the clock.
This register shares its address with the corresponding timer data register.
Table 59. Timer Reload Register—Low Byte
(TMR0_RR_L = 0063h, TMR1_RR_L = 0068h, TMR2_RR_L = 0072h,
TMR3_RR_L = 0077h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMR_RR_L
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte timer
reload value, {TMRx_RR_H[7:0], TMRx_RR_L[7:0]}. Bit 7
is bit 7 of the 16-bit timer reload value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of
the 16-bit timer reload value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
144
Timer Reload Register—High Byte
The Timer x Reload Register—High Byte, detailed in Table 60, stores the mostsignificant byte (MSB) of the 2-byte timer reload value. In CONTINUOUS mode,
the timer reload value is reloaded into the timer upon end-of-count. When the
reload bit (TMRx_CTL[RLD]) is set to 1, thereby forcing the reload function, the
timer reload value is written to the timer on the next rising edge of the clock.
This register shares its address with the corresponding timer data register.
Table 60. Timer Reload Register—High Byte
(TMR0_RR_H = 0064h, TMR1_RR_H = 0069h, TMR2_RR_H = 0073h,
TMR3_RR_H = 0078h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMR_RR_H
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte timer
reload value, {TMRx_RR_H[7:0], TMRx_RR_L[7:0]}. Bit 7
is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit timer reload value. Bit 0 is bit 8
of the 16-bit timer reload value.
Timer Input Capture Control Register
The Timer x Input Capture Control Register, detailed in Table 61, is used to select
the edge or edges to be captured. For Timer 1, CAP_EDGE_B is used for IC1,
and CAP_EDGE_A is for IC0. For Timer 3, CAP_EDGE_B is for IC3, and
CAP_EDGE_A is for IC2.
Table 61. Timer Input Capture Control Register
(TMR1_CAP_CTL = 006Ah, TMR3_CAP_CTL = 007Bh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:4]
0000
Reserved
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
145
[3:2]
CAP_EDGE_B
[1:0]
CAP_EDGE_A
00
Disable capture on ICB.
01
Enable capture only on the falling edge of ICB.
10
Enable capture only on the rising edge of ICB.
11
Enable capture on both edges of ICB.
00
Disable capture on ICA.
01
Enable capture only on the falling edge of ICA
10
Enable capture only on the rising edge of ICA.
11
Enable capture on both edges of ICA.
Timer Input Capture Value A Register—Low Byte
The Timer x Input Capture Value A Register—Low Byte, detailed in Table 62,
stores the Low byte of the capture value for external input A. For Timer 1, the
external input is IC0. For Timer 3, it is IC2.
Table 62. Timer Input Capture Value Register A—Low Byte
(TMR1_CAPA_L = 006Bh, TMR3_CAPA_L = 007Ch)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMRx_CAPA_L
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte capture
value, {TMRx_CAPA_H[7:0], TMRx_CAPA_L[7:0]}. Bit 7
is bit 7 of the 16-bit data value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16bit timer data value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
146
Timer Input Capture Value A Register—High Byte
The Timer x Input Capture Value A Register—High Byte, detailed in Table 63,
stores the High byte of the capture value for external input A. For Timer 1, the
external input is IC0. For Timer 3, it is IC2.
Table 63. Timer Input Capture Value Register A—High Byte
(TMR1_CAPA_H = 006Ch, TMR3_CAPA_H = 007Dh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
00h–FFh These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte capture
TMRx_CAPA_H
value, {TMRx_CAPA_H[7:0], TMRx_CAPA_L[7:0]}. Bit 7
is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit data value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of the
16-bit timer data value.
Timer Input Capture Value B Register—Low Byte
The Timer x Input Capture Value B Register—Low Byte, detailed in Table 64,
stores the Low byte of the capture value for external input B. For Timer 1, the
external input is IC1. For Timer 3, it is IC3.
Table 64. Timer Input Capture Value Register B—Low Byte
(TMR1_CAPB_L = 006Dh, TMR3_CAPB_L = 007Eh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMRx_CAPB_L
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte capture
value, {TMRx_CAPB_H[7:0], TMRx_CAPB_L[7:0]}. Bit 7
is bit 7 of the 16-bit data value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16bit timer data value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
147
Timer Input Capture Value B Register—High Byte
The Timer x Input Capture Value B Register—High Byte, detailed in Table 65,
stores the High byte of the capture value for external input B. For Timer 1, the
external input is IC0. For Timer 3, it is IC3.
Table 65. Timer Input Capture Value Register B—High Byte
(TMR1_CAPB_H = 006Eh, TMR3_CAPB_H = 007Fh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
00h–FFh These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte capture
TMRx_CAPB_H
value, {TMRx_CAPB_H[7:0], TMRx_CAPB_L[7:0]}. Bit 7
is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit data value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of the
16-bit timer data value.
Timer Output Compare Control Register 1
The Timer3 Output Compare Control Register 1, detailed in Table 66, is used to
select the Master Mode and to provide initial values for the OC pins.
Table 66. Timer Output Compare Control Register 1
(TMR3_OC_CTL1 = 0080h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:6]
00
Unused
5
OC3_INIT
0
OC pin cleared when initialized.
1
OC pin set when initialized.
4
OC2_INIT
0
OC pin cleared when initialized.
1
OC pin set when initialized.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
148
3
OC1_INIT
0
OC pin cleared when initialized.
1
OC pin set when initialized.
2
OC0_INIT
0
OC pin cleared when initialized.
1
OC pin set when initialized.
1
MAST_MODE
0
OC pins are independent.
1
OC pins all mimic OC0.
0
OC_EN
0
OUTPUT COMPARE mode is disabled.
1
OUTPUT COMPARE mode is enabled.
Timer Output Compare Control Register 2
The Timer3 Output Compare Control Register 2, detailed in Table 67, is used to
select the event that will occur on the output compare pins when a timer compare
happens.
Table 67. Timer Output Compare Control Register 2
(TMR3_OC_CTL2 = 0081h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:6]
OC3_MODE
[5:4]
OC2_MODE
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00
Initialize OC pin to value specified in
TMR3_OC_CTL1[OC3_INT].
01
OC pin is cleared upon timer compare.
10
OC pin is set upon timer compare.
11
OC pin toggles upon timer compare.
00
Initialize OC pin to value specified in
TMR3_OC_CTL1[OC2_INT].
01
OC pin is cleared upon timer compare.
10
OC pin is set upon timer compare.
11
OC pin toggles upon timer compare.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
149
[3:2]
OC1_MODE
[1:0]
OC0_MODE
00
Initialize OC pin to value specified in
TMR3_OC_CTL1[OC1_INT].
01
OC pin is cleared upon timer compare.
10
OC pin is set upon timer compare.
11
OC pin toggles upon timer compare.
00
Initialize OC pin to value specified in
TMR3_OC_CTL1[OC0_INT].
01
OC pin is cleared upon timer compare.
10
OC pin is set upon timer compare.
11
OC pin toggles upon timer compare.
Timer Output Compare Value Register—Low Byte
The Timer3 Output Compare x Value Register—Low Byte, detailed in Table 68,
stores the Low byte of the compare value for OC0–OC3.
Table 68. Compare Value Register—Low Byte
(TMR3_OC0_L = 0082h, TMR3_OC1_L = 0084h,
TMR3_OC2_L = 0086h, TMR3_OC3_L = 0088h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMR3_OCx_L
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte compare
value, {TMR3_OCx_H[7:0], TMR3_OCx_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is
bit 7 of the 16-bit data value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16-bit
timer compare value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
150
Timer Output Compare Value Register—High Byte
The Timer3 Output Compare x Value Register—High Byte, detailed in Table 69,
stores the High byte of the compare value for OC0–OC3.
Table 69. Compare Value Register—High Byte
(TMR3_OC0_H = 0083h, TMR3_OC1_H = 0085h,
TMR3_OC2_H = 0087h, TMR3_OC3_H = 0089h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
TMR3_OCx_H
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte compare
value, {TMR3_OCx_H[7:0], TMR3_OCx_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is
bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit data value. Bit 0 is bit 8
of the 16-bit timer compare value.
Multi-PWM Mode
Multi-PWM Mode Overview
The special Multi-PWM mode uses the Timer 3 16-bit counter as the primary timekeeper to control up to 4 pulse-width modulated (PWM) generators. The 16-bit
reload value for Timer 3 sets a common period for each of the PWM signals. However, the duty cycle and phase for each generator are independent—that is, the
High and Low periods for each PWM generator are set independently. In addition,
each of the 4 PWM generators is enabled independently. The 8 PWM signals (4
PWM output signals and their inverses) are output via Port A. A functional block
diagram of the Multi-PWM is illustrated in Figure 29.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
151
16
PWM0
Generator
PWM0 Output
PA4
PWM0 Output
PA1
PWM1 Output
PA5
PWM1 Output
PA2
PWM2 Output
PA6
PWM2 Output
PA3
PWM3 Output
PA7
PWM3 Output
16
Timer 3
16-Bit Binary
Downcounter
PWM1
Generator
16
Timer 3
Clock Input
PA0
Count Value
16
PWM2
Generator
16
PWM3
Generator
Figure 29. Multi-PWM Simplified Block Diagram
Setting TMR3_PWM_CTL1[MPWM_EN] to 1 enables Multi-PWM mode. The
TMR3_PWM_CTL1 register bits enable the 4 individual PWM generators by
adjusting settings according to the list provided in Table 70.
Table 70. Enabling PWM Generators
Enable PWM generator 0 by setting TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PWM0_EN] to 1.
Enable PWM generator 1 by setting TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PWM1_EN] to 1.
Enable PWM generator 2 by setting TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PWM2_EN] to 1.
Enable PWM generator 3 by setting TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PWM3_EN] to 1.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
152
The inverted PWM outputs PWM0, PWM1, PWM2, and PWM3 are globally
enabled by setting TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PAIR_EN] to 1. The individual PWM generators must be enabled for the associated inverted PWM signals to be output.
For each of the 4 PWM generators, there is a 16-bit rising edge value
{TMR3_PWMxR_H[PWMxR_H], TMR3_PWMxR_L[PWMxR_L]} and a 16-bit falling edge value {TMR3_PWMxF_H[PWMxF_H], TMR3_PWMxF_L[PWMxF_L]} for
a total of 16 registers. The rising-edge byte pairs define the timer count at which
the PWMx output transitions from Low to High. Conversely, the falling-edge byte
pairs define the timer count at which the PWMx output transitions from High to
Low. Upon reset, all enabled PWM outputs begin Low and all PWMx outputs
begin High. When the PWMx output is Low, the logic is looking for a match
between the timer count and the rising edge value, and vice versa. Therefore, in a
case in which the rising edge value is the same as the falling edge value, the
PWM output frequency is one-half the rate at which the counter passes through its
entire count cycle (from reload value down to 0000h).
Figures 30 and 31 demonstrate a simple multi-PWM output and an expanded
view of the timing, respectively. Associated control values are listed in Table 71.
T3 Count
0
C B A 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 C B A 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 C B A 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 C B A
PWM0
PWM0
PWM1
PWM1
Figure 30. Multi-PWM Operation
System Clock
Clock Enable
T3 Count
A
9
8
7
6
5
4
Figure 31. Multi-PWM Operation—Expanded View of Timing
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
153
Table 71. Example: Multi-PWM Addressing
Parameter
Control Register(s)
Value
Timer Reload Value
{TMR3_RR_H, TMR3_RR_L}
000Ch
PWM0 rising edge
{TMR3_PWM0R_H,
TMR3_PWM0R_L}
0008h
PWM0 falling edge
{TMR3_PWM0F_H,
TMR3_PWM0F_L}
0004h
PWM1 rising edge
{TMR3_PWM1R_H,
TMR3_PWM1R_L}
0006h
PWM1 falling edge
{TMR3_PWM1F_H,
TMR3_PWM1F_L}
0007h
PWM enable
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PAIR_EN]
1
PWM0 enable
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PWM0_EN]
1
PWM1 enable
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PWM1_EN]
1
Multi-PWM enable
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[MPWM_EN]
1
Prescaler Divider = 4
TMR3_CTL[CLK_DIV]
00b
PWM nonoverlapping delay = 0
TMR3_PWM_CTL2[PWM_DLY]
0000b
PWM Master Mode
In PWM Master mode, the pair of output signals generated from the PWM0 generator (PWM0 and PWM0) are directed to all four sets of PWM output pairs. Setting
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[MM_EN] to 1 enables PWM Master mode. Assuming the outputs are all enabled and no AND/OR gating is used, all four PWM output pairs
transition simultaneously under the direction of PWM0 and PWM0. In PWM Master mode, the outputs can still be gated individually using the AND/OR gating functions described in the next section. Multi-PWM mode and the individual PWM
outputs must be enabled along with PWM Master mode. It is possible to enable or
disable any combination of the 4 PWM outputs while running in PWM Master
mode.
Modification of Edge Transition Values
Special circuitry is included for the update of the PWM edge transition values.
Normal use requires that these values be updated while the PWM generator is
running.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
154
Note: Under certain circumstances, electric motors driven by the PWM logic can
encounter rough operation. In essence, cycles can be skipped if the PWM waveform edge is not carefully modified.
Without special consideration, if a PWM generator looks for a particular count to
make a state transition, and if the edge transition value changes to a value that
already occurred in the current counter count-down cycle, then the transition is
missed. The PWM generator holds the current output state until the counter
reloads and cycles through to the appropriate edge transition value again. In
effect, an entire cycle of the PWM waveform can be skipped with the signal held
at a DC value. The change in PWM waveform duty cycle from cycle to cycle must
be limited to some fraction of a period to avoid rough running. To avoid unintentional roughness due to timing of the load operation for the register values in
question, the PWM edge transition values are double-buffered and exhibit the following behavior:
1. When the PWM generators are disabled, PWM edge transition values written
by the CPU are immediately loaded into the PWM edge transition registers.
2. When the PWM generators are enabled, a PWM edge transition value is
loaded into a buffer register and transferred to its destination register only
upon a specific transition event. A rising edge transition value is only loaded
upon a falling edge transition event, and a falling edge transition value is only
loaded upon a rising edge transition event.
AND/OR Gating of the PWM Outputs
When in Multi-PWM mode, it is possible for the user to turn off PWM propagation
to the pins without disabling the PWM generator. This feature is global and applies
to all enabled PWM generators. The function is implemented by applying digital
logic (AND or OR functions) to combine the corresponding bits in the port output
register with the PWM and PWM outputs.
The AND or OR functions are enabled on all PWM outputs by setting
TMR3_PWM_CTL2[AO_EN] to either a 01b (AND) or 10b (OR). Any other value
disables this feature. Likewise, the AND or OR functions are enabled on all PWM
outputs by setting TMR3_PWM_CTL2[AON_EN] to either a 01b (AND) or 10b
(OR). Any other value disables this feature. A functional block diagram for the
AND/OR gating feature for PWM0 and PWM0 is illustrated in Figure 32. The functionality for the other three PWM pairs is identical.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
155
00
01
PWM0 Signal
PADR0
PA0
PWM0 Output
PA4
PWM0 Output
10
11
2
TMR3_PWM_CTL2[5:4]
00
01
PWM0 Signal
PADR4
10
11
2
TMR3_PWM_CTL2[7:6]
Figure 32. PWM AND/OR Gating Functional Diagram
If the user enables the OR function on all PWM outputs and PADR0 is set to 1,
then the PWM0 output on PA0 is forced High. Similarly, if the user selects the
AND function on all PWM outputs and PADR0 is set to a 0, then the PWM0 output
on PA0 is forced Low.
PWM Nonoverlapping Output Pair Delays
A delay can be added between the falling edge of the PWM (PWM) outputs and
the rising edge of the PWM (PWM) outputs. This delay can be set to assure that
even with load and output drive variations there will be no overlap between the
falling edge of a PWM (PWM) output and the rising edge of its paired output. The
selected delay is global to all four PWM pairs. The delay duration is softwareselectable using the 4-bit field TMR3_PWM_CTL2[PWM_DLY]. The duration is
programmable in units of the system clock (SCLK), from 0 SCLK periods to 15
SCLK periods. The TMR3_PWM_CTL2[PWM_DLY] bits are mapped directly to a
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
156
counter, such that a setting of 0000b represents a delay of 0 system clock periods, and a setting of 1111b represents a delay of 15 system clock periods. The
PWM delay feature is illustrated in Figure 33, with associated addressing listed in
Table 72.
Note: The PWM nonoverlapping delay time must always be defined to be less than the
delay between the rising and falling edges (and the delay between the falling and
rising edges) of all Multi-PWM outputs. In other words, a rising (falling) edge cannot be delayed beyond the time at which it is subsequently scheduled to fall (rise).
System Clock
Clock Enable
TMR3_Count
A
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
C
PWM0
PWM0
3 x SCLK
3 x SCLK
Figure 33. PWM Nonoverlapping Output Delay
Table 72. PWM Nonoverlapping Output Addressing
PS019209-0504
Parameter
Control Register(s)
Value
Timer clock is SCLK ÷ 4
TMR3_CTL[CLK_DIV]
00b
Timer reload value
{TMR3_RR_H, TMR3_RR_L}
000Ch
PWM0 rising edge
{TMR3_PWM0R_H, TMR3_PWM0R_L}
0008h
PWM0 falling edge
{TMR3_PWM0F_H, TMR3_PWM0F_L}
0004h
Prescaler divider = 4
TMR3_CTL[CLK_DIV]
00b
PWM nonoverlapping delay = 3
TMR3_PWM_CTL2[PWM_DLY]
0011b
PWM enable
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PAIR_EN]
1
PWM0 enable
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[PWM0_EN]
1
Multi-PWM enable
TMR3_PWM_CTL1[MPWN_EN]
1
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
157
Multi-PWM Power-Trip Mode
When enabled, the Multi-PWM power-trip feature forces the enabled PWM outputs to a predetermined state when an interrupt is generated from an external
source via IC0, IC1, IC2, or IC3. One or multiple external interrupt sources can be
enabled at any given time. If multiple sources are enabled, any of the selected
external sources can trigger an interrupt. Configuring the PWM_CTL3 register
enables or disables interrupt sources. See Table 75 on page 161.
The possible interrupt sources for a Multi-PWM power-trip are:
•
•
•
•
IC0—digital input
IC1—digital input
IC2—digital input
IC3—digital input
When the power trip is detected, TMR3_PWM_CTL3[PTD] is set to 1 to indicate
detection of the power-trip. A value of 0 signifies that no power-trip is detected.
The PWMs can only be released after a power-trip when
TMR3_PWM_CTL3[PTD] is written back to 0 by software. As a result, the user is
allowed to check the conditions of the motor being controlled before releasing the
PWMs. The explicit release also prevents noise glitches after a power-trip from
causing an accidental exit or reentry of the PWM power-trip state.
The programmable power-trip states of the PWMs are globally grouped for the
PWM outputs and the inverting PWM outputs. Upon detection of a power-trip, the
PWM outputs can be forced to either a High state, a Low state, or tristate. The settings for the power-trip states are made with power-trip control bits
TMR3_PWM_CTL3[PT_LVL], TMR3_PWM_CTL3[PT_LVL_N], and
TMR3_PWM_CTL3[PT_TRI].
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
158
Multi-PWM Control Registers
Pulse-Width Modulation Control Register 1
The PWM Control Register 1, detailed in Table 73, controls PWM function
enables.
Table 73. PWM Control Register 1
(PWM_CTL1 = 0079h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
0
Global disable of the PWM outputs (PWM outputs
enabled only).
1
Global enable of the PWM and PWM output pairs.
6
PT_EN
0
Disable power-trip feature.
1
Enable power-trip feature.
5
MM_EN
0
Disable Master mode.
1
Enable Master mode.
4
PWM3_EN
0
Disable PWM generator 3.
1
Enable PWM generator 3.
3
PWM2_EN
0
Disable PWM generator 2.
1
Enable PWM generator 2.
2
PWM1_EN
0
Disable PWM generator 1.
1
Enable PWM generator 1.
1
PWM0_EN
0
Disable PWM generator 0.
1
Enable PWM generator 0.
0
MPWM_EN
0
Disable Multi-PWM mode.
1
Enable Multi-PWM mode.
7
PAIR_EN
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
159
Pulse-Width Modulation Control Register 2
The PWM Control Register 2, detailed in Table 74, controls PWM AND/OR and
edge delay functions.
Table 74. PWM Control Register 2
(PWM_CTL2 = 007Ah)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:6]
AON_EN
[5:4]
AO_EN
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00
Disable AND/OR features on PWM.
01
Enable AND logic on PWM.
10
Enable OR logic on PWM.
11
Disable AND/OR features on PWM.
00
Disable AND/OR features on PWM.
01
Enable AND logic on PWM.
10
Enable OR logic on PWM.
11
Disable AND/OR features on PWM.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
160
[3:0]
PWM_DLY
PS019209-0504
0000
No delay between falling edge of PWM (PWM) and rising
edge of PWM (PWM)
0001
Delay of 1 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
0010
Delay of 2 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
0011
Delay of 3 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
0100
Delay of 4 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
0101
Delay of 5 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
0110
Delay of 6 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
0111
Delay of 7 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1000
Delay of 8 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1001
Delay of 9 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1010
Delay of 10 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1011
Delay of 11 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1100
Delay of 12 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1101
Delay of 13 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1110
Delay of 14 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
1111
Delay of 15 SCLK periods between falling edge of PWM
(PWM) and rising edge of PWM (PWM)
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
161
Pulse-Width Modulation Control Register 3
The PWM Control Register 3, detailed in Table 75, is used to configure the PWM
power trip functionality.
Table 75. PWM Control Register 3
(PWM_CTL3 = 007Bh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read only;
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
7
0
PT_IC3_EN
1
Power trip disabled on IC3.
6
0
PT_IC2_EN
1
Power trip disabled on IC2.
5
0
PT_IC1_EN
1
Power trip disabled on IC1.
4
0
PT_IC0_EN
1
Power trip disabled on IC0.
3
PT_TRI
0
All PWM trip levels are tristate
1
All PWM trip levels are defined by PT_LVL and PT_LVL_N
2
PT_LVL
0
After power trip, PWMx outputs are set to one.
1
After power trip, PWMx outputs are set to zero.
1
PT_LVL_N
0
After power trip, PWMx outputs are set to one.
1
After power trip, PWMx outputs are set to zero.
0
PTD
0
Power trip has been cleared.
1
This bit is set after power trip event.
Power trip enabled on IC3.
Power trip enabled on IC2.
Power trip enabled on IC1.
Power trip enabled on IC0.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
162
Pulse-Width Modulation Rising Edge—Low Byte
A parallel 16-bit Write of {TMR3_PWMxR_H[7–0], TMR3_PWMxR_L[7–0]} occurs
when software initiates a Write to TMR3_PWMxR_L. The register is detailed in
Table 76.
Table 76. PWMx Rising-Edge Register—Low Byte
(TMR3_PWM0R_L = 007Ch, TMR3_PWM1R_L = 007Eh, TMR3_PWM2R_L = 0080h,
TMR3_PWM3R_L = 0082h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
PWMXR_L
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the Low byte of the 16-bit value to set
the rising edge COMPARE value for PWMx,
{TMR3_PWMXR_H[7:0], TMR3_PWMXR_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is bit 7
of the 16-bit timer data value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16-bit
timer data value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
163
Pulse-Width Modulation Rising Edge—High Byte
Writing to TMR3_PWMxR_H stores the value in a temporary holding register. A
parallel 16-bit Write of {TMR3_PWMxR_H[7–0], TMR3_PWMxR_L[7–0]} occurs
when software initiates a Write to TMR3_PWMxR_L. The register is detailed in
Table 77.
Table 77. PWMx Rising-Edge Register—High Byte
(TMR3_PWM0R_H = 007Dh, TMR3_PWM1R_H = 007Fh, TMR3_PWM2R_H = 0081h,
TMR3_PWM3R_H = 0083h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
PWMXR_H
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the High byte of the 16-bit value to set
the rising edge COMPARE value for PWMx,
{TMR3_PWMXR_H[7:0], TMR3_PWMXR_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is bit
15 (msb) of the 16-bit timer data value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16bit timer data value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
164
Pulse-Width Modulation Falling Edge—Low Byte
A parallel 16-bit Write of {TMR3_PWMxF_H[7–0], TMR3_PWMxF_L[7–0]} occurs
when software initiates a Write to TMR3_PWMxF_L. The register is detailed in
Table 78.
Table 78. PWMx Falling-Edge Register—Low Byte
(TMR3_PWM0F_L = 0084h, TMR3_PWM1F_L = 0086h, TMR3_PWM2F_L = 0088h,
TMR3_PWM3F_L = 008Ah)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
PWMXF_L
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the Low byte of the 16-bit value to set
the falling edge COMPARE value for PWMx,
{TMR3_PWMXF_H[7:0], TMR3_PWMXF_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is bit 7
of the 16-bit timer data value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16-bit
timer data value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
165
Pulse-Width Modulation Falling Edge—High Byte
Writing to TMR3_PWMxF_H stores the value in a temporary holding register. A
parallel 16-bit Write of {TMR3_PWMxF_H[7–0], TMR3_PWMxF_L[7–0]} occurs
when software initiates a Write to TMR3_PWMxF_L. The register is detailed in
Table 79.
Table 79. PWMx Falling-Edge Register—High Byte
(TMR3_PWM0F_H = 0085h, TMR3_PWM1F_H = 0087h, TMR3_PWM2F_H = 0089h,
TMR3_PWM3F_H = 008Bh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
PWMXF_H
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00h–FFh These bits represent the High byte of the 16-bit value to set
the falling edge COMPARE value for PWMx,
{TMR3_PWMXF_H[7:0], TMR3_PWMXF_L[7:0]}. Bit 7 is bit
15 (msb) of the 16-bit timer data value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16bit timer data value.
PRELIMINARY
Programmable Reload Timers
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
166
Real-Time Clock
Real-Time Clock Overview
The Real-Time Clock (RTC) keeps time by maintaining a count of seconds, minutes, hours, day-of-the-week, day-of-the-month, year, and century. The current
time is kept in 24-hour format. The format for all count and alarm registers is
selectable between binary and binary-coded-decimal (BCD) operations. The calendar operation maintains the correct day of the month and automatically compensates for leap year. A simplified block diagram of the RTC and the associated
on-chip, low-power, 32 KHz oscillator is illustrated in Figure 34. Connections to an
external battery supply and 32 KHz crystal network are also demonstrated in
Figure 34.
RTC_VDD
Battery
VDD
to eZ80 CPU
IRQ
Real-Time Clock
ADDR[15:0]
DATA[7:0]
R1
RTC_XOUT
RTC Clock
C
System Clock
Low-Power
32 KHz Oscillator
VDD
32 KHz
Crystal
Enable
CLK_SEL
(RTC_CTRL[4])
RTC_XIN
C
Figure 34. Real-Time Clock and 32KHz Oscillator Block Diagram
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
167
Real-Time Clock Alarm
The clock can be programmed to generate an alarm condition when the current
count matches the alarm set-point registers. Alarm registers are available for seconds, minutes, hours, and day-of-the-week. Each alarm can be independently
enabled. To generate an alarm condition, the current time must match all enabled
alarm values. For example, if the day-of-the-week and hour alarms are both
enabled, the alarm only occurs at the specified hour on the specified day. The
alarm triggers an interrupt if the interrupt enable bit, INT_EN, is set to 1. The
alarm flag, ALARM, and corresponding interrupt to the CPU are cleared by reading the RTC_CTRL register.
Alarm value registers and alarm control registers can be written at any time. Alarm
conditions are generated when the count value matches the alarm value. The
comparison of alarm and count values occurs whenever the RTC count increments (one time every second). The RTC can also be forced to perform a comparison at any time by writing a 0 to the RTC_UNLOCK bit (the RTC_UNLOCK bit is
not required to be changed to a 1 first).
Real-Time Clock Oscillator and Source Selection
The RTC count is driven by either the on-chip 32768 Hz crystal oscillator or a 50/
60 Hz power-line frequency input connected to the 32 KHz RTC_XOUT pin. An
internal divider compensates for each of these options. The clock source and
power-line frequencies are selected in the RTC_CTRL register. Writing to the
RTC_CTRL register resets the clock divider.
Real-Time Clock Battery Backup
The power supply pin (RTC_VDD) for the Real-Time Clock and associated lowpower 32 KHz oscillator is isolated from the other power supply pins on the
eZ80F91 device. To ensure that the RTC continues to keep time in the event of
loss of line power to the application, a battery can be used to supply power to the
RTC and the oscillator via the RTC_VDD pin. All VSS (ground) pins should be connected together on the printed circuit assembly.
Real-Time Clock Recommended Operation
Following a initial system reset from a powered-down condition of VDD and
VDD_RTC, the counter values of the RTC are undefined and all alarms are disabled. The following procedure is recommended to initialize the Real-Time Clock:
PS019209-0504
•
Write to RTC_CTRL to set RTC_UNLOCK and disable the RTC counter; this
action also clears the clock divider
•
Write values to the RTC count registers to set the current time
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
168
•
Write values to the RTC alarm registers to set the appropriate alarm conditions
•
Write to RTC_CTRL to clear RTC_UNLOCK; clearing the RTC_UNLOCK bit
resets and enables the clock divider
Real-Time Clock Registers
The Real-Time Clock registers are accessed via the address and data buses
using I/O instructions. The RTC_UNLOCK control bit controls access to the RTC
count registers. When unlocked (RTC_UNLOCK = 1), the RTC count is disabled
and the count registers are Read/Write. When locked (RTC_UNLOCK = 0), the
RTC count is enabled and the count registers are Read Only. The default, at
RESET, is for the RTC to be locked.
Real-Time Clock Seconds Register
This register contains the current seconds count. The value in the RTC_SEC register is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines
whether the values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). Access to this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and
Read/Write if the RTC is unlocked. See Table 80.
Table 80. Real-Time Clock Seconds Register
(RTC_SEC = 00E0h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
TEN_SEC
0–5
The tens digit of the current seconds count.
[3:0]
SEC
0–9
The ones digit of the current seconds count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
SEC
00h–
3Bh
The current seconds count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
169
Real-Time Clock Minutes Register
This register contains the current minutes count. The value in the RTC_MIN register is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines
whether the values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). Access to this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and
Read/Write if the RTC is unlocked. See Table 81.
Table 81. Real-Time Clock Minutes Register
(RTC_MIN = 00E1h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
TEN_MIN
0–5
The tens digit of the current minutes count.
[3:0]
MIN
0–9
The ones digit of the current minutes count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
MIN
00h–
3Bh
The current minutes count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
170
Real-Time Clock Hours Register
This register contains the current hours count. The value in the RTC_HRS register
is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines whether
the values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal
(BCD_EN = 1). Access to this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and
Read/Write if the RTC is unlocked. See Table 82.
Table 82. Real-Time Clock Hours Register
(RTC_HRS = 00E2h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
TEN_HRS
0–2
The tens digit of the current hours count.
[3:0]
HRS
0–9
The ones digit of the current hours count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
HRS
00h–
17h
The current hours count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
171
Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Week Register
This register contains the current day-of-the-week count. The RTC_DOW register
begins counting at 01h. The value in the RTC_DOW register is unchanged by a
RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines whether the value in this register is binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). Access to
this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and Read/Write if the RTC is
unlocked. See Table 83.
Table 83. Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Week Register
(RTC_DOW = 00E3h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R = Read Only; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if
RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
0000
Reserved.
[3:0]
DOW
1–7
The current day-of-the-week.count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
0000
Reserved.
[3:0]
DOW
01h–
07h
The current day-of-the-week count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
172
Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Month Register
This register contains the current day-of-the-month count. The RTC_DOM register begins counting at 01h. The value in the RTC_DOM register is unchanged by a
RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines whether the values in this
register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). Access
to this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and Read/Write if the RTC is
unlocked. See Table 84.
Table 84. Real-Time Clock Day-of-the-Month Register
(RTC_DOM = 00E4h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
TENS_DOM
0–3
The tens digit of the current day-of-the-month count.
[3:0]
DOM
0–9
The ones digit of the current day-of-the-month count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
DOM
01h–
1Fh
The current day-of-the-month count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
173
Real-Time Clock Month Register
This register contains the current month count. The RTC_MON register begins
counting at 01h. The value in the RTC_MON register is unchanged by a RESET.
The current setting of BCD_EN determines whether the values in this register are
binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). Access to this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and Read/Write if the RTC is unlocked. See
Table 85.
Table 85. Real-Time Clock Month Register
(RTC_MON = 00E5h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
TENS_MON
0–1
The tens digit of the current month count.
[3:0]
MON
0–9
The ones digit of the current month count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
MON
01h–
0Ch
The current month count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
174
Real-Time Clock Year Register
This register contains the current year count. The value in the RTC_YR register is
unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines whether the
values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal
(BCD_EN = 1). Access to this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and
Read/Write if the RTC is unlocked. See Table 86.
Table 86. Real-Time Clock Year Register
(RTC_YR = 00E6h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
TENS_YR
0–9
The tens digit of the current year count.
[3:0]
YR
0–9
The ones digit of the current year count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
YR
00h–
63h
The current year count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
175
Real-Time Clock Century Register
This register contains the current century count. The value in the RTC_CEN register is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines
whether the values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). Access to this register is Read Only if the RTC is locked and
Read/Write if the RTC is unlocked. See Table 87.
Table 87. Real-Time Clock Century Register
(RTC_CEN = 00E7h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
TENS_CEN
0–9
The tens digit of the current century count.
[3:0]
CEN
0–9
The ones digit of the current century count.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
CEN
00h–
63h
The current century count.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
176
Real-Time Clock Alarm Seconds Register
This register contains the alarm seconds value. The value in the RTC_ASEC register is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines
whether the values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). See Table 88.
Table 88. Real-Time Clock Alarm Seconds Register
(RTC_ASEC = 00E8h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W = Read/Write.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
ATEN_SEC
0–5
The tens digit of the alarm seconds value.
[3:0]
ASEC
0–9
The ones digit of the alarm seconds value.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
ASEC
00h–
3Bh
The alarm seconds value.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
177
Real-Time Clock Alarm Minutes Register
This register contains the alarm minutes value. The value in the RTC_AMIN register is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines
whether the values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). See Table 89.
Table 89. Real-Time Clock Alarm Minutes Register
(RTC_AMIN = 00E9h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W = Read/Write.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
ATEN_MIN
0–5
The tens digit of the alarm minutes value.
[3:0]
AMIN
0–9
The ones digit of the alarm minutes value.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
AMIN
00h–
3Bh
The alarm minutes value.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
178
Real-Time Clock Alarm Hours Register
This register contains the alarm hours value. The value in the RTC_AHRS register
is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN determines whether
the values in this register are binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binary-coded decimal
(BCD_EN = 1). See Table 90.
Table 90. Real-Time Clock Alarm Hours Register
(RTC_AHRS = 00EAh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R/W = Read/Write.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
ATEN_HRS
0–2
The tens digit of the alarm hours value.
[3:0]
AHRS
0–9
The ones digit of the alarm hours value.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
AHRS
00h–
17h
The alarm hours value.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
179
Real-Time Clock Alarm Day-of-the-Week Register
This register contains the alarm day-of-the-week value. The value in the
RTC_ADOW register is unchanged by a RESET. The current setting of BCD_EN
determines whether the value in this register is binary (BCD_EN = 0) or binarycoded decimal (BCD_EN = 1). See Table 91.
Table 91. Real-Time Clock Alarm Day-of-the-Week Register
(RTC_ADOW = 00EBh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R = Read Only; R/W* = Read Only if RTC locked, Read/Write if
RTC unlocked.
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation (BCD_EN = 1)
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
0000
Reserved.
[3:0]
ADOW
1–7
The alarm day-of-the-week.value.
Binary Operation (BCD_EN = 0)
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
0000
Reserved.
[3:0]
ADOW
01h–
07h
The alarm day-of-the-week value.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
180
Real-Time Clock Alarm Control Register
This register contains control bits for the Real-Time Clock. The RTC_ACTRL register is cleared by a RESET. See Table 92.
Table 92. Real-Time Clock Alarm Control Register
(RTC_ACTRL = 00ECh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:4]
0000
Reserved.
3
ADOW_EN
0
The day-of-the-week alarm is disabled.
1
The day-of-the-week alarm is enabled.
2
AHRS_EN
0
The hours alarm is disabled.
1
The hours alarm is enabled.
1
AMIN_EN
0
The minutes alarm is disabled.
1
The minutes alarm is enabled.
0
ASEC_EN
0
The seconds alarm is disabled.
1
The seconds alarm is enabled.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
181
Real-Time Clock Control Register
This register contains control and status bits for the Real-Time Clock. Some bits in
the RTC_CTRL register are cleared by a RESET. The ALARM bit flag and associated interrupt (if INT_EN is enabled) are cleared by reading this register. The
ALARM bit flag is updated by clearing (locking) the RTC_UNLOCK bit or by an
increment of the RTC count. Writing to the RTC_CTRL register also resets the
RTC count prescaler allowing the RTC to be synchronized to another time source.
SLP_WAKE indicates if an RTC alarm condition initiated the CPU recovery from
SLEEP mode. This bit can be checked after RESET to determine if a sleep-mode
recovery is caused by the RTC. SLP_WAKE is cleared by a Read of the
RTC_CTRL register.
Setting the BCD_EN bit causes the RTC to use BCD counting in all registers
including the alarm set points.
The CLK_SEL and FREQ_SEL bits select the RTC clock source. If the 32 KHz
crystal option is selected the oscillator is enabled and the internal prescaler is set
to divide by 32768. If the power-line frequency option is selected, the prescale
value is set by the FREQ_SEL bit, and the 32 Khz oscillator is disabled. See Table
93.
Table 93. Real-Time Clock Control Register
(RTC_CTRL = 00EDh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
0
X
X
X
X
0/1
0
CPU Access
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
Note: X = Unchanged by RESET; R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
7
ALARM
0
Alarm interrupt is inactive.
1
Alarm interrupt is active.
6
INT_EN
0
Interrupt on alarm condition is disabled.
1
Interrupt on alarm condition is enabled.
5
BCD_EN
0
RTC count and alarm value registers are binary.
1
RTC count and alarm value registers are binary-coded
decimal (BCD).
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
182
Bit
Position
4
CLK_SEL
PS019209-0504
Value Description
0
RTC clock source is crystal oscillator output (32768 Hz).
On-chip 32768Hz oscillator is enabled.
1
RTC clock source is power-line frequency input.
On-chip 32768 Hz oscillator is disabled.
3
FREQ_SEL
0
Power-line frequency is 60 Hz.
1
Power-line frequency is 50 Hz.
2
DAY_SAV
0
Daylight Savings Time not selected.
1
Daylight Savings Time selected.
1
SLP_WAKE
0
RTC did not generate a sleep-mode recovery reset.
1
RTC Alarm generated a sleep-mode recovery reset.
0
0
RTC_UNLOCK
RTC count registers are locked to prevent write access.
RTC counter is enabled.
1
RTC count registers are unlocked to allow write access.
RTC counter is disabled.
PRELIMINARY
Real-Time Clock
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
183
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/
Transmitter
UART Control Interface and Baud Rate Generator
The UART module implements all of the logic required to support the asynchronous communications protocol. The module also implements two separate 16byte-deep FIFOs for both transmission and reception. A block diagram of the
UART is illustrated in Figure 35.
®
to eZ80 CPU
System Clock
I/O Address
Data
Interrupt Signal
Receive
Buffer
RxD0/RxD1
Transmit
Buffer
TxD0/TxD1
Modem
Control
Logic
CTS0/CTS1
RTS0/RTS1
DSR0/DSR1
DTR0/DTR1
DCD0/DCD1
RI0/RI1
Figure 35. UART Block Diagram
The UART module provides the following asynchronous communications protocol-related features and functions:
•
•
•
•
•
•
PS019209-0504
5-, 6-, 7-, 8- or 9-bit data transmission
Even/odd, space/mark, address/data, or no parity bit generation and detection
Start and stop bit generation and detection (supports up to two stop bits)
Line break detection and generation
Receiver overrun and framing errors detection
Logic and associated I/O to provide modem handshake capability
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
184
UART Functional Description
The UART Baud Rate Generator creates the clock for the serial transmit and
receive functions. The UART module supports all of the various options in the
asynchronous transmission and reception protocol including:
•
•
•
•
•
5- to 9-bit transmit/receive
Start bit generation and detection
Parity generation and detection
Stop bit generation and detection
Break generation and detection
The UART contains 16-byte-deep FIFOs in each direction. The FIFOs can be
enabled or disabled by the application. The receive FIFO features trigger-level
detection logic, which enables the CPU to block-transfer data bytes from the
receive FIFO.
UART Functions
The UART function implements:
•
•
•
The transmitter and associated control logic
The receiver and associated control logic
The modem interface and associated logic
UART Transmitter
The transmitter block controls the data transmitted on the TxD output. It implements the FIFO, access via the UARTx_THR register, the transmit shift register,
the parity generator, and control logic for the transmitter to control parameters for
the asynchronous communications protocol.
The UARTx_THR is a Write Only register. The CPU writes the data byte to be
transmitted into this register. In FIFO mode, up to 16 data bytes can be written via
the UARTx_THR register. The data byte from the FIFO is transferred to the transmit shift register at the appropriate time and transmitted via TxD output. After
SYNC_RESET, the UARTx_THR register is empty. Therefore, the Transmit Holding Register Empty (THRE) bit (bit 5 of the UARTx_LSR register) is 1. An interrupt
is sent to the CPU if interrupts are enabled. The CPU can reset this interrupt by
loading data into the UARTx_THR register, which clears the transmitter interrupt.
The transmit shift register places the byte to be transmitted on the TxD signal serially. The least-significant bit of the byte to be transmitted is shifted out first and the
most-significant bit is shifted out last. The control logic within the block adds the
asynchronous communications protocol bits to the data byte being transmitted.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
185
The transmitter block obtains the parameters for the protocol from the bits programmed via the UARTx_LCTL register. When enabled, an interrupt is generated
after the final protocol bit is transmitted, which the CPU can reset by loading data
into the UARTx_THR register. The TxD output is set to 1 if the transmitter is idle
(i.e., the transmitter does not contain any data to be transmitted).
The transmitter operates with the Baud Rate Generator (BRG) clock. The data
bits are placed on the TxD output one time every 16 BRG clock cycles. The transmitter block also implements a parity generator that attaches the parity bit to the
byte, if programmed. For 9-bit data, the host CPU programs the parity bit generator so that it marks the byte as either address (mark parity) or data (space parity).
UART Receiver
The receiver block controls the data reception from the RxD signal. The receiver
block implements a receiver shift register, receiver line error condition monitoring
logic and receiver data ready logic. It also implements the parity checker.
The UARTx_RBR is a Read Only register of the module. The CPU reads received
data from this register. The condition of the UARTx_RBR register is monitored by
the DR bit (bit 0 of the UARTx_LSR register). The DR bit is 1 when a data byte is
received and transferred to the UARTx_RBR register from the receiver shift register. The DR bit is reset only when the CPU reads all of the received data bytes. If
the number of bits received is less than eight, the unused most-significant bits of
the data byte Read are 0.
For 9-bit data, the receiver checks incoming bytes for space parity. A line status
interrupt is generated when an address byte is received, because address bytes
maintain high parity bits. The CPU clears the interrupt by determining if the
address matches its own, then configures the receiver to either accept the subsequent data bytes if the address matches, or ignore the data if the address does
not match.
The receiver uses the clock from the BRG for receiving the data. This clock must
operate at 16 times the appropriate baud rate. The receiver synchronizes the shift
clock on the falling edge of the RxD input start bit. It then receives a complete byte
according to the set parameters. The receiver also implements logic to detect
framing errors, parity errors, overrun errors, and break signals.
UART Modem Control
The modem control logic provides two outputs and four inputs for handshaking
with the modem. Any change in the modem status inputs, except RI, is detected
and an interrupt can be generated. For RI, an interrupt is generated only when the
trailing edge of the RI is detected. The module also provides LOOP mode for selfdiagnostics.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
186
UART Interrupts
There are six different sources of interrupts from the UART. The six sources of
interrupts are:
•
•
•
Transmitter (two different interrupts)
Receiver (three different interrupts)
Modem status
UART Transmitter Interrupt
A Transmitter Hold Register Empty interrupt is generated if there is no data available in the hold register. By the same token, a transmission complete interrupt is
generated after the data in the shift register is sent. Both interrupts can be disabled using individual interrupt enable bits, or cleared by writing data into the
UARTx_THR register.
UART Receiver Interrupts
A receiver interrupt can be generated by three possible events. The first event, a
receiver data ready interrupt event, indicates that one or more data bytes are
received and are ready to be read. Next, this interrupt is generated if the number
of bytes in the receiver FIFO is greater than or equal to the trigger level. If the
FIFO is not enabled, the interrupt is generated if the receive buffer contains a data
byte. This interrupt is cleared by reading the UARTx_RBR.
The second interrupt source is the receiver time-out. A receiver time-out interrupt
is generated when there are fewer data bytes in the receiver FIFO than the trigger
level and there are no Reads and Writes to or from the receiver FIFO for four consecutive byte times. When the receiver time-out interrupt is generated, it is
cleared only after emptying the entire receive FIFO.
The first two interrupt sources from the receiver (data ready and time-out) share
an interrupt enable bit. The third source of a receiver interrupt is a line status error,
indicating an error in byte reception. This error can result from:
•
Incorrect received parity
Note: For 9-bit data, incorrect parity indicates detection of an address byte.
PS019209-0504
•
Incorrect framing (i.e., the stop bit) is not detected by receiver at the end of the
byte
•
•
Receiver overrun condition
A BREAK condition being detected on the receive data input
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
187
An interrupt due to one of the above conditions is cleared when the UARTx_LSR
register is read. In case of FIFO mode, a line status interrupt is generated only
after the received byte with an error reaches the top of the FIFO and is ready to be
read.
A line status interrupt is activated (provided this interrupt is enabled) as long as
the Read pointer of the receiver FIFO points to the location of the FIFO that contains a byte with the error. The interrupt is immediately cleared when the
UARTx_LSR register is read. The ERR bit of the UARTx_LSR register is active as
long as an erroneous byte is present in the receiver FIFO.
UART Modem Status Interrupt
The modem status interrupt is generated if there is any change in state of the
modem status inputs to the UART. This interrupt is cleared when the CPU reads
the UARTx_MSR register.
UART Recommended Usage
The following standard sequence of events occurs in the UART block of the
eZ80F91 device. A description of each follows.
1. Module reset.
2. Control transfers to configure UART operation.
3. Data transfers.
Module Reset
Upon reset, all internal registers are set to their default values. All command status registers are programmed with their default values, and the FIFOs are flushed.
Control Transfers
Based on the requirements of the application, the data transfer baud rate is determined and the BRG is configured to generate a 16X clock frequency. Interrupts
are disabled and the communication control parameters are programmed in the
UARTx_LCTL register. The FIFO configuration is determined and the receive trigger levels are set in the UARTx_FCTL register. The status registers, UARTx_LSR
and UARTx_MSR, are read to ensure that none of the interrupt sources are
active. The interrupts are enabled (except for the transmit interrupt) and the application is ready to use the module for transmission/reception.
Data Transfers
Transmit. To transmit data, the application enables the transmit interrupt. An inter-
rupt is immediately expected in response. The application reads the UARTx_IIR
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
188
register and determines whether the interrupt occurs due to either an empty
UARTx_THR register or a completed transmission. When the application makes
this determination, it writes the transmit data bytes to the UARTx_THR register.
The number of bytes that the application writes depends on whether or not the
FIFO is enabled. If the FIFO is enabled, the application can write 16 bytes at a
time. If not, the application can write one byte at a time. As a result of the first
Write, the interrupt is deactivated. The CPU then waits for the next interrupt.
When the interrupt is raised by the UART module, the CPU repeats the same process until it exhausts all of the data for transmission.
To control and check the modem status, the application sets up the modem by
writing to the UARTx_MCTL register and reading the UARTx_MCTL register
before starting the process described above.
Receive. The receiver is always enabled, and it continually checks for the start bit
on the RxD input signal. When an interrupt is raised by the UART module, the
application reads the UARTx_IIR register and determines the cause for the interrupt. If the cause is a line status interrupt, the application reads the UARTx_LSR
register, reads the data byte and then can discard the byte or take other appropriate action. If the interrupt is caused by a receive-data-ready condition, the application alternately reads the UARTx_LSR and UARTx_RBR registers and
removes all of the received data bytes. It reads the UARTx_LSR register before
reading the UARTx_RBR register to determine that there is no error in the
received data.
To control and check modem status, the application sets up the modem by writing
to the UARTx_MCTL register and reading the UARTx_MSR register before starting the process described above.
Poll Mode Transfers. When interrupts are disabled, all data transfers are referred
to as poll mode transfers. In poll mode transfers, the application must continually
poll the UARTx_LSR register to transmit or receive data without enabling the
interrupts. The same holds true for the UARTx_MSR register. If the interrupts are
not enabled, the data in the UARTx_IIR register cannot be used to determine the
cause of interrupt.
Baud Rate Generator
The Baud Rate Generator consists of a 16-bit downcounter, two registers, and
associated decoding logic. The initial value of the Baud Rate Generator is defined
by the two BRG Divisor Latch registers, {UARTx_BRG_H, UARTx_BRG_L}. At
the rising edge of each system clock, the BRG decrements until it reaches the
value 0001h. On the next system clock rising edge, the BRG reloads the initial
value from {UARTx_BRG_H, UARTx_BRG_L) and outputs a pulse to indicate the
end-of-count.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
189
Calculate the UART data rate with the following equation:
UART Data Rate (bits/s)
=
System Clock Frequency
16 X UART Baud Rate Generator Divisor
Upon RESET, the 16-bit BRG divisor value resets to the smallest allowable value
of 0002h. Therefore, the minimum BRG clock divisor ratio is 2. A software Write to
either the Low- or High-byte registers for the BRG Divisor Latch causes both the
Low and High bytes to load into the BRG counter, and causes the count to restart.
The divisor registers can only be accessed if bit 7 of the UART Line Control register (UARTx_LCTL) is set to 1. After reset, this bit is reset to 0.
Recommended Use of the Baud Rate Generator
The following is the normal sequence of operations that should occur after the
eZ80F91 is powered on to configure the Baud Rate Generator:
1. Assert and deassert RESET.
2. Set UARTx_LCTL[7] to 1 to enable access of the BRG divisor registers.
3. Program the UARTx_BRG_L and UARTx_BRG_H registers.
4. Clear UARTx_LCTL[7] to 0 to disable access of the BRG divisor registers.
BRG Control Registers
UART Baud Rate Generator Register—Low and High Bytes
The registers hold the Low and High bytes of the 16-bit divisor count loaded by
the CPU for UART baud rate generation. The 16-bit clock divisor value is returned
by {UARTx_BRG_H, UARTx_BRG_L}, where x is either 0 or 1 to identify the two
available UART devices. Upon RESET, the 16-bit BRG divisor value resets to
0002h. The initial 16-bit divisor value must be between 0002h and FFFFh,
because the values 0000h and 0001h are invalid and proper operation is not guaranteed at these two values. As a result, the minimum BRG clock divisor ratio is 2.
A Write to either the Low- or High-byte registers for the BRG Divisor Latch causes
both bytes to be loaded into the BRG counter. The count is then restarted.
Bit 7 of the associated UART Line Control register (UARTx_LCTL) must be set to
1 to access this register. See Tables 94 and 95. Refer to the UART Line Control
Register (UARTx_LCTL) on page 196 for more information.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
190
Note: The UARTx_BRG_L registers share the same address space with the
UARTx_RBR and UARTx_THR registers. The UARTx_BRG_H registers share
the same address space with the UARTx_IER registers. Bit 7 of the associated
UART Line Control register (UARTx_LCTL) must be set to 1 to enable access to
the BRG registers.
Table 94. UART Baud Rate Generator Register—Low Bytes
(UART0_BRG_L = 00C0h, UART1_BRG_L = 00D0h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
UART_BRG_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 16-bit Baud Rate
Generator divider value. The complete BRG divisor value is
returned by {UART_BRG_H, UART_BRG_L}.
Table 95. UART Baud Rate Generator Register—High Bytes
(UART0_BRG_H = 00C1h, UART1_BRG_H = 00D1h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
UART_BRG_H
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the High byte of the 16-bit Baud Rate
Generator divider value. The complete BRG divisor value is
returned by {UART_BRG_H, UART_BRG_L}.
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
191
UART Registers
After a system reset, all UART registers are set to their default values. Any Writes
to unused registers or register bits are ignored and reads return a value of 0. For
compatibility with future revisions, unused bits within a register should always be
written with a value of 0. Read/Write attributes, reset conditions, and bit descriptions of all of the UART registers are provided in this section.
UART Transmit Holding Register
If less than eight bits are programmed for transmission, the lower bits of the byte
written to this register are selected for transmission. The Transmit FIFO is
mapped at this address. The user can write up to 16 bytes for transmission at one
time to this address if the FIFO is enabled by the application. If the FIFO is disabled, this buffer is only one byte deep.
These registers share the same address space as the UARTx_RBR and
UARTx_BRG_L registers. See Table 96.
Table 96. UART Transmit Holding Registers
(UART0_THR = 00C0h, UART1_THR = 00D0h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
TxD
00h–
FFh
Transmit data byte.
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
192
UART Receive Buffer Register
The bits in this register reflect the data received. If less than eight bits are programmed for reception, the lower bits of the byte reflect the bits received, whereas
upper unused bits are 0. The Receive FIFO is mapped at this address. If the FIFO
is disabled, this buffer is only one byte deep.
These registers share the same address space as the UARTx_THR and
UARTx_BRG_L registers. See Table 97.
Table 97. UART Receive Buffer Registers
(UART0_RBR = 00C0h, UART1_RBR = 00 D0h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
RxD
00h–
FFh
Receive data byte.
UART Interrupt Enable Register
The UARTx_IER register is used to enable and disable the UART interrupts. The
UARTx_IER registers share the same I/O addresses as the UARTx_BRG_H registers. See Table 98.
Table 98. UART Interrupt Enable Registers
(UART0_IER = 00C1h, UART1_IER = 00D1h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:5]
000
Reserved
4
TCIE
0
Transmission complete interrupt is disabled
1
Transmission complete interrupt is generated when both the
transmit hold register and the transmit shift register are empty
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
193
Bit
Position
Value
Description
3
MIIE
0
Modem interrupt on edge detect of status inputs is disabled.
1
Modem interrupt on edge detect of status inputs is enabled.
2
LSIE
0
Line status interrupt is disabled.
1
Line status interrupt is enabled for receive data errors:
incorrect parity bit received, framing error, overrun error, or
break detection.
1
TIE
0
Transmit interrupt is disabled.
1
Transmit interrupt is enabled. Interrupt is generated when the
transmit FIFO/buffer is empty indicating no more bytes
available for transmission.
0
RIE
0
Receive interrupt is disabled.
1
Receive interrupt and receiver time-out interrupt are enabled.
Interrupt is generated if the FIFO/buffer contains data ready to
be read or if the receiver times out.
UART Interrupt Identification Register
The Read Only UARTx_IIR register allows the user to check whether the FIFO is
enabled and the status of interrupts. These registers share the same I/O
addresses as the UARTx_FCTL registers. See Tables 99 and 100.
Table 99. UART Interrupt Identification Registers
(UART0_IIR = 00C2h, UART1_IIR = 00D2h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
[7:6]
FSTS
[5:4]
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
00
FIFO is disabled.
10
Receive FIFO is disabled (Multidrop Mode)
11
FIFO is enabled.
00
Reserved
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
194
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[3:1]
INSTS
000–
110
Interrupt Status Code
The code indicated in these three bits is valid only if INTBIT is
1. If two internal interrupt sources are active and their
respective enable bits are High, only the higher priority
interrupt is seen by the application. The lower-priority interrupt
code is indicated only after the higher-priority interrupt is
serviced. Table 100 lists the interrupt status codes.
0
INTBIT
0
There is an active interrupt source within the UART.
1
There is not an active interrupt source within the UART.
Table 100. UART Interrupt Status Codes
PS019209-0504
INSTS
Value
Priority
Interrupt Type
011
Highest
Receiver Line Status
010
Second
Receive Data Ready or Trigger Level
110
Third
Character Time-out
101
Fourth
Transmission Complete
001
Fifth
Transmit Buffer Empty
000
Lowest
Modem Status
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
195
UART FIFO Control Register
This register is used to monitor trigger levels, clear FIFO pointers, and enable or
disable the FIFO. The UARTx_FCTL registers share the same I/O addresses as
the UARTx_IIR registers. See Table 101.
Table 101. UART FIFO Control Registers
(UART0_FCTL = 00C2h, UART1_FCTL = 00D2h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
00
Receive FIFO trigger level set to 1. Receive data interrupt is
generated when there is 1 byte in the FIFO. Valid only if FIFO
is enabled.
01
Receive FIFO trigger level set to 4. Receive data interrupt is
generated when there are 4bytes in the FIFO. Valid only if
FIFO is enabled.
10
Receive FIFO trigger level set to 8. Receive data interrupt is
generated when there are 8 bytes in the FIFO. Valid only if
FIFO is enabled.
11
Receive FIFO trigger level set to 14. Receive data interrupt is
generated when there are 14 bytes in the FIFO. Valid only if
FIFO is enabled.
[5:3]
000b
Reserved—must be 000b.
2
CLRTxF
0
No effect.
1
Clear the transmit FIFO and reset the transmit FIFO pointer.
Valid only if the FIFO is enabled.
1
CLRRxF
0
No effect.
1
Clear the receive FIFO, clear the receive error FIFO, and
reset the receive FIFO pointer. Valid only if the FIFO is
enabled.
0
FIFOEN
0
Transmit and receive FIFOs are disabled. Transmit and
receive buffers are only 1 byte deep.
1
Transmit and receive FIFOs are enabled. Note: Receive FIFO
will not be enabled during Multidrop Mode.
[7:6]
TRIG
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
196
UART Line Control Register
This register is used to control the communication control parameters. See
Tables 102 and 103.
Table 102. UART Line Control Registers
(UART0_LCTL = 00C3h, UART1_LCTL = 00D3h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
0
Access to the UART registers at I/O addresses C0h, C1h,
D0h and D1h is enabled.
1
Access to the Baud Rate Generator registers at I/O addresses
C0h, C1h, D0h and D1h is enabled.
6
SB
0
Do not send a BREAK signal.
1
Send Break
UART sends continuous zeroes on the transmit output from
the next bit boundary. The transmit data in the transmit shift
register is ignored. After forcing this bit High, the TxD output
is 0 only after the bit boundary is reached. Just before forcing
TxD to 0, the transmit FIFO is cleared. Any new data written
to the transmit FIFO during a break should be written only
after the THRE bit of UARTx_LSR register goes High. This
new data is transmitted after the UART recovers from the
break. After the break is removed, the UART recovers from
the break for the next BRG edge.
5
FPE
0
Do not force a parity error.
1
Force a parity error. When this bit and the party enable bit
(pen) are both 1, an incorrect parity bit is transmitted with the
data byte.
7
DLAB
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
197
Bit
Position
Value
Description
0
Even Parity Select
Use odd parity for transmit and receive. The total number of 1
bits in the transmit data plus parity bit is odd. Used as SPACE
bit in Multidrop Mode. See Table 104 for parity select
definitions. Note: Receive Parity is set to SPACE in multidrop
mode.
1
Use even parity for transmit and receive. The total number of
1 bits in the transmit data plus parity bit is even. Used as
MARK bit in Multidrop Mode. See Table 104 for parity select
definitions.
3
PEN
0
Parity bit transmit and receive is disabled.
1
Parity bit transmit and receive is enabled. For transmit, a
parity bit is generated and transmitted with every data
character. For receive, the parity is checked for every
incoming data character. In Multidrop Mode, receive parity is
checked for space parity.
[2:0]
CHAR
000–
111
UART Character Parameter Selection
See Table 103 for a description of the values.
4
EPS
Table 103. UART Character Parameter Definition
PS019209-0504
CHAR[2:0]
Character Length
(Tx/Rx Data Bits)
Stop Bits
(Tx Stop Bits)
000
5
1
001
6
1
010
7
1
011
8
1
100
5
2
101
6
2
110
7
2
111
8
2
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
198
Table 104. Parity Select Definition for Multidrop Communications
Multidrop
Mode
Even Parity
Select
Parity Type
0
0
odd
0
1
even
1
0
space
1
1*
mark
Note: *In Multidrop Mode, EPS resets to 0 after the
first character is sent.
UART Modem Control Register
This register is used to control and check the modem status. See Table 105.
Table 105. UART Modem Control Registers
(UART0_MCTL = 00C4h, UART1_MCTL = 00D4h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Reserved
6
POLARITY
0
TxD and RxD signals—Normal Polarity.
1
Invert Polarity of TxD and RxD signals.
5
MDM
0
Multidrop Mode disabled.
1
Multidrop Mode enabled. See Table 104 for parity select
definitions.
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
199
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
4
LOOP
0
LOOP BACK mode is not enabled.
1
LOOP BACK mode is enabled.
The UART operates in internal LOOP BACK mode. The
transmit data output port is disconnected from the internal
transmit data output and set to 1. The receive data input port
is disconnected and internal receive data is connected to
internal transmit data. The modem status input ports are
disconnected and the four bits of the modem control register
are connected as modem status inputs. The two modem
control output ports (OUT1&2) are set to their inactive state
3
OUT2
0–1
No function in normal operation.
In LOOP BACK mode, this bit is connected to the DCD bit in
the UART Status Register.
2
OUT1
0–1
No function in normal operation.
In LOOP BACK mode, this bit is connected to the RI bit in the
UART Status Register.
1
RTS
0–1
Request to Send
In normal operation, the RTS output port is the inverse of this
bit. In LOOP BACK mode, this bit is connected to the CTS bit
in the UART Status Register.
0
DTR
0–1
Data Terminal Ready.
In normal operation, the DTR output port is the inverse of this
bit. In LOOP BACK mode, this bit is connected to the DSR bit
in the UART Status Register.
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
200
UART Line Status Register
This register is used to show the status of UART interrupts and registers. See
Table 106.
Table 106. UART Line Status Registers
(UART0_LSR = 00C5h, UART1_LSR = 00 D5h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
0
Always 0 when operating in with the FIFO disabled. With the
FIFO enabled, this bit is reset when the UARTx_LSR register
is read and there are no more bytes with error status in the
FIFO.
1
Error detected in the FIFO. There is at least 1 parity, framing
or break indication error in the FIFO.
0
Transmit holding register/FIFO is not empty or transmit shift
register is not empty or transmitter is not idle.
1
Transmit holding register/FIFO and transmit shift register are
empty; and the transmitter is idle. This bit cannot be set to 1
during the BREAK condition. This bit only becomes 1 after the
BREAK command is removed.
5
THRE
0
Transmit holding register/FIFO is not empty.
1
Transmit holding register/FIFO. This bit cannot be set to 1
during the BREAK condition. This bit only becomes 1 after the
BREAK command is removed.
4
BI
0
Receiver does not detect a BREAK condition. This bit is reset
to 0 when the UARTx_LSR register is read.
1
Receiver detects a BREAK condition on the receive input line.
This bit is 1 if the duration of BREAK condition on the receive
data is longer than one character transmission time, the time
depends on the programming of the UARTx_LSR register. In
case of FIFO only one null character is loaded into the
receiver FIFO with the framing error. The framing error is
revealed to the eZ80 whenever that particular data is read
from the receiver FIFO.
7
ERR
6
TEMT
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
201
Bit
Position
3
FE
2
PE
1
OE
0
DR
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
0
No framing error detected for character at the top of the FIFO.
This bit is reset to 0 when the UARTx_LSR register is read.
1
Framing error detected for the character at the top of the
FIFO. This bit is set to 1 when the stop bit following the data/
parity bit is logic 0.
0
The received character at the top of the FIFO does not
contain a parity error. In multidrop mode, this indicates that
the received character is a data byte. This bit is reset to 0
when the UARTx_LSR register is read.
1
The received character at the top of the FIFO contains a parity
error. In multidrop mode, this indicates that the received
character is an address byte.
0
The received character at the top of the FIFO does not
contain an overrun error. This bit is reset to 0 when the
UARTx_LSR register is read.
1
Overrun error is detected. If the FIFO is not enabled, this
indicates that the data in the receive buffer register was not
read before the next character was transferred into the
receiver buffer register. If the FIFO is enabled, this indicates
the FIFO was already full when an additional character was
received by the receiver shift register. The character in the
receiver shift register is not put into the receiver FIFO.
0
This bit is reset to 0 when the UARTx_RBR register is read or
all bytes are read from the receiver FIFO.
1
Data ready. If the FIFO is not enabled, this bit is set to 1 when
a complete incoming character is transferred into the receiver
buffer register from the receiver shift register. If the FIFO is
enabled, this bit is set to 1 when a character is received and
transferred to the receiver FIFO.
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
202
UART Modem Status Register
This register is used to show the status of the UART signals. See Table 107.
Table 107. UART Modem Status Registers
(UART0_MSR = 00C6h, UART1_MSR = 00 D6h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
7
DCD
0–1
Data Carrier Detect
In NORMAL mode, this bit reflects the inverted state of the
DCDx input pin. In LOOP BACK mode, this bit reflects the
value of the UARTx_MCTL[3] = out2.
6
RI
0–1
Ring Indicator
In NORMAL mode, this bit reflects the inverted state of the RIx
input pin. In LOOP BACK mode, this bit reflects the value of
the UARTx_MCTL[2] = out1.
5
DSR
0–1
Data Set Ready
In NORMAL mode, this bit reflects the inverted state of the
DSRx input pin. In LOOP BACK mode, this bit reflects the
value of the UARTx_MCTL[0] = DTR.
4
CTS
0–1
Clear to Send
In NORMAL mode, this bit reflects the inverted state of the
CTSx input pin. In LOOP BACK mode, this bit reflects the
value of the UARTx_MCTL[1] = RTS.
3
DDCD
0–1
Delta Status Change of DCD
This bit is set to 1 whenever the DCDx pin changes state. This
bit is reset to 0 when the UARTx_MSR register is read.
2
TERI
0–1
Trailing Edge Change on RI.
This bit is set to 1 whenever a falling edge is detected on the
RIx pin. This bit is reset to 0 when the UARTx_MSR register is
read.
1
DDSR
0–1
Delta Status Change of DSR
This bit is set to 1 whenever the DSRx pin changes state. This
bit is reset to 0 when the UARTx_MSR register is read.
0
DCTS
0–1
Delta Status Change of CTS
This bit is set to 1 whenever the CTSx pin changes state.
This bit is reset to 0 when the UARTx_MSR register is read.
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
203
UART Scratch Pad Register
The UARTx_SPR register can be used by the system as a general-purpose Read/
Write register. See Table 108.
Table 108. UART Scratch Pad Registers
(UART0_SPR = 00C7h, UART1_SPR = 00D7h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
SPR
00h–
FFh
UART scratch pad register is available for use as a generalpurpose Read/Write register.
PRELIMINARY
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
204
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
The eZ80F91 device contains a UART to an infrared encoder/decoder (endec).
The endec is integrated with the on-chip UART0 to allow easy communication
between the CPU and IrDA Physical Layer Specification Version 1.4-compatible
infrared transceivers, as illustrated in Figure 36. Infrared communication provides
secure, reliable, high-speed, low-cost, point-to-point communication between
PCs, PDAs, mobile telephones, printers and other infrared-enabled devices.
eZ80F91
Infrared
Transceiver
System
Clock
RxD
IR_RxD
TxD
IR_TxD
UART0
Baud Rate
Clock
Interrupt
I/O
Signal Address
Data
Infrared
Encoder/Decoder
RxD
TxD
I/O
Data
Address
®
To eZ80 CPU
Figure 36. Infrared System Block Diagram
Functional Description
When the endec is enabled, the transmit data from the on-chip UART is encoded
as digital signals in accordance with the IrDA standard and output to the infrared
transceiver. Likewise, data received from the infrared transceiver is decoded by
the endec and passed to the UART. Communication is half-duplex, meaning that
simultaneous data transmission and reception is not allowed.
The baud rate is set by the UART Baud Rate Generator, which supports IrDA
standard baud rates from 9600 bits/s to 115.2 KBPS. Higher baud rates are possi-
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
205
ble, but do not meet IrDA specifications. The UART must be enabled to use the
endec. Refer to the section covering the Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter on page 183 for more information on the UART and its Baud Rate Generator.
Transmit
The data to be transmitted via the IR transceiver is first data sent to UART0. The
UART transmit signal, TxD, and Baud Rate Clock are used by the endec to generate the modulation signal, IR_TxD, that drives the infrared transceiver. Each
UART bit is 16 clocks wide. If the data to be transmitted is a logical 1 (High), the
IR_TxD signal remains Low (0) for the full 16-clock period. If the data to be transmitted is a logical 0, a 3-clock High (1) pulse is output following a 7-clock Low (0)
period. Following the 3-clock High pulse, a 6-clock Low pulse completes the full
16-clock data period. Data transmission is illustrated in Figure 37. During data
transmission, the IR receive function should be disabled by clearing the IR_RxEN
bit in the IR_CTL reg to 0 to prevent transmitter-to-receiver crosstalk.
16-clock
period
Baud Rate
Clock
UART_TxD
Start Bit = 0
Data Bit 0 = 1
Data Bit 1 = 0
Data Bit 2 = 1
Data Bit 3 = 1
3-clock
pulse
IR_TxD
7-clock
delay
Figure 37. Infrared Data Transmission
Receive
Data received from the IR transceiver via the IR_RxD signal is decoded by the
endec and passed to the UART. The IR_RxEN bit in the IR_CTL register must be
set to enable the receiver decoder. The SIR data format uses half duplex communication. Therefore, the UART should not be allowed to transmit while the receiver
decoder is enabled. The UART Baud Rate Clock is used by the endec to generate
the demodulated signal, RxD, that drives the UART. Each UART bit is 16 clocks
wide. If the data to be received is a logical 1 (High), the IR_RxD signal remains
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
206
High (1) for the full 16-clock period. If the data to be received is a logical 0, a 3clock Low (0) pulse is output following a 7-clock High (1) period. Following the 3clock Low pulse is a 6-clock High pulse to complete the full 16-clock data period.
Data transmission is illustrated in Figure 38.
16-clock
period
Baud Rate
Clock
Start Bit = 0
Data Bit 0 = 1
Data Bit 1 = 0
Data Bit 2 = 1
Data Bit 3 = 1
IR_RxD
1.6 µs
min. pulse
UART_RxD
8-clock
delay
16-clock
period
16-clock
period
16-clock
period
16-clock
period
Figure 38. Infrared Data Reception
Note: The infrared encoder/decoder samples the incoming IR pulses using the baud
rate clock divided by 16. This sampling rate can be insufficient to capture the
incoming pulses when they use a short pulse (1.6 µs) format and low data rates.
When the external transmitter sends a short pulse of 3 clocks of 16 clock periods
(IR_RxD), the infrared encoder/decoder receives the data properly.
Jitter
Due to the inherent sampling of the received IR_RxD signal by the Bit Rate Clock,
some jitter can be expected on the first bit in any sequence of data. However, all
subsequent bits in the received data stream are a fixed 16 clock periods wide.
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Signal Pins
The endec signal pins, IR_TxD and IR_RxD, are multiplexed with General-Purpose I/O (GPIO) pins. These GPIO pins must be configured for alternate function
operation for the endec to operate.
The remaining six UART0 pins, CTS0, DCD0, DSR0, DTR0, RTS and RI0, are not
required for use with the endec. The UART0 modem status interrupt should be
disabled to prevent unwanted interrupts from these pins. The GPIO pins corresponding to these six unused UART0 pins can be used for inputs, outputs, or
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
207
interrupt sources. Recommended GPIO Port D control register settings are provided in Table 109. Refer to the section covering the General-Purpose Input/Output, on page 58 for additional information on setting the GPIO Port modes.
Table 109. GPIO Mode Selection when using the IrDA Encoder/Decoder
GPIO Port D
Bits
Allowable GPIO
Port Mode
Allowable Port Mode Functions
PD0
7
Alternate Function
PD1
7
Alternate Function
PD2–PD7
Any other than GPIO Mode 7
(1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, or 9)
Output, Input, Open-Drain, Open-Source, Levelsensitive Interrupt Input, or Edge-Triggered Interrupt
Input
Loopback Testing
Both internal and external loopback testing can be accomplished with the endec
on the eZ80F91 device. Internal loopback testing is enabled by setting the
LOOP_BACK bit to 1. During internal loopback, the IR_TxD output signal is
inverted and connected on-chip to the IR_RxD input. External loopback testing of
the off-chip IrDA transceiver can be accomplished by transmitting data from the
UART while the receiver is enabled (IR_RxEN set to 1).
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Register
After a RESET, the Infrared Encoder/Decoder Register is set to its default value.
Any Writes to unused register bits are ignored and reads return a value of 0. The
IR_CTL register is described in Table 110.
Table 110. Infrared Encoder/Decoder Control Registers
(IR_CTL = 00BFh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:3]
00000
Reserved.
PRELIMINARY
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
208
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
2
LOOP_BACK
0
Internal LOOP BACK mode is disabled.
1
Internal LOOP BACK mode is enabled.
IR_TxD output is inverted and connected to IR_RxD input for
internal loop back testing.
1
IR_RxEN
0
IR_RxD data is ignored.
1
IR_RxD data is passed to UART0 RxD.
0
IR_EN
0
Endec is disabled.
1
Endec is enabled.
PRELIMINARY
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
209
Serial Peripheral Interface
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a synchronous interface allowing several
SPI-type devices to be interconnected. The SPI is a full-duplex, synchronous,
character-oriented communication channel that employs a four-wire interface. The
SPI block consists of a transmitter, receiver, baud rate generator, and control unit.
During an SPI transfer, data is sent and received simultaneously by both the master and the slave SPI devices.
In a serial peripheral interface, separate signals are required for data and clock.
The SPI can be configured as either a master or a slave. The connection of two
SPI devices (one master and one slave) and the direction of data transfer is demonstrated in Figures 39 and 40 .
MASTER
SS
DATAIN
MISO
Bit 7
Bit 0
8-Bit Shift Register
DATAOUT
SCK
CLKOUT
MISO
DATAOUT
Baud Rate
Generator
Figure 39. SPI Master Device
SLAVE
ENABLE
SS
DATAIN
MOSI
CLKIN
SCK
Bit 0
Bit 7
8-Bit Shift Register
Figure 40. SPI Slave Device
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
210
SPI Signals
The four basic SPI signals are:
•
•
•
•
MISO (Master In, Slave Out)
MOSI (Master Out, Slave In)
SCK (SPI Serial Clock)
SS (Slave Select)
These SPI signals are discussed in the following paragraphs. Each signal is
described in both MASTER and SLAVE modes.
Master In, Slave Out
The Master In, Slave Out (MISO) pin is configured as an input in a master device
and as an output in a slave device. It is one of the two lines that transfer serial
data, with the most-significant bit sent first. The MISO pin of a slave device is
placed in a high-impedance state if the slave is not selected. When the SPI is not
enabled, this signal is in a high-impedance state.
Master Out, Slave In
The Master Out, Slave In (MOSI) pin is configured as an output in a master device
and as an input in a slave device. It is one of the two lines that transfer serial data,
with the most-significant bit sent first. When the SPI is not enabled, this signal is in
a high-impedance state.
Slave Select
The active Low Slave Select (SS) input signal is used to select the SPI as a slave
device. It must be Low prior to all data communication and must stay Low for the
duration of the data transfer.
The SS input signal must be High for the SPI to operate as a master device. If the
SS signal goes Low, a Mode Fault error flag (MODF) is set in the SPI_SR register.
See the SPI Status Register (SPI_SR) on page 217 for more information.
When the Clock Phase (CPHA) is set to 0, the shift clock is the logical OR of SS
with SCK. In this clock phase mode, SS must go High between successive characters in an SPI message. When CPHA is set to 1, SS can remain Low for several
SPI characters. In cases where there is only one SPI slave, its SS line could be
tied Low as long as CPHA is set to 1. See the SPI Control Register (SPI_CTL) on
page 216 for more information on CPHA.
Serial Clock
The Serial Clock (SCK) is used to synchronize data movement both in and out of
the device via its MOSI and MISO pins. The master and slave are each capable of
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
211
exchanging a byte of data during a sequence of eight clock cycles. Because SCK
is generated by the master, the SCK pin becomes an input on a slave device. The
SPI contains an internal divide-by-two clock divider. In MASTER mode, the SPI
serial clock is one-half the frequency of the clock signal created by the SPI’s Baud
Rate Generator.
As demonstrated in Figure 41 and Table 111, four possible timing relations can be
chosen by using the clock polarity (CPOL) and CPHA control bits in the SPI Control register. See the SPI Control Register (SPI_CTL) on page 216. Both the master and slave must operate with the identical timing, CPOL, and CPHA. The
master device always places data on the MOSI line a half-cycle before the clock
edge (SCK signal), for the slave device to latch the data.
Number of Cycles on the SCK Signal
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SCK (CPOL bit = 0)
SCK (CPOL bit = 1)
Sample Input
(CPHA bit = 0) Data Out
MSB
Sample Input
(CPHA bit = 1) Data Out
MSB
6
5
6
4
3
5
4
2
1
3
2
LSB
1
LSB
ENABLE (To Slave)
Figure 41. SPI Timing
Table 111. SPI Clock Phase and Clock Polarity Operation
SS High
PS019209-0504
CPHA
CPOL
SCK
Transmit
Edge
SCK
Receive
Edge
SCK
Idle
State
Between
Characters?
0
0
Falling
Rising
Low
Yes
0
1
Rising
Falling
High
Yes
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
212
Table 111. SPI Clock Phase and Clock Polarity Operation (Continued)
SS High
CPHA
CPOL
SCK
Transmit
Edge
SCK
Receive
Edge
SCK
Idle
State
Between
Characters?
1
0
Rising
Falling
Low
No
1
1
Falling
Rising
High
No
SPI Functional Description
When a master transmits to a slave device via the MOSI signal, the slave device
responds by sending data to the master via the master's MISO signal. The resulting implication is a full-duplex transmission, with both data out and data in synchronized with the same clock signal. As a result, the byte transmitted is replaced
by the byte received to eliminate the requirement for separate transmit-empty and
receive-full status bits. A single status bit, SPIF, is used to signify that the I/O operation is complete. See the SPI Status Register (SPI_SR) on page 217.
The SPI is double-buffered during reads, but not during Writes. If a Write is performed during data transfer, the transfer occurs uninterrupted, and the Write is
unsuccessful. This condition causes the write collision (WCOL) status bit in the
SPI_SR register to be set. After a data byte is shifted, the SPIF flag of the SPI_SR
register is set to 1.
In SPI MASTER mode, the SCK pin functions as an output. It idles High or Low
depending on the CPOL bit in the SPI_CTL register until data is written to the shift
register. Data transfer is initiated by writing to the transmit shift register, SPI_TSR.
Eight clocks are then generated to shift the eight bits of transmit data out via the
MOSI pin while shifting in eight bits of data via the MISO pin. After transfer, the
SCK signal becomes idle.
In SPI SLAVE mode, the start logic receives a logic Low from the SS pin and a
clock input at the SCK pin; as a result, the slave is synchronized to the master.
Data from the master is received serially from the slave MOSI signal and is loaded
into the 8-bit shift register. After the 8-bit shift register is loaded, its data is paralleltransferred to the Read buffer. During a Write cycle, data is written into the shift
register. Next, the slave waits for the SPI master to initiate a data transfer, supply
a clock signal, and shift the data out on the slave's MISO signal.
If the CPHA bit in the SPI_CTL register is 0, a transfer begins when the SS pin
signal goes Low. The transfer ends when SS goes High after eight clock cycles on
SCK. When the CPHA bit is set to 1, a transfer begins the first time SCK becomes
active while SS is Low. The transfer ends when the SPIF flag is set to 1.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
213
SPI Flags
Mode Fault
The Mode Fault flag (MODF) indicates that there can be a multimaster conflict in
the system control. The MODF bit is normally cleared to 0 and is only set to 1
when the master device’s SS pin is pulled Low. When a mode fault is detected,
the following sequence occurs:
1. The MODF flag (SPI_SR[4]) is set to 1.
2. The SPI device is disabled by clearing the SPI_EN bit (SPI_CTL[5]) to 0.
3. The MASTER_EN bit (SPI_CTL[4]) is cleared to 0, forcing the device into
SLAVE mode.
4. If the SPI interrupt is enabled by setting IRQ_EN (SPI_CTL[7]) High, an SPI
interrupt is generated.
Clearing the Mode Fault flag is performed by reading the SPI Status register. The
other SPI control bits (SPI_EN and MASTER_EN) must be restored to their original states by user software after the Mode Fault flag is cleared to 0.
Write Collision
The write collision flag, WCOL (SPI_SR[5]), is set to 1 when an attempt is made to
write to the SPI Transmit Shift register (SPI_TSR) while data transfer occurs.
Clearing the WCOL bit is performed by reading SPI_SR with the WCOL bit set to
1.
SPI Baud Rate Generator
The SPI’s Baud Rate Generator creates a lower frequency clock from the high-frequency system clock. The Baud Rate Generator output is used as the clock
source by the SPI.
Baud Rate Generator Functional Description
The SPI’s Baud Rate Generator consists of a 16-bit downcounter, two 8-bit registers, and associated decoding logic. The Baud Rate Generator’s initial value is
defined by the two BRG Divisor Latch registers {SPI_BRG_H, SPI_BRG_L}. At
the rising edge of each system clock, the BRG decrements until it reaches the
value 0001h. On the next system clock rising edge, the BRG reloads the initial
value from {SPI_BRG_H, SPI_BRG_L) and outputs a pulse to indicate the end of
the count.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
214
The SPI Data Rate can be calculated using the following equation:
SPI Data Rate (bits/s)
=
System Clock Frequency
2 X SPI Baud Rate Generator Divisor
Upon RESET, the 16-bit BRG divisor value resets to 0002h. When the SPI is operating as a Master, the BRG divisor value must be set to a value of 0003h or
greater. When the SPI is operating as a Slave, the BRG divisor value must be set
to a value of 0004h or greater. A software Write to either the Low- or High-byte
registers for the BRG Divisor Latch causes both the Low and High bytes to load
into the BRG counter, and causes the count to restart.
Data Transfer Procedure with SPI Configured as a Master
The sequence that follows details the procedure for transferring data from a master SPI device to a slave SPI device.
1. Load the SPI Baud Rate Generator Registers, SPI_BRG_H and SPI_BRG_L.
The external device must deassert the SS pin if currently asserted.
2. Load the SPI Control Register, SPI_CTL.
3. Assert the ENABLE pin of the slave device using a GPIO pin.
4. Load the SPI Transmit Shift Register, SPI_TSR.
5. When the SPI data transfer is complete, deassert the ENABLE pin of the slave
device.
Data Transfer Procedure with SPI Configured as a Slave
The sequence that follows details the procedure for transferring data from a slave
SPI device to a master SPI device.
1. Load the SPI Baud Rate Generator Registers, SPI_BRG_H and SPI_BRG_L.
2. Load the SPI Transmit Shift Register, SPI_TSR. This load cannot occur while
the SPI slave is currently receiving data.
3. Wait for the external SPI Master device to initiate the data transfer by
asserting SS.
SPI Registers
There are six registers in the Serial Peripheral Interface that provide control, status, and data storage functions. The SPI registers are described in the following
paragraphs.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
215
SPI Baud Rate Generator Registers—Low Byte and High Byte
These registers hold the Low and High bytes of the 16-bit divisor count loaded by
the CPU for baud rate generation. The 16-bit clock divisor value is returned by
{SPI_BRG_H, SPI_BRG_L}. Upon RESET, the 16-bit BRG divisor value resets to
0002h. When configured as a Master, the 16-bit divisor value must be between
0003h and FFFFh, inclusive. When configured as a Slave, the 16-bit divisor value
must be between 0004h and FFFFh, inclusive.
A Write to either the Low- or High-byte registers for the BRG Divisor Latch causes
both bytes to be loaded into the BRG counter and a restart of the count. See
Tables 112 and 113.
Table 112. SPI Baud Rate Generator Register—Low Byte
(SPI_BRG_L = 00B8h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
SPI_BRG_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 16-bit Baud Rate
Generator divider value. The complete BRG divisor value is
returned by {SPI_BRG_H, SPI_BRG_L}.
Table 113. SPI Baud Rate Generator Register—High Byte
(SPI_BRG_H = 00B9h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
SPI_BRG_H
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the High byte of the 16-bit Baud Rate
Generator divider value. The complete BRG divisor value is
returned by {SPI_BRG_H, SPI_BRG_L}.
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
216
SPI Control Register
This register is used to control and setup the serial peripheral interface. The SPI
should be disabled prior to making any changes to CPHA or CPOL. See Table
114.
Table 114. SPI Control Register
(SPI_CTL = 00BAh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
7
IRQ_EN
0
SPI system interrupt is disabled.
1
SPI system interrupt is enabled.
6
0
Reserved.
5
SPI_EN
0
SPI is disabled.
1
SPI is enabled.
4
MASTER_EN
0
When enabled, the SPI operates as a slave.
1
When enabled, the SPI operates as a master.
3
CPOL
0
Master SCK pin idles in a Low (0) state.
1
Master SCK pin idles in a High (1) state.
2
CPHA
0
SS must go High after transfer of every byte of data.
1
SS can remain Low to transfer any number of data bytes.
[1:0]
00
Reserved.
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
217
SPI Status Register
The SPI Status Read Only register returns the status of data transmitted using the
serial peripheral interface. Reading the SPI_SR register clears Bits 7, 6, and 4 to
a logical 0. See Table 115.
Table 115. SPI Status Register
(SPI_SR = 00BBh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value Description
7
SPIF
0
SPI data transfer is not finished.
1
SPI data transfer is finished. If enabled, an interrupt is
generated. This bit flag is cleared to 0 by a Read of the
SPI_SR register.
6
WCOL
0
An SPI write collision is not detected.
1
An SPI write collision is detected. This bit flag is cleared to 0
by a Read of the SPI_SR registers.
5
0
Reserved.
4
MODF
0
A mode fault (multimaster conflict) is not detected.
1
A mode fault (multimaster conflict) is detected. This bit flag is
cleared to 0 by a Read of the SPI_SR register.
[3:0]
0000
Reserved.
SPI Transmit Shift Register
The SPI Transmit Shift register (SPI_TSR) is used by the SPI master to transmit
data over SPI serial bus to the slave device. A Write to the SPI_TSR register
places data directly into the shift register for transmission. A Write to this register
within an SPI device configured as a master initiates transmission of the byte of
the data loaded into the register. At the completion of transmitting a byte of data,
the SPIF status bit (SPI_SR[7]) is set to 1 in both the master and slave devices.
The SPI Transmit Shift Write Only register shares the same address space as the
SPI Receive Buffer Read Only register. See Table 116.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
218
Table 116. SPI Transmit Shift Register
(SPI_TSR = 00BCh)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
X
W
6
X
W
5
X
W
4
X
W
3
X
W
2
X
W
1
X
W
0
X
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
TX_DATA
00h–
FFh
SPI transmit data.
SPI Receive Buffer Register
The SPI Receive Buffer register (SPI_RBR) is used by the SPI slave to receive
data from the serial bus. The SPIF bit must be cleared prior to a second transfer of
data from the shift register; otherwise, an overrun condition exists. In the event of
an overrun, the byte that causes the overrun is lost.
The SPI Receive Buffer Read Only register shares the same address space as
the SPI Transmit Shift Write Only register. See Table 117.
Table 117. SPI Receive Buffer Register
(SPI_RBR = 00BCh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
RX_DATA
00h–
FFh
SPI received data.
PRELIMINARY
Serial Peripheral Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
219
I2C Serial I/O Interface
I2C General Characteristics
The Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) serial I/O bus is a two-wire communication interface that can operate in four modes:
•
•
•
•
MASTER TRANSMIT
MASTER RECEIVE
SLAVE TRANSMIT
SLAVE RECEIVE
The I2C interface consists of a Serial Clock (SCL) and Serial Data (SDA). Both
SCL and SDA are bidirectional lines connected to a positive supply voltage via an
external pull-up resistor. When the bus is free, both lines are High. The output
stages of devices connected to the bus must be configured as open-drain outputs.
Data on the I2C bus can be transferred at a rate of up to 100 kbps in STANDARD
mode, or up to 400 kbps in FAST mode. One clock pulse is generated for each
data bit transferred.
Clocking Overview
If another device on the I2C bus drives the clock line when the I2C is in MASTER
mode, the I2C synchronizes its clock to the I2C bus clock. The High period of the
clock is determined by the device that generates the shortest High clock period.
The Low period of the clock is determined by the device that generates the longest Low clock period.
A slave can stretch the Low period of the clock to slow down the bus master. The
Low period can also be stretched for handshaking purposes. This result can be
accomplished after each bit transfer or each byte transfer. The I2C stretches the
clock after each byte transfer until the IFLG bit in the I2C_CTL register is cleared
to 0.
Bus Arbitration Overview
In MASTER mode, the I2C checks that each transmitted logic 1 appears on the
I2C bus as a logic 1. If another device on the bus overrules and pulls the SDA signal Low, arbitration is lost. If arbitration is lost during the transmission of a data
byte or a Not Acknowledge (NACK) bit, the I2C returns to an idle state. If arbitration is lost during the transmission of an address, the I2C switches to SLAVE
mode so that it can recognize its own slave address or the general call address.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
220
Data Validity
The data on the SDA line must be stable during the High period of the clock. The
High or Low state of the data line can only change when the clock signal on the
SCL line is Low, as illustrated in Figure 42.
SDA Signal
SCL Signal
Data Line
Stable
Data Valid
Change of
Data Allowed
Figure 42. I2C Clock and Data Relationship
START and STOP Conditions
Within the I2C bus protocol, unique situations arise which are defined as START
and STOP conditions. Figure 43 illustrates a High-to-Low transition on the SDA
line while SCL is High, indicating a START condition. A Low-to-High transition on
the SDA line while SCL is High defines a STOP condition.
START and STOP conditions are always generated by the master. The bus is
considered to be busy after a START condition. The bus is considered to be free
for a defined time after a STOP condition.
SDA Signal
SCL Signal
S
P
START Condition
STOP Condition
Figure 43. START and STOP Conditions In I2C Protocol
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
221
Transferring Data
Byte Format
Every character transferred on the SDA line must be a single 8-bit byte. The number of bytes that can be transmitted per transfer is unrestricted. Each byte must
be followed by an Acknowledge (ACK)1. Data is transferred with the most-significant bit (msb) first. Figure 44 illustrates a receiver that holds the SCL line Low to
force the transmitter into a wait state. Data transfer then continues when the
receiver is ready for another byte of data and releases SCL.
SDA Signal
MSB
SCL Signal
1
Acknowledge from
Receiver
Acknowledge from
Receiver
2
8
9
S
START Condition
1
9
ACK
P
STOP Condition
Clock Line Held Low By Receiver
Figure 44. I2C Frame Structure
Acknowledge
Data transfer with an ACK function is obligatory. The ACK-related clock pulse is
generated by the master. The transmitter releases the SDA line (High) during the
ACK clock pulse. The receiver must pull down the SDA line during the ACK clock
pulse so that it remains stable (Low) during the High period of this clock pulse.
See Figure 45.
A receiver that is addressed is obliged to generate an ACK after each byte is
received. When a slave receiver does not acknowledge the slave address (for
example, unable to receive because it is performing some real-time function), the
data line must be left High by the slave. The master then generates a STOP condition to abort the transfer.
If a slave receiver acknowledges the slave address, but cannot receive any more
data bytes, the master must abort the transfer. The abort is indicated by the slave
generating the Not Acknowledge (NACK) on the first byte to follow. The slave
leaves the data line High and the master generates the STOP condition.
1. ACK is defined as a general Acknowledge bit. By contrast, the I2C
Acknowledge bit is represented as AAK, bit 2 of the I2C Control Register,
which identifies which ACK signal to transmit. See Table 127 on page 235.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
222
If a master receiver is involved in a transfer, it must signal the end of the data
stream to the slave transmitter by not generating an ACK on the final byte that is
clocked out of the slave. The slave transmitter must release the data line to allow
the master to generate a STOP or a repeated START condition.
Data Output
by Transmitter
MSB
Data Output
by Receiver
1
S
SCL Signal
from Master
1
2
8
9
START Condition
Clock Pulse for Acknowledge
Figure 45. I2C Acknowledge
Clock Synchronization
All masters generate their own clocks on the SCL line to transfer messages on the
I2C bus. Data is only valid during the High period of each clock.
Clock synchronization is performed using the wired AND connection of the I2C
interfaces to the SCL line, meaning that a High-to-Low transition on the SCL line
causes the relevant devices to start counting from their Low period. When a
device clock goes Low, it holds the SCL line in that state until the clock High state
is reached. See Figure 46. The Low-to-High transition of this clock, however, can
not change the state of the SCL line if another clock is still within its Low period.
The SCL line is held Low by the device with the longest Low period. Devices with
shorter Low periods enter a High wait state during this time.
When all devices count off the Low period, the clock line is released and goes
High. There is no difference between the device clocks and the state of the SCL
line; all of the devices start counting the High periods. The first device to complete
its High period again pulls the SCL line Low. In this way, a synchronized SCL
clock is generated with its Low period determined by the device with the longest
clock Low period, and its High period determined by the device with the shortest
clock High period.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
223
Wait
State
Start Counting
High Period
CLK1 Signal
Counter
Reset
CLK2 Signal
SCL Signal
Figure 46. Clock Synchronization In I2C Protocol
Arbitration
Any master can initiate a transfer if the bus is free. As a result, multiple masters
can each generate a START condition if the bus is free within a minimum period. If
multiple masters generate a START condition, a START is defined for the bus.
However, arbitration defines which MASTER controls the bus. Arbitration takes
place on the SDA line. As mentioned, START conditions are initiated only while
the SCL line is held High. If, during this period, a master (M1) initiates a High-toLow transition—i.e., a START condition—while a second master (M2) transmits a
Low signal on the line, then the first master, M1, cannot take control of the bus. As
a result, the data output stage for M1 is disabled.
Arbitration can continue for many bits. Its first stage is comparison of the address
bits. If the masters are each trying to address the same device, arbitration continues with a comparison of the data. Because address and data information on the
I2C bus is used for arbitration, no information is lost during this process. A master
that loses the arbitration can generate clock pulses until the end of the byte in
which it loses the arbitration.
If a master also incorporates a slave function and it loses arbitration during the
addressing stage, it is possible that the winning master is trying to address it. The
losing master must switch over immediately to its slave receiver mode. Figure 46
illustrates the arbitration procedure for two masters. Of course, more can be
involved, depending on how many masters are connected to the bus. The
moment there is a difference between the internal data level of the master generating DATA 1 and the actual level on the SDA line, its data output is switched off,
which means that a High output level is then connected to the bus. As a result, the
data transfer initiated by the winning master is not affected. Because control of the
I2C bus is decided solely on the address and data sent by competing masters,
there is no central master, nor any order of priority on the bus.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
224
Special attention must be paid if, during a serial transfer, the arbitration procedure
is still in progress at the moment when a repeated START condition or a STOP
condition is transmitted to the I2C bus. If it is possible for such a situation to occur,
the masters involved must send this repeated START condition or STOP condition
at the same position in the format frame. In other words, arbitration is not allowed
between:
•
•
•
A repeated START condition and a data bit
A STOP condition and a data bit
A repeated START condition and a STOP condition
Clock Synchronization for Handshake
The clock-synchronizing mechanism can function as a handshake, enabling
receivers to cope with fast data transfers, on either a byte or a bit level. The byte
level allows a device to receive a byte of data at a fast rate, but allows the device
more time to store the received byte or to prepare another byte for transmission.
Slaves hold the SCL line Low after reception and acknowledge the byte, forcing
the master into a wait state until the slave is ready for the next byte transfer in a
handshake procedure.
Operating Modes
Master Transmit
In MASTER TRANSMIT mode, the I2C transmits a number of bytes to a slave
receiver.
Enter MASTER TRANSMIT mode by setting the STA bit in the I2C_CTL register
to 1. The I2C then tests the I2C bus and transmits a START condition when the
bus is free. When a START condition is transmitted, the IFLG bit is 1 and the status code in the I2C_SR register is 08h. Before this interrupt is serviced, the
I2C_DR register must be loaded with either a 7-bit slave address or the first part
of a 10-bit slave address, with the lsb cleared to 0 to specify TRANSMIT mode.
The IFLG bit should now be cleared to 0 to prompt the transfer to continue.
After the 7-bit slave address (or the first part of a 10-bit address) plus the Write bit
are transmitted, the IFLG is set again. A number of status codes are possible in
the I2C_SR register. See Table 118.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
225
Table 118. I2C Master Transmit Status Codes
Code
I2C State
Microcontroller Response
Next I2C Action
18h
Addr+W transmitted
ACK received1
For a 7-bit address: write byte Transmit data byte,
to DATA, clear IFLG
receive ACK.
Or set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit repeated
START.
Or set STP, clear IFLG
Transmit STOP.
Or set STA & STP, clear IFLG Transmit STOP
then START.
For a 10-bit address: write
Transmit extended
extended address byte to data, address byte.
clear IFLG
20h
Addr+W transmitted,
ACK not received
Same as code 18h
Same as code 18h.
38h
Arbitration lost
Clear IFLG
Return to idle.
Or set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit START
when bus is free.
Arbitration lost,
+W received,
ACK transmitted
Clear IFLG, AAK = 02
Receive data byte,
transmit NACK.
Or clear IFLG, AAK = 1
Receive data byte,
transmit ACK.
78h
Arbitration lost,
General call address
received, ACK
transmitted
Same as code 68h
Same as code 68h.
B0h
Arbitration lost,
SLA+R received,
ACK transmitted3
Write byte to DATA, clear
IFLG, clear AAK = 0
Transmit last byte,
receive ACK.
Or write byte to DATA, clear
IFLG, set AAK = 1
Transmit data byte,
receive ACK.
68h
Notes:
1. W is defined as the Write bit; i.e., the lsb is cleared to 0.
2. AAK is an I2C control bit that identifies which ACK signal to transmit.
3. R is defined as the Read bit; i.e., the lsb is set to 1.
If 10-bit addressing is used, the status code is 18h or 20h after the first part of a
10-bit address, plus the Write bit, are successfully transmitted.
After this interrupt is serviced and the second part of the 10-bit address is transmitted, the I2C_SR register contains one of the codes listed in Table 119.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
226
Table 119. I2C 10-Bit Master Transmit Status Codes
Code
I2C State
Microcontroller Response
Next I2C Action
38h
Arbitration lost
Clear IFLG
Return to idle
Or set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit START
when bus free
Arbitration lost,
SLA+W received,
ACK transmitted1
Clear IFLG, clear AAK = 02
Receive data byte,
transmit NACK
Or clear IFLG, set AAK = 1
Receive data byte,
transmit ACK
Arbitration lost,
SLA+R received,
ACK transmitted3
Write byte to DATA,
clear IFLG, clear AAK = 0
Transmit last byte,
receive ACK
Or write byte to DATA,
clear IFLG, set AAK = 1
Transmit data byte,
receive ACK
Second address byte
+ W transmitted,
ACK received
Write byte to data,
clear IFLG
Transmit data byte,
receive ACK
Or set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit repeated
START
Or set STP, clear IFLG
Transmit STOP
Or set STA & STP,
clear IFLG
Transmit STOP
then
START
Same as code D0h
Same as code D0h
68h
B0h
D0h
D8h
Second address byte
+ W transmitted,
ACK not received
Notes:
1. W is defined as the Write bit; i.e., the lsb is cleared to 0.
2. AAK is an I2C control bit that identifies which ACK signal to transmit.
3. R is defined as the Read bit; i.e., the lsb is set to 1.
If a repeated START condition is transmitted, the status code is 10h instead of
08h.
After each data byte is transmitted, the IFLG is set to 1 and one of the status
codes listed in Table 120 is loaded into the I2C_SR register.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
227
Table 120. I2C Master Transmit Status Codes For Data Bytes
Code
I2C State
28h
Data byte transmitted, Write byte to data,
ACK received
clear IFLG
Microcontroller Response
Next I2C Action
Transmit data byte,
receive ACK.
Or set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit repeated
START.
Or set STP, clear IFLG
Transmit STOP.
Or set STA & STP,
clear IFLG
Transmit START
then STOP.
30h
Data byte transmitted, Same as code 28h
ACK not received
Same as code 28h.
38h
Arbitration lost
Clear IFLG
Return to idle.
Or set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit START
when bus free.
When all bytes are transmitted, the microcontroller should write a 1 to the STP bit
in the I2C_CTL register. The I2C then transmits a STOP condition, clears the STP
bit and returns to an idle state.
Master Receive
In MASTER RECEIVE mode, the I2C receives a number of bytes from a slave
transmitter.
After the START condition is transmitted, the IFLG bit is 1 and the status code 08h
is loaded into the I2C_SR register. The I2C_DR register should be loaded with the
slave address (or the first part of a 10-bit slave address), with the lsb set to 1 to
signify a Read. The IFLG bit should be cleared to 0 as a prompt for the transfer to
continue.
When the 7-bit slave address (or the first part of a 10-bit address) and the Read
bit are transmitted, the IFLG bit is set and one of the status codes listed in Table
121 is loaded into the I2C_SR register.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
228
Table 121. I2C Master Receive Status Codes
Code
I2C State
Microcontroller Response
Next I2C Action
40h
Addr + R transmitted,
ACK received
For a 7-bit address,
clear IFLG, AAK = 01
Receive data byte,
transmit NACK
Or clear IFLG, AAK = 1
Receive data byte,
transmit ACK
For a 10-bit address
Write extended address
byte to data, clear IFLG
Transmit extended
address byte
For a 7-bit address:
Set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit repeated
START
Or set STP, clear IFLG
Transmit STOP
Or set STA & STP,
clear IFLG
Transmit STOP
then START
48h
Addr + R transmitted,
ACK not received2
For a 10-bit address:
Transmit extended
Write extended address byte to address byte
data, clear IFLG
38h
Clear IFLG
Return to idle
Or set STA, clear IFLG
Transmit START
when bus is free
Arbitration lost,
SLA+W received,
ACK transmitted3
Clear IFLG, clear AAK = 0
Receive data byte,
transmit NACK
Or clear IFLG, set AAK = 1
Receive data byte,
transmit ACK
78h
Arbitration lost,
General call addr
received, ACK
transmitted
Same as code 68h
Same as code 68h
B0h
Arbitration lost,
SLA+R received,
ACK transmitted
Write byte to DATA,
clear IFLG, clear AAK = 0
Transmit last byte,
receive ACK
Or write byte to DATA,
clear IFLG, set AAK = 1
Transmit data byte,
receive ACK
68h
Arbitration lost
Notes:
1. AAK is an I2C control bit that identifies which ACK signal to transmit.
2. R is defined as the Read bit; i.e., the lsb is set to 1.
3. W is defined as the Write bit; i.e., the lsb is cleared to 0.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
229
If 10-bit addressing is being used, the slave is first addressed using the full 10-bit
address, plus the Write bit. The master then issues a restart followed by the first
part of the 10-bit address again, this time with the Read bit. The status code then
becomes 40h or 48h. It is the responsibility of the slave to remember that it had
been selected prior to the restart.
If a repeated START condition is received, the status code is 10h instead of 08h.
After each data byte is received, the IFLG is set to 1 and one of the status codes
listed in Table 122 is loaded into the I2C_SR register.
Table 122. I2C Master Receive Status Codes For Data Bytes
Code
I2C State
Microcontroller Response
Next I2C Action
50h
Data byte received,
ACK transmitted
Read data, clear IFLG,
clear AAK = 0*
Receive data byte,
transmit NACK
Or read data, clear IFLG,
set AAK = 1
Receive data byte,
transmit ACK
Read data, set STA,
clear IFLG
Transmit repeated
START
Or read data, set STP,
clear IFLG
Transmit STOP
Or read data, set
STA & STP, clear IFLG
Transmit STOP
then
START
Same as master transmit
Same as master
transmit
58h
38h
Data byte received,
NACK transmitted
Arbitration lost in
NACK bit
Note: AAK is an I2C control bit that identifies which ACK signal to transmit.
When all bytes are received, a NACK should be sent, then the microcontroller
should write a 1 to the STP bit in the I2C_CTL register. The I2C then transmits a
STOP condition, clears the STP bit and returns to an idle state.
Slave Transmit
In SLAVE TRANSMIT mode, a number of bytes are transmitted to a master
receiver.
The I2C enters SLAVE TRANSMIT mode when it receives its own slave address
and a Read bit after a START condition. The I2C then transmits an ACK bit (if the
AAK bit is set to 1); it then sets the IFLG bit in the I2C_CTL register. As a result,
the I2C_SR register contains the status code A8h.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
230
Note: When I2C contains a 10-bit slave address (signified by the address range F0h–
F7h in the I2C_SAR register), it transmits an ACK when the first address byte is
received after a restart. An interrupt is generated and IFLG is set to 1; however,
the status does not change. No second address byte is sent by the master. It is up
to the slave to remember it had been selected prior to the restart.
I2C goes from MASTER mode to SLAVE TRANSMIT mode when arbitration is
lost during the transmission of an address, and the slave address and Read bit
are received. This action is represented by the status code B0h in the I2C_SR register.
The data byte to be transmitted is loaded into the I2C_DR register and the IFLG bit
is cleared to 0. After the I2C transmits the byte and receives an ACK, the IFLG bit
is set to 1 and the I2C_SR register contains B8h. When the final byte to be transmitted is loaded into the I2C_DR register, the AAK bit is cleared when the IFLG is
cleared to 0. After the final byte is transmitted, the IFLG is set and the I2C_SR register contains C8h and the I2C returns to an idle state. The AAK bit must be set to
1 before reentering SLAVE mode.
If no ACK is received after transmitting a byte, the IFLG is set and the I2C_SR register contains C0h. The I2C then returns to an idle state.
If a STOP condition is detected after an ACK bit, the I2C returns to an idle state.
Slave Receive
In SLAVE RECEIVE mode, a number of data bytes are received from a master
transmitter.
The I2C enters SLAVE RECEIVE mode when it receives its own slave address
and a Write bit (lsb = 0) after a START condition. The I2C transmits an ACK bit and
sets the IFLG bit in the I2C_CTL register and the I2C_SR register contains the status code 60h. The I2C also enters SLAVE RECEIVE mode when it receives the
general call address 00h (if the GCE bit in the I2C_SAR register is set). The status
code is then 70h.
Note: When the I2C contains a 10-bit slave address (signified by F0h–F7h in the
I2C_SAR register), it transmits an acknowledge after the first address byte is
received but no interrupt is generated. IFLG is not set and the status does not
change. The I2C generates an interrupt only after the second address byte is
received. The I2C sets the IFLG bit and loads the status code as described above.
I2C goes from MASTER mode to SLAVE RECEIVE mode when arbitration is lost
during the transmission of an address, and the slave address and Write bit (or the
general call address if the CGE bit in the I2C_SAR register is set to 1) are
received. The status code in the I2C_SR register is 68h if the slave address is
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
231
received or 78h if the general call address is received. The IFLG bit must be
cleared to 0 to allow data transfer to continue.
If the AAK bit in the I2C_CTL register is set to 1 then an ACK bit (Low level on
SDA) is transmitted and the IFLG bit is set after each byte is received. The I2C_SR
register contains the two status codes 80h or 90h if SLAVE RECEIVE mode is
entered with the general call address. The received data byte can be read from
the I2C_DR register and the IFLG bit must be cleared to allow the transfer to continue. If a STOP condition or a repeated START condition is detected after the
acknowledge bit, the IFLG bit is set and the I2C_SR register contains status code
A0h.
If the AAK bit is cleared to 0 during a transfer, the I2C transmits a NACK bit (High
level on SDA) after the next byte is received, and sets the IFLG bit to 1. The
I2C_SR register contains the two status codes 88h or 98h if SLAVE RECEIVE
mode is entered with the general call address. The I2C returns to an idle state
when the IFLG bit is cleared to 0.
I2C Registers
Addressing
The CPU interface provides access to six 8-bit registers: four Read/Write registers, one Read Only register and two Write Only registers, as indicated in Table
123.
Table 123. I2C Register Descriptions
Register
Description
I2C_SAR
Slave address register
I2C_XSAR
Extended slave address register
I2C_DR
Data byte register
I2C_CTL
Control register
I2C_SR
Status register (Read Only)
I2C_CCR
Clock Control register (Write Only)
I2C_SRR
Software reset register (Write Only)
Resetting the I2C Registers
Hardware Reset. When the I2C is reset by a hardware reset of the eZ80F91
device, the I2C_SAR, I2C_XSAR, I2C_DR, and I2C_CTL registers are cleared to
00h; while the I2C_SR register is set to F8h.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
232
Software Reset. Perform a software reset by writing any value to the I2C Software
Reset Register (I2C_SRR). A software reset clears the STP, STA, and IFLG bits of
the I2C_CTL register to 0 and sets the I2C back to an idle state.
I2C Slave Address Register
The I2C_SAR register provides the 7-bit address of the I2C when in SLAVE mode
and allows 10-bit addressing in conjunction with the I2C_XSAR register.
I2C_SAR[7:1] = SLA[6:0] is the 7-bit address of the I2C when in 7-bit SLAVE
mode. When the I2C receives this address after a START condition, it enters
SLAVE mode. I2C_SAR[7] corresponds to the first bit received from the I2C bus.
When the register receives an address starting with F7h to F0h (I2C_SAR[7:3] =
11110b), the I2C recognizes that a 10-bit slave addressing mode is being selected.
The I2C sends an ACK after receiving the I2C_SAR byte (the device does not
generate an interrupt at this point). After the next byte of the address (I2C_XSAR)
is received, the I2C generates an interrupt and enters SLAVE mode.Then
I2C_SAR[2:1] are used as the upper 2 bits for the 10-bit extended address. The
full 10-bit address is supplied by {I2C_SAR[2:1], I2C_XSAR[7:0]}. See Table 124.
Table 124. I2C Slave Address Register
(I2C_SAR = 00C8h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:1]
SLA
00h–
7Fh
7-bit slave address or upper 2 bits,I2C_SAR[2:1], of address
when operating in 10-bit mode.
0
GCE
0
I2C not enabled to recognize the General Call Address.
1
I2C enabled to recognize the General Call Address.
I2C Extended Slave Address Register
The I2C_XSAR register is used in conjunction with the I2C_SAR register to provide 10-bit addressing of the I2C when in SLAVE mode. The I2C_SAR value
forms the lower 8 bits of the 10-bit slave address. The full 10-bit address is supplied by {I2C_SAR[2:1], I2C_XSAR[7:0]}.
When the register receives an address starting with F7h to F0h (I2C_SAR[7:3] =
11110b), the I2C recognizes that a 10-bit slave addressing mode is being selected.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
233
The I2C sends an ACK after receiving the I2C_XSAR byte (the device does not
generate an interrupt at this point). After the next byte of the address (I2C_XSAR)
is received, the I2C generates an interrupt and enters SLAVE mode.Then
I2C_SAR[2:1] are used as the upper 2 bits for the 10-bit extended address. The
full 10-bit address is supplied by {I2C_SAR[2:1], I2C_XSAR[7:0]}. See Table 125.
Table 125. I2C Extended Slave Address Register
(I2C_XSAR = 00C9h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
SLAX
00h–
FFh
Least-significant 8 bits of the 10-bit extended slave address.
I2C Data Register
This register contains the data byte/slave address to be transmitted or the data
byte just received. In TRANSMIT mode, the most-significant bit of the byte is
transmitted first. In RECEIVE mode, the first bit received is placed in the most-significant bit of the register. After each byte is transmitted, the I2C_DR register contains the byte that is present on the bus in case a lost arbitration event occurs.
See Table 126.
Table 126. I2C Data Register
(I2C_DR = 00CAh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
DATA
00h–
FFh
I2C data byte.
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
234
I2C Control Register
The I2C_CTL register is a control register that is used to control the interrupts and
the master slave relationships on the I2C bus.
When the Interrupt Enable bit (IEN) is set to 1, the interrupt line goes High when
the IFLG is set to 1. When IEN is cleared to 0, the interrupt line always remains
Low.
When the Bus Enable bit (ENAB) is set to 0, the I2C bus inputs SCLx and SDAx
are ignored and the I2C module does not respond to any address on the bus.
When ENAB is set to 1, the I2C responds to calls to its slave address and to the
general call address if the GCE bit (I2C_SAR[0]) is set to 1.
When the Master Mode Start bit (STA) is set to 1, the I2C enters MASTER mode
and sends a START condition on the bus when the bus is free. If the STA bit is set
to 1 when the I2C module is already in MASTER mode and one or more bytes are
transmitted, then a repeated START condition is sent. If the STA bit is set to 1
when the I2C block is being accessed in SLAVE mode, the I2C completes the data
transfer in SLAVE mode and then enters MASTER mode when the bus is
released. The STA bit is automatically cleared after a START condition is set.
Writing a 0 to the STA bit produces no effect.
If the Master Mode Stop bit (STP) is set to 1 in MASTER mode, a STOP condition
is transmitted on the I2C bus. If the STP bit is set to 1 in slave move, the I2C module operates as if a STOP condition is received, but no STOP condition is transmitted. If both STA and STP bits are set, the I2C block first transmits the STOP
condition (if in MASTER mode), then transmits the START condition. The STP bit
is cleared to 0 automatically. Writing a 0 to this bit produces no effect.
The I2C Interrupt Flag (IFLG) is set to 1 automatically when any of 30 of the possible 31 I2C states is entered. The only state that does not set the IFLG bit is state
F8h. If IFLG is set to 1 and the IEN bit is also set, an interrupt is generated. When
IFLG is set by the I2C, the Low period of the I2C bus clock line is stretched and the
data transfer is suspended. When a 0 is written to IFLG, the interrupt is cleared
and the I2C clock line is released.
When the I2C Acknowledge bit (AAK) is set to 1, an acknowledge is sent during
the acknowledge clock pulse on the I2C bus if:
PS019209-0504
•
Either the whole of a 7-bit slave address or the first or second byte of a 10-bit
slave address is received
•
The general call address is received and the General Call Enable bit in
I2C_SAR is set to 1
•
A data byte is received while in MASTER or SLAVE modes
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
235
When AAK is cleared to 0, a NACK is sent when a data byte is received in MASTER or SLAVE mode. If AAK is cleared to 0 in SLAVE TRANSMIT mode, the byte
in the I2C_DR register is assumed to be the final byte. After this byte is transmitted, the I2C block enters the C8h state, then returns to an idle state. The I2C module does not respond to its slave address unless AAK is set to 1. See Table 127.
Table 127. I2C Control Register
(I2C_CTL = 00CBh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value Description
7
IEN
0
I2C interrupt is disabled.
1
I2C interrupt is enabled.
6
ENAB
0
The I2C bus (SCL/SDA) is disabled and all inputs are
ignored.
1
The I2C bus (SCL/SDA) is enabled.
5
STA
0
Master mode START condition is sent.
1
Master mode start-transmit START condition on the bus.
4
STP
0
Master mode STOP condition is sent.
1
Master mode stop-transmit STOP condition on the bus.
3
IFLG
0
I2C interrupt flag is not set.
1
I2C interrupt flag is set.
2
AAK
0
Not Acknowledge.
1
Acknowledge.
[1:0]
00
Reserved.
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
236
I2C Status Register
The I2C_SR register is a Read Only register that contains a 5-bit status code in
the five most-significant bits; the three least-significant bits are always 0. The
Read Only I2C_SR registers share the same I/O addresses as the Write Only
I2C_CCR registers. See Table 128.
Table 128. I2C Status Registers
(I2C_SR = 00CCh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:3]
STAT
00000–
11111
5-bit I2C status code.
[2:0]
000
Reserved.
There are 29 possible status codes, as listed in Table 129. When the I2C_SR register contains the status code F8h, no relevant status information is available, no
interrupt is generated, and the IFLG bit in the I2C_CTL register is not set. All other
status codes correspond to a defined state of the I2C.
When each of these states is entered, the corresponding status code appears in
this register and the IFLG bit in the I2C_CTL register is set to 1. When the IFLG bit
is cleared, the status code returns to F8h.
Table 129. I2C Status Codes
PS019209-0504
Code
Status
00h
Bus error.
08h
START condition transmitted.
10h
Repeated START condition transmitted.
18h
Address and Write bit transmitted, ACK received.
20h
Address and Write bit transmitted, ACK not received.
28h
Data byte transmitted in MASTER mode, ACK received.
30h
Data byte transmitted in MASTER mode, ACK not received.
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
237
Table 129. I2C Status Codes (Continued)
Code
Status
38h
Arbitration lost in address or data byte.
40h
Address and Read bit transmitted, ACK received.
48h
Address and Read bit transmitted, ACK not received.
50h
Data byte received in MASTER mode, ACK transmitted.
58h
Data byte received in MASTER mode, NACK transmitted.
60h
Slave address and Write bit received, ACK transmitted.
68h
Arbitration lost in address as master, slave address and Write bit received,
ACK transmitted.
70h
General Call address received, ACK transmitted.
78h
Arbitration lost in address as master, General Call address received, ACK
transmitted.
80h
Data byte received after slave address received, ACK transmitted.
88h
Data byte received after slave address received, NACK transmitted.
90h
Data byte received after General Call received, ACK transmitted.
98h
Data byte received after General Call received, NACK transmitted.
A0h
STOP or repeated START condition received in SLAVE mode.
A8h
Slave address and Read bit received, ACK transmitted.
B0h
Arbitration lost in address as master, slave address and Read bit received,
ACK transmitted.
B8h
Data byte transmitted in SLAVE mode, ACK received.
C0h
Data byte transmitted in SLAVE mode, ACK not received.
C8h
Last byte transmitted in SLAVE mode, ACK received.
D0h
Second Address byte and Write bit transmitted, ACK received.
D8h
Second Address byte and Write bit transmitted, ACK not received.
F8h
No relevant status information, IFLG = 0.
If an illegal condition occurs on the I2C bus, the bus error state is entered (status
code 00h). To recover from this state, the STP bit in the I2C_CTL register must be
set and the IFLG bit cleared. The I2C then returns to an idle state. No STOP condition is transmitted on the I2C bus.
Note: The STP and STA bits can be set to 1 at the same time to recover from the bus
error. The I2C then sends a START condition.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
238
I2C Clock Control Register
The I2C_CCR register is a Write Only register. The seven LSBs control the frequency at which the I2C bus is sampled and the frequency of the I2C clock line
(SCL) when the I2C is in MASTER mode. The Write Only I2C_CCR registers
share the same I/O addresses as the Read Only I2C_SR registers. See Table
130.
Table 130. I2C Clock Control Registers
(I2C_CCR = 00CCh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Read only.
Bit
Position
Value Description
7
0
[6:3]
M
0000– I2C clock divider scalar value.
1111
[2:0]
N
000–
111
Reserved.
I2C clock divider exponent.
The I2C clocks are derived from the system clock of the eZ80F91 device. The frequency of this system clock is fSCK. The I2C bus is sampled by the I2C block at the
frequency fSAMP supplied by the following equation:
fSAMP
=
fSCLK
2N
In MASTER mode, the I2C clock output frequency on SCL (fSCL) is supplied by the
following equation:
fSCL =
fSCLK
10 • (M + 1)(2)N
The use of two separately-programmable dividers allows the MASTER mode output frequency to be set independently of the frequency at which the I2C bus is
sampled. This feature is particularly useful in multimaster systems because the
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
239
frequency at which the I2C bus is sampled must be at least 10 times the frequency
of the fastest master on the bus to ensure that START and STOP conditions are
always detected. By using two programmable clock divider stages, a high sampling frequency can be ensured while allowing the MASTER mode output to be
set to a lower frequency.
Bus Clock Speed
The I2C bus is defined for bus clock speeds up to 100 kbps (400 kbps in FAST
mode).
To ensure correct detection of START and STOP conditions on the bus, the I2C
must sample the I2C bus at least ten times faster than the bus clock speed of the
fastest master on the bus. The sampling frequency should therefore be at least
1 MHz (4 MHz in FAST mode) to guarantee correct operation with other bus masters.
The I2C sampling frequency is determined by the frequency of the eZ80F91 system clock and the value in the I2C_CCR bits 2 to 0. The bus clock speed generated by the I2C in MASTER mode is determined by the frequency of the input
clock and the values in I2C_CCR[2:0] and I2C_CCR[6:3].
I2C Software Reset Register
The I2C_SRR register is a Write Only register. Writing any value to this register
performs a software reset of the I2C module. See Table 131.
Table 131. I2C Software Reset Register
(I2C_SRR = 00CDh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
SRR
00h–
FFh
Writing any value to this register performs a software reset of
the I2C module.
PRELIMINARY
I2C Serial I/O Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
240
Ethernet Media Access Controller
The Ethernet Media Access Controller (EMAC) is a full-function 10/100 Mbps
media access control module with a Media-Independent Interface (MII). This
EMAC and interface combination is called a EMACMII module. Figure 47 presents an illustration of the EMAC block.
MDIO
MDC
Memory
RxD
RxCLK
RxDV
RxER
TxFIFO
Arbiter
MII Interface
TxDMA
Ethernet Media Access Controller
TxD
TxCLK
TxER
TxEN
COL
CRS
RxD
RxD/CTRL
RxFIFO
Accept
CTRL
RxDMA
Reject
Figure 47. EMAC Block Diagram
The EMACMII module consists of six submodules that represent the Transmit and
Receive portions of the Ethernet MAC, plus the EMAC sublayer module. In addition, there is a host interface module, a central clock and reset module, and an MII
management module. There are many different applications possible, including
network interface designs, Ethernet switching designs, and test equipment
designs.
The EMAC functions are contained in the Transmit and Receive modules. These
modules represent the core MAC. 802.3x flow control implemented by the EMAC
sublayer module.
The MII management module provides a two-wire control/status path to the MII
PHY. Read and Write communication to and from registers within the PHY is
accomplished via the host interface.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
241
Note: MII PHY is a Physical Layer transceiver device; PHY does not refer to the
eZ80F91 system clock output pin, PHI.
The MII management module provides a two-wire control/status path to the MII .
Read and Write communication to and from registers within the PHY is accomplished via the host interface.
EMAC Functional Description
The EMAC block implements memory, arbiter, and transmit and receive direct
memory access functions, as described in this section.
Memory
EMAC memory is the shared Ethernet memory location of the Transmit and
Receive buffers. This memory is broken into two parts: the Tx buffer and the Rx
buffer. The Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer Register, EmacTLBP, is the register
that holds the starting address of the Tx buffer. The Boundary Pointer Register,
EmacBP, points to the start of the Rx buffer (end of Tx buffer + 1). The Receive
High Boundary Pointer Register, EmacRHBP, points to the end of the Rx buffer +
1. The Tx and Receive buffers are divided into packet buffers of either 256, 128,
64, or 32 bytes. These buffer sizes are selected by EmacBufSize register bits 7
and 6.
The EmacBlksLeft register contains the number of Receive packet buffers remaining in the Rx buffer. This buffer can be used for software flow control. If the
Block_Level is nonzero (bits 5:0 of the EmacBufSize register), hardware flow control is enabled. If in Full Duplex Mode, the EMAC transmits a pause control frame
when the EmacBlksLeft register is less than the Block_Level. In Half Duplex
mode, the EMAC continually transmits a nibble pattern of hexadecimal 5’s to jam
the channel.
Four pointers are defined for reading and writing the Tx and Rx buffers. The
Transmit Write Pointer, TWP, is a software pointer that points to the next available
packet buffer. The TWP is reset to the value stored in EmacTLBP. The Transmit
Read Pointer, TRP, is a hardware pointer in the Transmit Direct Memory Access
Register, TxDMA, that contains the address of the next packet to be transmitted. It
is automatically reset to the EmacTLBP. The Receive Write Pointer, RWP, is a
hardware pointer in the Receive Direct Memory Access Register, RxDMA, which
contains the storage address of the incoming packet. The RWP pointer is automatically initialized to the Boundary Pointer registers. The Receive Read Pointer,
RRP, is a software pointer to where the next packet should be read from. The
RRP pointer should be initialized to the Boundary Pointer registers. For the hardware flow control to function properly, the software must update the hardware
RRP (EmacRrp) pointer whenever the software version is updated. The RxDMA
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
242
uses RWP and the RRP to determine how many packet buffers remain in the Rx
buffer.
Arbiter
The arbiter controls access to EMAC memory. It prioritizes the requests for memory access between the CPU, the TxDMA, and the RxDMA. The TxDMA offers
two levels of priority: a high priority when the TxFIFO is less than half full and a
Low priority when the TxFIFO is more than half full. Similarly, the RxDMA offers
two levels of priority: a high priority when the RxFIFO is more than half full and a
Low priority when the RxFIFO is less than half full.
The arbiter determines resolution between the CPU, the RxDMA, and the TxDMA
requests to access EMAC memory. Post writing for CPU Writes results in zerowait-state write access timing when the CPU assumes the highest priority. CPU
Reads require a minimum of 1 wait state and can take more when the CPU does
not hold the highest priority. The CPU Read wait state is not a user-controllable
operation, because it is controlled by the arbiter. The RxDMA and TxDMA
requests are not allowed to occur back-to-back. Therefore, the maximum throughput rate for the two Direct Memory Access (DMA) ports is 25 megabytes per second each (one byte every 2 clocks) when the system clock is running at 50 MHz.
The rate is reduced to 20 megabytes per second for a 40 MHz system clock. The
arbiter uses the internal WAIT signal to add wait states to CPU access when
required. See Table 132.
Table 132. Arbiter Priority
Priority
Level
Device
Serviced
Flags
0
RxDMA High
RxFIFO > half full (FAF)
1
TxDMA High
TxFIFO < half full (FAE)
2
eZ80® CPU
3
RxDMA Low
RxFIFO < half full (FAE)
4
TxDMA Low
TxFIFO > half full (FAF)
TxDMA
The TxDMA module moves the next packet to be transmitted from EMAC memory
into the TxFIFO. Whenever the polling timer expires, the TxDMA reads the High
status byte from the Tx descriptor table pointed to by the Transmit Read Pointer,
TRP. Polling continues until the High status Read reaches bit 7, when the
Emac_Owns ownership semaphore, bit 15 of the descriptor table (see Table 134)
is set to 1. The TxDMA then initializes the packet length counter with the size of
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
243
the packet from descriptor table bytes 3 and 4. The TxDMA moves the data into
the TxFIFO until the packet length counter downcounts to zero. The TxDMA then
waits for Transmission Complete signal to be asserted to indicate that the packet
is sent and that the Transmit status from the EMAC is valid. The TxDMA updates
the descriptor table status and resets the ownership semaphore, bit 15. Finally,
the Tx_DONE_STAT bit of the EMAC Interrupt Status Register is set to 1, the
address field, DMA_Address, is updated from the descriptor table next pointer, NP
(see Figure 50). The High byte of the status is read to determine if the next packet
is ready to be transmitted.
While the TxDMA is filling the TxFIFO, it monitors two signals from the Transmit
FIFO State Machine (TxFifoSM) to detect error conditions and to determine if the
packet is to be retransmitted (TxDMA_Retry asserted) or the packet is aborted
(TxDMA_Abort asserted). If the packet is aborted, the TxDMA updates the
descriptor status and moves to the next packet. If the packet is to be retried, the
DMA_Address is reset to the start of the packet, the packet length counter is
reloaded from the descriptor table, bytes 3 and 4, and the packet is moved into
the TxFIFO again. When an abort or retry event occurs, the TxDMA asserts the
appropriate signal to reset the TxFIFO Read and Write pointers which clears out
any data that is in the FIFO. The TxFifoSM negates the TxDMA_Abort and/or
TxDMA_Retry signal(s) when the TxFCWP signal is High. This handshaking
maintains synchronization between the TxDMA and the TxFifoSM.
RxDMA
The RxDMA reads the data from the RxFIFO and stores it in the EMAC memory
Receive buffer. When the end of the packet is detected, the RxDMA reads the
next two bytes from the RxFIFO and writes them into the Rx descriptor status LSB
and MSB. The packet length counter is stored into the descriptor table packet
length field, the descriptor table next pointer is written into the Rx descriptor table
and finally the Rx_DONE_STAT bit in the EMAC Interrupt Status Register register
is set to 1.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
244
EMAC Interrupts
Eight different sources of interrupts from the EMAC are described in Table 133.
Table 133. EMAC Interrupts
Interrupt
Description
EMAC System Interrupts
Transmit State Machine Error
Bit 7 (TxFSMERR_STAT) of the EMAC Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT). A Transmit State Machine Error should never
occur. However, if this bit is set, the entire transmitter module
must be reset.
MIIMGT Done
Bit 6 (MGTDONE_STAT) of the Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT). This bit is set when communicating to the PHY
over the MII during a Read or Write operation.
Receive Overrun
Bit 2 (Rx_OVR_STAT) of the Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT). If this bit is set, all incoming packets are ignored
until this bit is cleared by software.
EMAC Transmitter Interrupts
Transmit Control Frame
Transmit Control Frame = Bit 1 (Tx_CF_STAT) of the Interrupt
Status Register (EMAC_ISTAT). Denotes when control frame
transmission is complete.
Transmit Done
Bit 0 (Tx_DONE_STAT) of the Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT). Denotes when packet transmission is complete.
EMAC Receiver Interrupts
Receive Control Frame
Bit 5 (Rx_CF_STAT) of the Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT). Denotes when control frame reception is
complete.
Receive Pause Control Frame
Bit 4 (Rx_PCF_STAT) of the Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT). Denotes when pause control frame reception is
complete.
Receive Done
Bit 3 (Rx_DONE_STAT) of the Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT). Denotes when control frame reception is
complete.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
245
EMAC Shared Memory Organization
Internal Ethernet SRAM shares memory with the CPU. This memory is divided
into the Transmit buffer and the Receive buffer by defining three registers, as
listed below.
•
Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer (TLBP)—this register points to the start of
the Transmit buffer in the internal Ethernet shared memory space
•
•
Boundary Pointer (BP)—this register points to the start of the Receive buffer
Receive High Boundary Pointer (RHBP)—this register points to the end of the
Receive buffer + 1
This internal Ethernet shared memory is depicted in Figure 48.
TLBP
Tx Buffer
BP
Rx Buffer
RHBP
Figure 48. internal Ethernet Shared Memory
The Transmit and Receive buffers are able to be subdivided into packet buffers of
32, 64, 128, or 256 bytes in size. The packet buffer size is set in bits 7 and 6 of the
EmacBufSize register. An Ethernet packet can accommodate multiple packet buffers. At the start of each packet is a descriptor table that describes the packet.
Each actual Ethernet packet follows the descriptor table, as illustrated in
Figure 49.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
246
Offset
TWP
0000h
Descriptor
Table
0007h
Ethernet
Packet
Figure 49. Descriptor Table
The descriptor table contains three entries: the next pointer (NP), the packet size
(Pkt_Size) and the packet status (Stat), as illustrated in Figure 50.
Offset
TWP
0000h
NP
0003h
Pkt_Size
0005h
Stat
Figure 50. Descriptor Table Entries
NP is a 24-bit pointer to the start of the next packet. Pkt_Size contains the number
of bytes of data in the Ethernet packet, including the four CRC bytes, but does not
contain the seven descriptor table bytes. Stat contains the status of the packet.
Stat differs for Transmit and Receive packets. See Tables 134 and 135.
Table 134. Transmit Descriptor Status
Bit
Name
Description
15
TxOwner
0 = Host (eZ80®) owns, 1 = EMAC owns.
14
TxAbort
1 = Packet aborted (not transmitted).
13
TxBPA
1 = Back pressure applied.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
247
Table 134. Transmit Descriptor Status
Bit
Name
Description
12
TxHuge
1 = Packet size is very large (Pkt_Size > EmacMaxf).
11
TxLOOR
1 = Type/Length field is out of range (larger than 1518 bytes).
10
TxLCError
1 = Type/Length field is not a Type field and it does not match the
actual data byte length of the Ethernet packet. The data byte length is
the number of bytes of data in the Ethernet packet between the Type/
Length field and the FCS.
9
TxCrcError
1 = The packet contains an invalid FCS (CRC). This flag is set when
CRCEN = 0 and the last 4 bytes of the packet are not the valid FCS.
8
TxPktDeferred
1 = Packet is deferred.
7
TxXsDfr
1 = Packet is excessively deferred. (> 6071 nibble times in 100 BaseT
or 24,287 bit times in 10 BaseT).
6
TxFifoUnderRun
1 = TxFIFO experiences Underrun. Check the TxAbort bit to see if the
packet is aborted or retried.
5
TxLateCol
1 = A late collision occurs. Collision is detected at a byte count >
EmacCfg2[5:0]. Collisions detected before the byte count reaches
EmacCfg2[5:0] are early collisions and retried.
4
TxMaxCol
1 = The maximum number of collisions occurs. # Collisions >
EmacCfg3[3:0]. These packets are aborted.
[3:0]
TxNumberOfCollisions
This field contains the number of collisions that occur while
transmitting the packet.
Table 135. Receive Descriptor Status
Bit
Name
Description
15
RxOK
1 = Packet received intact.
14
RxAlignError
1 = An odd number of nibbles is received.
13
RxCrcError
1 = The CRC (FCS) is in error.
12
RxLongEvent
1 = A Long or Dropped Event occurs. A Long Event is when a packet
over 50,000 bit times occurs. A Dropped Packet can occur if the
minimum interpacket gap is not met, the preamble is not pure, and the
EmacCfg3[PUREP] bit is set, or if a preamble over 11 bytes in length
is detected and the EmacCfg3[LONGP] bit is set to 1.
11
RxPCF
1 = The packet is a pause control frame.
10
RxCF
1 = The packet is a control frame.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
248
Table 135. Receive Descriptor Status (Continued)
Bit
Name
Description
9
RxMcPkt
1 = The packet contains a multicast address.
8
RxBcPkt
1 = The packet contains a broadcast address.
7
RxVLAN
1 = The packet is a VLAN packet.
6
RxUOpCode
1 = An unsupported Op Code is indicated in the Op Code field of the
Ethernet packet.
5
RxLOOR
1 = The Type/Length field is out of range (larger than 1518 bytes).
4
RxLCError
1 = Type/Length field is not a Type field and it does not match the
actual data byte length of the Ethernet packet. The data byte length is
the number of bytes of data in the Ethernet packet between the Type/
Length field and the FCS.
3
RxCodeV
1 = A code violation is detected. The PHY asserts Rx error (RxER).
2
RxCEvent
1 = A carrier event is previously seen. This event is defined as Rx
error RxER = 1, receive data valid (RxDV) = 0 and receive data (RxD)
= Eh.
1
RxDvEvent
1 = A receive data (RxDV) event is previously seen. Indicates that the
last Receive event is not long enough to be a valid packet.
0
RxOVR
1 = A Receive Overrun occurs in this packet. An overrun occurs when
all of the EMAC Receive buffers are in use and the Receive FIFO is
full. The hardware ignores all incoming packets until the EmacIStat
Register [Rx_Ovr] bit is cleared by the software. There is no indication
as to how many packets are ignored.
EMAC and the System Clock
Effective Ethernet throughput in any given system is dependent upon factors such
as system clock speed, network protocol overhead, application complexity, and
network traffic conditions at any given moment. The following information provides
a general guideline about the effects of system clock speed on Ethernet operation.
The eZ80F91 MCU's EMAC block performs a synchronous function that is
designed to operate over a wide range of system clock frequencies. To understand its maximum data transfer capabilities at certain system operating frequencies, the user must first understand the internal data bus bandwidth that is
required under ideal conditions.
For 10 BaseT Ethernet connectivity, the data rate is 10 Mbits per second, which
equates to 1.25 Mbytes per second. If the eZ80F91 MCU is operating in full duplex
mode over 10BaseT, the data rate for RX data and TX data is 1.25 Mbytes per
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
249
second. Because raw data transfers at this rate consume a certain amount of
CPU bandwidth, the CPU must support traffic from both directions as well as
operate at a minimum clock frequency of (1.25 + 1.25) * 2 = 5 Mhz while transferring Ethernet packets to and from the physical layer.
Similarly, for 100 BaseT Ethernet, the data rate is 100 Mbits per second, which
equates to 12.5 Mbytes per second. If the eZ80F91 MCU is operating in full duplex
mode over 100 BaseT, the data rate for RX data and TX data is 12.5 Mbytes per
second. Because raw data transfers at this rate consume a certain amount of
CPU bandwidth, the CPU must support traffic from both directions as well as
operate at a minimum clock frequency of (12.5 + 12.5) x 2 = 50 Mhz while transferring Ethernet packets to and from the physical layer. Consequently, 50 MHz is
the minimum system clock speed that the eZ80® CPU requires to sustain EMAC
data transfers while not also including any software overhead or additional eZ80®
tasks.
The FIFO functionality of the EMAC operates at any frequency as long as the user
application avoids overrun and underrun errors via higher-level flow control.
Actual application requirements will dictate Ethernet modes of operation (fullduplex, half-duplex, etc.). Because each user and application is different, it
becomes the user’s responsibility to control the data flow with these parameters.
Under ideal conditions, the system clock will operate somewhere between 5 MHz
and 50 MHz to handle the EMAC data rates.
EMAC Operation in HALT Modes
When the CPU is in HALT mode, the eZ80F91 device’s EMAC block cannot be
disabled as can other peripherals. Upon receipt of an Ethernet packet, a
maskable Receive interrupt is generated by the EMAC block, just as it would be in
a non-halt mode. Accordingly, the processor wakes up and continues with the
user-defined application.
EMAC Registers
After a system reset, all EMAC registers are set to their default values. Any Writes
to unused registers or register bits are ignored and reads return a value of 0. For
compatibility with future revisions, unused bits within a register should always be
written with a value of 0. Read/Write attributes, reset conditions, and bit descriptions of all of the EMAC registers are provided in this section.
EMAC Test Register
The EMAC Test Register allows test functionality of the EMAC module. Available
test modes are defined for bits [6:0]. See Table 136.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
250
Table 136. EMAC Test Register
(EMAC_ TEST = 0020h)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R/W
5
0
R/W
4
0
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write, R = Read Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Reserved.
6
TEST_FIFO
0
FIFO test mode disabled—normal operation.
1
FIFO test mode enabled.
5
TxRx_SEL
0
Select the Receive FIFO when FIFO test mode is enabled.
1
Select the Transmit FIFO when FIFO test mode is enabled.
4
SSTC
0
Normal operation.
1
Short Cut Slot Timer Counter. Slot time is shortened to
speed up simulation.
3
SIMR
0
Normal operation.
1
Simulation Reset.
2
0
FRC_OVR_ERR
1
Normal operation.
1
0
FRC_UND_ERR
1
Normal operation.
0
LPBK
0
Normal operation.
1
EMAC Transmit interface is looped back into EMAC
Receive interface.
Force Overrun error in Receive FIFO.
Force Underrun error in Transmit FIFO.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
251
EMAC Configuration Register 1
The EMAC Configuration Register 1 allows control of the padding, autodetection,
cyclic redundancy checking (CRC) control, full duplex, field length checking, maximum packet ignores, and proprietary header options. See Table 137.
Table 137. EMAC Configuration Register 1
(EMAC_CFG1 = 0021h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
0
No padding. Assume all frames presented to EMAC have
proper length.
1
EMAC pads all short frames by adding zeroes to the end of
the data field. This bit is used in conjunction with ADPADN
and VLPAD.
6
ADPADN
0
Disable autodetection.
1
Enable frame detection by comparing the two octets following
the source address with 0x8100 (VLAN Protocol ID) and pad
accordingly. This bit is ignored if PADEN is cleared to 0.
5
VLPAD
0
Do not pad all short frames.
1
EMAC pads all short frames to 64 bytes and append a valid
CRC. This bit is ignored if PADEN is cleared to 0.
4
CRCEN
0
Do not append CRC.
1
Append CRC to every frame regardless of padding options.
3
FULLD
0
Half-duplex mode. CSMA/CD is enabled.
1
Enable full duplex mode. CSMA/CD is disabled.
2
FLCHK
0
Ignore the length field within Transmit/Receive frames.
1
Both Transmit and Receive frame lengths are compared to
the length/type field. If the length/type field represents a
length then the frame length check is performed.
1
HUGEN
0
Limit the Receive frame-size to the number of bytes specified
in the MAXF[15:0] field.
1
Allow unlimited sized frames to be received. Ignore the
MAXF[15:0] field.
7
PADEN
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
252
Bit
Position
0
DCRCC
Value
Description
0
No proprietary header. Normal operation.
1
Four bytes of proprietary header (ignored by CRC) exists on
the front of IEEE 802.3 frames.
Table 138 shows the results of different settings for bits [7:4} of EMAC Configuration Register 1.
Table 138. CRC/PAD Features of EMAC Configuration Register
ADPADN
VLPADN
PADEN
0
0
0
0
No pad or CRC appended.
0
0
0
1
CRC appended.
0
0
1
0
Pad to 60 bytes if necessary; append CRC (min. size =
64).
0
0
1
1
Pad to 60 bytes if necessary; append CRC (min. size =
64).
0
1
0
0
No pad or CRC appended.
0
1
0
1
CRC appended.
0
1
1
0
Pad to 64 bytes if necessary, append CRC (min. size =
68).
0
1
1
1
Pad to 64 bytes if necessary, append CRC (min. size =
68).
1
0
0
0
No pad or CRC appended.
1
0
0
1
CRC appended.
1
0
1
0
If VLAN not detected, pad to 60, add CRC.
If VLAN detected, pad to 64, add CRC.
1
0
1
1
If VLAN not detected, pad to 60, add CRC.
If VLAN detected, pad to 64, add CRC.
1
1
0
0
No pad or CRC appended.
1
1
0
1
CRC appended.
1
1
1
0
If VLAN not detected, pad to 60, add CRC.
If VLAN detected, pad to 64, add CRC.
1
1
1
1
If VLAN not detected, pad to 60, add CRC.
If VLAN detected, pad to 64, add CRC.
PS019209-0504
CRCEN Result
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
253
EMAC Configuration Register 2
The EMAC Configuration Register 2 controls the behavior of the back pressure
and late collision data from the Descriptor table. See Table 139.
Table 139. EMAC Configuration Register 2
(EMAC_CFG2 = 0022h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
0
Use normal back-off algorithm prior to transmitting packet. No
back pressure applied.
1
After incidentally causing a collision during back pressure, the
EMAC immediately (i.e., no back-off) retransmits the packet
without back-off, which reduces the chance of further
collisions and ensures that the Transmit packets are sent.
6
NOBO
0
Enable exponential back-off.
1
The EMAC immediately retransmits following a collision rather
than use the binary exponential backfill algorithm, as specified
in the IEEE 802.3 specification.
[5:0]
LCOL
00h–
3Fh
Sets the number of bytes after Start Frame Delimiter (SFD)
for which a late collision can occur. By default, all late
collisions are aborted.
7
BPNB
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
254
EMAC Configuration Register 3
The EMAC Configuration Register 3 controls preamble length and value, excessive deferment, and the number of retransmission tries. See Table 140.
Table 140. EMAC Configuration Register 3
(EMAC_CFG3 = 0023h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
0
The EMAC allows any preamble length as per the IEEE 802.3
specification.
1
The EMAC only allows Receive packets that contain
preamble fields less than 12 bytes in length.
6
PUREP
0
No preamble error checking is performed.
1
The EMAC verifies the content of the preamble to ensure that
it contains a value of 55h and that it is error-free. Packets
containing an errored preamble are discarded.
5
XSDFR
0
The EMAC aborts when the excessive deferral limit is
reached.
1
The EMAC defers to the carrier indefinitely as per the IEEE
802.3 specification.
4
BITMD
0
Disable 10 Mbps ENDEC mode.
1
Enable 10 Mbps ENDEC mode.
[3:0]
RETRY
0h–Fh
A programmable field specifying the number of retransmission
attempts following a collision before aborting the packet due
to excessive collisions.
7
LONGP
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
255
EMAC Configuration Register 4
The EMAC Configuration Register 4 controls pause control frame behavior, back
pressure, and receive frame acceptance. See Table 141.
Table 141. EMAC Configuration Register 4
(EMAC_CFG4 = 0024h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Reserved.
6
TPCF
0
Do not transmit a pause control frame.
1
Transmit pause control frame (full duplex mode). TPCF
continually sends pause control frames until negated.
5
THDF
0
Disable back pressure.
1
EMAC asserts back pressure on the link. Back pressure
causes preamble to be transmitted, raising carrier sense (half
duplex mode).
4
PARF
0
Only accept frames that meet preset criteria (i.e. address,
CRC, length, etc.).
1
All frames are received regardless of address, CRC, length,
etc.
3
RxFC
0
EMAC ignores received pause control frames.
1
EMAC acts upon pause control frames received.
2
TxFC
0
PAUSE control frames are NOT allowed to be transmitted.
1
PAUSE control frames are allowed to be transmitted.
1
TPAUSE
0
Do not force a pause condition.
1
Force a pause condition while this bit is asserted.
0
RxEN
0
Do not receive frames.
1
Allow Receive frames to be received.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
256
EMAC Station Address Register
The EMAC Station Address register is used for two functions. In the address recognition logic for Receive frames, EMAC_STAD_0–EMAC_STAD_5 are matched
against the 6-byte Destination Address (DA) field of the Receive frame.
EMAC_STAD_0 is matched against the first byte of the Receive frame, and
EMAC_STAD_5 is matched against the sixth byte of the Receive frame. Bit 0 of
EMAC_STAD_0 (STAD[40]) is matched against the first bit (Unicast/Multicast bit)
of the first byte of the Receive frame. This bit ordering is used to logically map the
PE-MACMII station address, as exemplified below.
EMAC_STAD0[7:0] contains STAD[47:40]
•
•
EMAC_STAD5[7:0] contains STAD[7:0]
The second function of the EMAC Station Address registers is to provide the
Source Address (SA) field of Transmit Pause frames when these frames are
transmitted by the EMAC. EMAC_STAD_0 provides the first byte of the 6-byte SA
field and EMAC_STAD_5 provides the final byte of the SA field in order of transmission. The LSB is the first byte sent out. The EMAC Station Address register is
detailed in Table 142.
Table 142. EMAC Station Address Register
(EMAC_STAD_0 = 0025h, EMAC_STAD_1 = 0026h, EMAC_STAD_2 = 0027h,
EMAC_STAD_3 = 0028h, EMAC_STAD_4 = 0029h, EMAC_STAD_5 = 002Ah)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EMAC_STAD_0 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_STAD_1 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_STAD_2 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_STAD_3 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_STAD_4 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_STAD_5 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_STAD_x
00h–
FFh
This 48-bit station address comprises {EMAC_STAD_5,
EMAC_STAD_4, EMAC_STAD_3, EMAC_STAD_2,
EMAC_STAD_1, EMAC_STAD_0}.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
257
EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value Register—Low and High Bytes
The Low and High bytes of the EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value Register are
inserted into outgoing pause control frames. See Tables 143 and 144.
Table 143. EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_TPTV_L = 002Bh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_TPTV_L
00h–
FFh
The 16-bit value, {EMAC_TPTV_H, EMAC_TPTV_L}, is
inserted into outgoing pause control frames as the pause
timer value upon asserting TPCF.
Table 144. EMAC Transmit Pause Timer Value Register—High Byte
(EMAC_TPTV_H = 002Ch)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_TPTV_H FFh
PS019209-0504
Description
The 16-bit value, {EMAC_TPTV_H, EMAC_TPTV_L}, is
inserted into outgoing pause control frames as the pause
timer value upon asserting TPCF.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
258
EMAC Interpacket Gap
EMAC Interpacket Gap Overview
Interpacket gap (IPG) is measured between the last nibble of the frame check
sequence (FCS) and the first nibble of the preamble of the next packet. Three registers are available to fine tune the IPG, the EMAC_IPGT, EMAC_IPGR1, and the
EMAC_IPGR2. The first register EMAC_IPGT determines the back-to-back
Transmit IPG. The other two registers determine the non-back-to-back IPG in two
parts. Table 145 shows the values for the EMAC_IPGT and the corresponding
IPGs for both full-duplex and half-duplex modes.
Table 145. EMAC_IPGT Back-to-Back Settings for Full/Half Duplex Modes*
MII, RMII/SMII, PMD
(100 Mbps)
MII, RMII/SMII
(10 Mbps)
ENDEC Mode
(10 Mbps)
Clock Period = 40 nsec
IPGT[6:0]
Clock Period = 400 nsec
IPGT[6:0]
Clock Period = 100 nsec
IPGT[6:0]
Half
Duplex
12h
Full
Interpacket
Half
Duplex
Gap
Duplex
Full
Interpacket
Half
Duplex
Gap
Duplex
Full
Interpacket
Duplex
Gap
0Dh
0.12 µs
00h
1.2 µs
10h
1.9 µs
0Bh
0.44 µs
08h
4.4 µs
18h
2.7 µs
0Ch
0.60 µs
0Ch
6.0 µs
20h
3.5 µs
10h
0.76 µs
10h
7.5 µs
40h
6.7 µs
15h
0.96 µs
15h
9.6 µs
5Dh
9.6 µs
20h
1.40 µs
20h
14.0 µs
20h
13.0 µs
12h
5Ah
Note: *The IEEE 802.3, 802.3(u) minimum values are shaded.
The equations for back-to-back Transmit IPG are determined by the following:
Full Duplex Mode (3 clocks + IPGT clocks) * clock period = IPG
Half Duplex Mode (6 clocks + IPGT clocks) * clock period = IPG
Table 146 shows the IPGR2 settings for the non-back-to-back packets.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
259
Table 146. EMAC_IPGT Non-Back-to-Back Settings for Full/Half Duplex Modes*
MII, RMII/SMII, PMD
(100 Mbps)
MII, RMII/SMII
(10 Mbps)
ENDEC Mode
(10 Mbps)
Clock Period = 40 nsec
Clock Period = 400 nsec
Clock Period = 100 nsec
IPGR2[6:0]
Interpacket
Gap
IPGR2[6:0]
Interpacket
Gap
IPGR2[6:0]
Interpacket
Gap
00h
0.24 µs
00h
2.4 µs
00h
0.6 µs
10h
0.88 µs
10h
8.8 µs
10h
2.2 µs
12h
0.96 µs
12h
9.6 µs
20h
3.8 µs
20h
1.52 µs
20h
15.2 µs
40h
7.0 µs
40h
2.80 µs
40h
28.0 µs
5Ah
9.6 µs
7Fh
5.32 µs
7Fh
53.2 µs
7Fh
13.3 µs
Note: *The IEEE 802.3, 802.3(u) minimum values are shaded.
A non-back-to-back Transmit IPG is determined by the following formula:
(6 clocks + IPGR2 clocks) * clock period = IPG
The difference in values between Tables 145 and 146 is due to the asynchronous
nature of the Carrier Sense (CRS). The CRS must undergo a 2-clock synchronization before the internal Tx state machine can detect it. This synchronization
equates to a 6-clock intrinsic delay between packets instead of the 3-clock intrinsic delay in the back-to-back packet mode. More information covering this topic
can be found in the IEEE 802.3/4.2.3.2.1 Carrier Deference section.
EMAC Interpacket Gap Register
The EMAC Interpacket Gap is a programmable field representing the interpacket
gap (IPG) between back-to-back packets. It is the IPG parameter used in fullduplex and half-duplex modes between back-to-back packets. Set this field to the
appropriate number of IPG octets. The default setting of 15h represents the minimum IPG of 0.96 µs (at 100 Mbps) or 9.6 µs (at 10Mbps). See Table 147.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
260
Table 147. EMAC Interpacket Gap Register
(EMAC_IPGT = 002Dh)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R/W
5
0
R/W
4
1
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
1
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
1
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Reserved.
[6:0]
IPGT
00h–
7Fh
The number of octets of IPG.
EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 1
Part 1 of the EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register is a programmable field representing the optional carrier sense window referenced in IEEE 802.3/4.2.3.2.1
Carrier Deference. If a carrier is detected during the timing of IPGR1, the EMAC
defers to the carrier. If, however, the carrier becomes active after IPGR1, the
EMAC continues timing for IPGR2 and transmits, knowingly causing a collision.
This collision acts to ensure fair access to the medium. Its range of values is 00h
to IPGR2. See Table 148. The default setting of 0Ch represents the Carrier Sense
Window Referencing depicted tin IEEE 802.3, Section 4.2.3.2.1.
Table 148. EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 1
(EMAC_IPGR1 = 002Eh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Reserved.
[6:0]
IPGR 1
00h–
7Fh
This is a programmable field representing the optional carrier
sense window referenced in IEEE 802.3/4.2.3.2.1 Carrier
Deference.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
261
EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 2
Part 2 of the EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register is a programmable field representing the non-back-to-back interpacket gap. Its default is 12h, which represents the minimum IPG of 0.96 µs at 100 Mbps or 9.6 µs at 10 Mbps. See Table
149.
Table 149. EMAC Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 2
(EMAC_IPGR2 = 002Fh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
CPU Access
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write
Bit
Position
Value
Description
7
0
Reserved.
[6:0]
IPGR2
00h–
7Fh
This is a programmable field representing the non-back-toback interpacket gap.
EMAC Maximum Frame Length Register—Low and High Bytes
The 16-bit field resets to 0600h, which represents a maximum Receive frame of
1536 octets. An untagged maximum size Ethernet frame is 1518 octets. A tagged
frame adds four octets for a total of 1522 octets. If a shorter maximum length
restriction is more appropriate, program this field. See Tables 150 and 151.
Note: If a proprietary header is allowed, this field should be adjusted accordingly. For
example, if 12-byte headers are prepended to frames, MAXF should be set to
1524 octets to allow the maximum VLAN tagged frame plus the 12-byte header.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
262
Table 150. EMAC Maximum Frame Length Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_MAXF_L = 0030h
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R/W
6
0
R/W
5
0
R/W
4
0
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_MAXF_L FFh
Description
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte MAXF
value, {EMAC_MAXF_H, EMAC_MAXF_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of
the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
Table 151. EMAC Maximum Frame Length Register—High Byte
(EMAC_MAXF_H = 0031h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_MAXF_H FFh
PS019209-0504
Description
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte MAXF
value, {EMAC_MAXF_H, EMAC_MAXF_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15
(msb) of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
263
EMAC Address Filter Register
The EMAC Address Filter Register functions as a filter to control promiscuous
mode, and multicast and broadcast messaging. See Table 152.
Table 152. EMAC Address Filter Register
(EMAC_AFR = 0032h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:4]
0h
Reserved.
3
PROM
1
Enable Promiscuous Mode. Receive all incoming packets
regardless of station address. Disables station address
filtering.
0
Disable Promiscuous Mode.
1
Accept any multicast message. A multicast packet is
determined by the first bit in the destination address. If the first
LSB is a 1, it is a group address and is globally or locally
administered depending on the 2nd bit. See IEEE 802.3/3.2.3
for more information.
0
Do not accept multicast messages of any type.
1
Accept only qualified multicast (QMC) messages as
determined by the hash table.
0
Do not accept qualified multicast messages.
1
Accept broadcast messages. Broadcast messages have the
destination address set to FFFFFFFFFFFFh.
0
Do not accept broadcast messages.
2
MC
1
QMC
0
BC
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
264
EMAC Hash Table Register
The EMAC Hash Table Register represents the 8x8 hash table matrix. This table
is used as an option to select between different multicast addresses. If a multicast
address is received, the first 6 bits of the CRC are decoded and added to a table
that points to a single bit within the hash table matrix. If the selected bit = 1, the
multicast packet is accepted. If the bit = 0, the multicast packet is rejected. See
Table 153.
Table 153. EMAC Hash Table Register
(EMAC_HTBL_0 = 0033h, EMAC_HTBL_1 = 0034h, EMAC_HTBL_2 = 0035h,
EMAC_HTBL_3 = 0036h, EMAC_HTBL_4 = 0037h, EMAC_HTBL_5 = 0038h,
EMAC_HTBL_6 = 0039h, EMAC_HTBL_7 = 003Ah)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EMAC_HTBL_0 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_HTBL_1 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_HTBL_2 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_HTBL_3 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_HTBL_4 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_HTBL_5 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_HTBL_6 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
EMAC_HTBL_7 Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_HTBL_x
00h–
FFh
This field is the hash table. The 64-bit hash table is
{EMAC_HTBL_7, EMAC_HTBL_6, EMAC_HTBL_5,
EMAC_HTBL_4, EMAC_HTBL_3, EMAC_HTBL_2,
EMAC_HTBL_1, EMAC_HTBL_0}.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
265
EMAC MII Management Register
The EMAC MII Management Register is used to control the external PHY
attached to the MII. See Table 154.
Table 154. EMAC MII Management Register
(EMAC_MIIMGT = 003Bh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
7
LCTLD
6
RSTAT
6
SCINC
5
SCAN
4
SPRE
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
1
Rising edge causes the CTLD control data to be transmitted
to external PHY if MII is not busy. This bit is self clearing.
0
No operation.
1
Rising edge causes status to be read from external PHY via
PRSD[15:0] bus if MII is not busy. This bit is self clearing.
0
No operation.
1
Scan PHY address increments upon SCAN cycle. The SCAN
bit must also be set for the PHY address to increment after
each scan. The scanning starts at the EmacFiad and
increments up to 1fh. It then rolls back to the EmacFiad
address.
0
Normal operation.
1
Perform continuous Read cycles via MII management. While
in scan mode, the EmacIStat[MGTDONE] bit is set when the
current PHY Read has completed. At this time, the EmacPsrd
register holds the Read data and the EmacMIIStat[4:0] holds
the address of the PHY for which the EmacPrsd data pertains.
0
Normal operation.
1
Suppress MDO preamble.
0
Normal preamble.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
266
Bit
Position
[2:0]
CLKS
Value
Description
Programmable divisor that produces MDC from SCLK.
000
MDC = SCLK ÷ 4.
001
MDC = SCLK ÷ 4.
010
MDC = SCLK ÷ 6.
011
MDC = SCLK ÷ 8.
100
MDC = SCLK ÷ 10.
101
MDC = SCLK ÷ 14.
110
MDC = SCLK ÷ 20.
111
MDC = SCLK ÷ 28.
EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—Low Byte
The Low Byte of the EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register represents the configuration data written to the external PHY. See Table 155.
Table 155. EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_CTLD_L = 003Ch)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_CTLD_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte PHY
configuration data value, {EMAC_CTLD_H,
EMAC_CTLD_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is bit
0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
267
EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—High Byte
The High Byte of the EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register represents the configuration data written to the external PHY. See Table 156.
Table 156. EMAC PHY Configuration Data Register—High Byte
(EMAC_CTLD_H = 003Dh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_CTLD_H FFh
Description
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte PHY
configuration data value, {EMAC_CTLD_H,
EMAC_CTLD_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit value.
Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
EMAC PHY Address Register
The EMAC PHY Address Register allows access to the external PHY registers.
See Table 157.
Table 157. EMAC PHY Address Register
(EMAC_RGAD = 003Eh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:5]
000
Reserved.
[4:0]
RGAD
00h–
1Fh
Programmable 5-bit value which selects address within the
selected external PHY.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
268
EMAC PHY Unit Select Address Register
The EMAC PHY Unit Select Address Register allows the selection of multiple connected external PHY devices. See Table 158.
Table 158. EMAC PHY Unit Select Address Register
(EMAC_FIAD = 003Fh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:5]
000
Reserved.
[4:0]
FIAD
00h–
1Fh
Programmable 5-bit value that selects an external PHY.
EMAC Transmit Polling Timer Register
This register sets the Transmit Polling Period in increments of TPTMR =
SYSCLK ÷ 256. Whenever this register is written, the status of the Transmit Buffer
Descriptor is checked to determine if the EMAC owns the Transmit buffer. It then
rechecks this status every TPTMR (calculated by TPTMR * EMAC_PTMR[7:0]).
The Transmit Polling Timer is disabled if this register is set to 00h (which also disables the transmitting of packets). If a transmission is in progress when
EMAC_PTMR is set to 00h, the transmission will complete. See Table 159.
Table 159. EMAC Transmit Polling Timer Register
(EMAC_PTMR = 0040h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_PTMR
00h–
FFh
The Transmit polling period.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
269
EMAC Reset Control Register
The bit values in the EMAC Reset Control Register are not self-clearing bits. The
user is responsible for controlling their state. See Table 160.
Table 160. EMAC Reset Control Register
(EMAC_RST = 0041h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:6]
00
Reserved.
5
SRST
1
Software Reset Active—resets Receive, Transmit, EMAC
Control and EMAC MII_MGT functions.
0
Normal operation.
4
HRTFN
1
Reset Transmit function.
0
Normal operation.
3
HRRFN
1
Reset Receive function.
0
Normal operation.
2
HRTMC
1
Reset EMAC Transmit Control function.
0
Normal operation.
1
HRRMC
1
Reset EMAC Receive Control function.
0
Normal operation.
0
HRMGT
1
Reset EMAC Management function.
0
Normal operation.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
270
EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer Register—Low and High Bytes
The EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer is set to the start of the Transmit
buffer in EMAC shared memory. See Tables 161 and 162.
Table 161. EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_TLBP_L = 0042h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_TLBP_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte Transmit
Lower Boundary Pointer value, {EMAC_TLBP_H,
EMAC_TLBP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is bit
0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
Table 162. EMAC Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer Register—High Byte
(EMAC_TLBP_H = 0043h)*
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_TLBP_H
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte Transmit
Lower Boundary Pointer value, {EMAC_TLBP_H,
EMAC_TLBP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit value.
Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
Note: *Bits 7:5 are not used by the EMAC; these bits return 000.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
271
EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Low and High Bytes
The Boundary Pointer is set to the start of the Receive buffer (end of Transmit
buffer +1) in EMAC shared memory. This pointer is 24 bits and determined by
{RAM_ADDR_U, EMAC_BP_H, EMAC_BP_L}. The upper 3 bits of the
EMAC_BP_H register are hard-wired inside the eZ80F91 device to locate the
base of EMAC shared memory. The last 5 bits of the EMAC_BP_L register value
are hard-wired to keep the addressing aligned to a 32-byte boundary. See
Tables 163 and 164.
Table 163. EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_BP_L = 0044h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R = Read Only, R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_BP_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 3-byte EMAC
Boundary Pointer value, {EMAC_BP_U, EMAC_BP_H,
EMAC_BP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 24-bit value. Bit 0 is bit 0 of
the 24-bit value.
Table 164. EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—High Byte
(EMAC_BP_H = 0045h)
Bit
15:13
12:8
Reset
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only, R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_BP_H
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the High byte of the 3-byte EMAC
Boundary Pointer value, {EMAC_BP_U, EMAC_BP_H,
EMAC_BP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 of the 24-bit value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of
the 24-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
272
EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Upper Byte
The EMAC Boundary Pointer Register maps directly to the RAM_ADDR_U register within the eZ80F91 device. This register value is Read Only. See Table 165.
Table 165. EMAC Boundary Pointer Register—Upper Byte
(EMAC_BP_U = 0046h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_BP_U
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the upper byte of the 3-byte EMAC
Boundary Pointer value, {EMAC_BP_U, EMAC_BP_H,
EMAC_BP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 23 of the 24-bit value. Bit 0 is bit 16
of the 24-bit value.
EMAC Receive High Boundary Pointer Register—Low and High Bytes
The Receive High Boundary Pointer Register should be set to the end of the
Receive buffer +1 in EMAC shared memory. This RHBP uses the same
RAM_ADDR_U as the EMAC_BP_U pointer above. See Tables 166 and 167.
Table 166. EMAC Receive High Boundary Pointer Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_RHBP_L = 0047h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R = Read Only, R/W = Read/Write
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_RHBP_L E0h
PS019209-0504
Description
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte EMAC
Receive High Boundary Pointer value, {EMAC_RHBP_H,
EMAC_RHBP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is
bit 0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
273
Table 167. EMAC Receive High Boundary Pointer Register—High Byte
(EMAC_RHBP_H = 0048h)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
1
R
6
1
R
5
0
R
4
0
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R = Read Only, R/W = Read/Write
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_RHBP_H FFh
Description
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte EMAC
Receive High Boundary Pointer value, {EMAC_RHBP_H,
EMAC_RHBP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit value.
Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
Note: *Bits 7:5 are not used by the EMAC; these bits return 000.
EMAC Receive Read Pointer Register—Low and High Bytes
The Receive Read Pointer Register should be initialized to the EMAC_BP value
(start of the Receive buffer). This register points to where the next Receive packet
is read from. The EMAC_BP[12:5] is loaded into this register whenever the
EMAC_RST [(HRRFN) is set to 1. The RxDMA block uses the Emac_Rrp[12:5] to
compare to EmacRwp[12:5] for determining how many buffers remain. The result
equates to the EmacBlksLeft register. See Tables 168 and 169.
Table 168. EMAC Receive Read Pointer Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_RRP_L = 0049h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
CPU Access
Note: R = Read Only, R/W = Read/Write
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_RRP_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte EMAC
Receive Read Pointer value, {EMAC_RRP_H,
EMAC_RRP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is bit
0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
274
Table 169. EMAC Receive Read Pointer Register—High Byte
(EMAC_RRP_H = 004Ah)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R
5
0
R
4
0
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R = Read Only, R/W = Read/Write
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_RRP_ FFh
H
Description
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte EMAC
Receive Read Pointer value, {EMAC_RRP_H,
EMAC_RRP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit value. Bit 0
is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
EMAC Buffer Size Register
The lower six bits of this register set the level at which the EMAC either transmits
a pause control frame or jams the Ethernet bus, depending on the mode selected.
When these bits each contain a zero, this feature is disabled.
In Full Duplex Mode, a Pause Control Frame is transmitted as a one-shot operation. The software must free up a number of Rx buffers so that the number of buffers remaining, EmacBlksLeft, is greater than TCPF_LEV.
In Half Duplex Mode, the EMAC jams the Ethernet by sending a continuous
stream of hexadecimal 5s (5fh). When the software frees up the Rx buffers and
the number of buffers remaining, EmacBlksLeft, is greater than TCPF_LEV, the
EMAC stops jamming.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
275
Table 170. EMAC Buffer Size Register
(EMAC_BUFSZ = 004Bh)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R/W
6
0
R/W
5
0
R/W
4
0
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:6]
BUFSZ
[5:0]
TPCF_LEV
Value
Description
00
Set EMAC Rx/Tx buffer size to 256 bytes.
01
Set EMAC Rx/Tx buffer size to 128 bytes.
10
Set EMAC Rx/Tx buffer size to 64 bytes.
11
Set EMAC Rx/Tx buffer size to 32 bytes.
00h–
3Fh
Transmit Pause Control Frame level.*
Note: *00h disables the hardware-generated Transmit Pause Control Frame.
EMAC Interrupt Enable Register
Enabling the Receive Overrun interrupt allows software to detect an overrun condition as soon as it occurs. If this interrupt is not set, then an overrun cannot be
detected until the software processes the Receive packet with the overrun and
checks the Receive status in the Rx descriptor table. Because the receiver is disabled by an overrun error until the Rx_OVR bit is cleared in the EMAC_ISTAT register, this packet is the final packet in the Receive buffer. To reenable the receiver
before all of the Receive packets are processed and the Receive buffer is empty,
software can enable this interrupt to detect the overrun condition early. As it processes the Receive packets, it can reenable the receiver when the number of free
buffers is greater than the number of minimum buffers. See Table 171.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
276
Table 171. EMAC Interrupt Enable Register
(EMAC_IEN = 004Ch)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R/W
6
0
R/W
5
0
R/W
4
0
R/W
3
0
R/W
2
0
R/W
1
0
R/W
0
0
R/W
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
1
Enable Transmit State Machine Error Interrupt (system
interrupt).
0
Disable Transmit State Machine Error Interrupt (system
interrupt).
6
MGTDONE
1
Enable MII Mgmt. Done Interrupt (system Interrupt).
0
Disable MII Mgmt. Done Interrupt (system Interrupt).
5
Rx_CF
1
Enable Receive Control Frame Interrupt (Receive interrupt).
0
Disable Receive Control Frame Interrupt (Receive interrupt).
4
Rx_PCF
1
Enable Receive Pause Control Frame interrupt (Receive
interrupt).
0
Disable Receive Pause Control Frame interrupt (Receive
interrupt).
3
Rx_DONE
1
Enable Receive Done interrupt (Receive interrupt).
0
Disable Receive Done interrupt (Receive interrupt).
2
Rx_OVR
1
Enable Receive Overrun interrupt (System interrupt).
0
Disable Receive Overrun interrupt (System interrupt).
1
Tx_CF
1
Enable Transmit Control Frame Interrupt (Transmit interrupt).
0
Disable Transmit Control Frame Interrupt (Transmit interrupt).
0
Tx_DONE
1
Enable Transmit Done interrupt (Transmit interrupt).
0
Disable Transmit Done Interrupt (Transmit interrupt).
7
TxFSMERR
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
277
EMAC Interrupt Status Register
When a Receive overrun occurs, all incoming packets are ignored until the
Rx_OVR_STAT status bit is cleared by software. Consequently, software controls
when the receiver can be reenabled after an overrun. Enable the Rx_OVR interrupt to detect overrun conditions when they occur. Clear this condition when the
Rx buffers are freed to avoid additional overrun errors. See Table 172.
Note: Status bits are not self-clearing. Each status bit is cleared by writing a 1 into the
selected bit.
Table 172. EMAC Interrupt Status Register
(EMAC_ISTAT = 004Dh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
7
1
TxFSMERR_STAT
An internal error occurs in the EMAC Transmit path. The
Transmit path must be reset to reset this error condition.
0
Normal operation—no Transmit state machine errors.
1
The MII Mgmt. interrupt has completed a Read (RSTAT
or SCAN) or a Write (LDCTLD) access to the PHY.
0
The MII Mgmt. interrupt does not occur.
1
Receive Control Frame interrupt (Receive Interrupt)
occurs.
0
Receive Control Frame interrupt does not occur.
1
Receive Pause Control Frame interrupt (Receive
Interrupt) occurs.
0
Disable Receive Pause Control Frame interrupt
(Receive Interrupt) does not occur.
3
Rx_DONE_STAT
1
Receive Done interrupt (Receive Interrupt) occurs.
0
Disable Receive Done interrupt (Receive Interrupt) does
not occur.
2
Rx_OVR_STAT
1
Receive Overrun interrupt (System Interrupt) occurs.
0
Receive Overrun interrupt (System Interrupt) does not
occur.
6
MGTDONE_STAT
5
Rx_CF_STAT
4
Rx_PCF_STAT
PS019209-0504
Description
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
278
Bit
Position
1
Tx_CF_STAT
0
Tx_DONE_STAT
Value
Description
1
Transmit Control Frame Interrupt (Transmit Interrupt)
occurs.
0
Transmit Control Frame Interrupt (Transmit Interrupt)
does not occur.
1
Transmit Done interrupt (Transmit Interrupt) occurs.
0
Transmit Done interrupt (Transmit Interrupt) does not
occur.
EMAC PHY Read Status Data Register—Low and High Bytes
The PHY MII Management Data Register is where the data Read from the PHY is
stored. See Tables 173 and 174.
Table 173. EMAC PHY Read Status Data Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_PRSD_L = 004Eh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_PRSD_L FFh
PS019209-0504
Description
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte EMAC
PHY Read Status Data value, {EMAC_PRSD_H,
EMAC_PRSD_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is
bit 0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
279
Table 174. EMAC PHY Read Status Data Register—High Byte
(EMAC_PRSD_H = 004Fh)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R
5
0
R
4
0
R
3
0
R
2
0
R
1
0
R
0
0
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_PRSD_H FFh
Description
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte EMAC
PHY Read Status Data value, {EMAC_PRSD_H,
EMAC_PRSD_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit value.
Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
EMAC MII Status Register
The EMAC MII Status Register is used to determine the current state of the external PHY device. See Table 175.
Table 175. EMAC MII Status Register
(EMAC_MIISTAT = 0050h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
7
BUSY
6
MIILF
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
1
MII management operation in progress—Busy. This status bit
goes busy whenever the LCTLD (PHY Write) or the RSTAT
(PHY Read) is set in the EMAC_MIIMGT register. It is
negated when the Write or Read operation to the PHY has
completed. In SCAN mode, the BUSY will be asserted until
the SCAN is disabled. Use the EmacIStat[MGTDONE]
interrupt status bit to determine when the data is valid.
0
Not Busy.
1
Local copy of PHY Link fail bit.
0
PHY Link OK.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
280
5
NVALID
1
MII Scan result is not valid Emac_PRSD is invalid
0
Emac_PRSD is valid.
[4:0]
RDADR
00h–
1Fh
Denotes PHY addressed in current scan cycle.
EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—Low Byte
The Read Only Receive-Write-Pointer register reports the current RxDMA
Receive Write pointer. This pointer gets initialized to EmacTLBP whenever
Emac_RST bits SRST or HRRTN are set. Because the size of the packet is limited to a minimum of 32 bytes, the last five bits are always zero. See Tables 176
and 177.
Table 176. EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_RWP_L = 0051h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_RWP_L
00h–
E0h
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte EMAC
RxDMA Receive Write Pointer value, {EMAC_RWP_H,
EMAC_RWP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is bit
0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
281
EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—High Byte
Because of the size of the EMAC’s 8 KB SRAM, the upper three bits of the EMAC
Receive Write Pointer Register are always zero.
Table 177. EMAC Receive Write Pointer Register—High Byte
(EMAC_RWP_H = 0052h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_RWP_H
00h–
1Fh
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte EMAC
RxDMA Receive Write Pointer value, {EMAC_RWP_H,
EMAC_RWP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit value. Bit
0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—Low Byte
The Low byte of the Transmit Read Pointer register reports the current TxDMA
Transmit Read pointer.This pointer is initialized to EmacTLBP whenever
Emac_RST bits SRST or HRRTN are set. Because the size of the packet is limited to a minimum of 32 bytes, the last five bits are always zero. See Table 178.
Table 178. EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_TRP_L = 0053h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_TRP_L
00h–
E0h
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte EMAC
TxDMA Transmit Read Pointer value, {EMAC_TRP_H,
EMAC_TRP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is bit 0
(lsb) of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
282
EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—High Byte
Because of the size of the EMAC’s 8 KB SRAM, the upper three bits of the EMAC
Transmit Read Pointer Register are always zero. See Table 179.
Table 179. EMAC Transmit Read Pointer Register—High Byte
(EMAC_TRP_H = 0054h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RO
RO
RO
RO
RO
RO
RO
RO
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_TRP_H
00h–
1Fh
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte EMAC
TxDMA Transmit Read Pointer value, {EMAC_TRP_H,
EMAC_TRP_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit value. Bit
0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—Low and High Bytes
This register reports the number of buffers left in the Receive EMAC shared memory. The hardware uses this information, along with the Block-Level set in the
EMAC_BUFSZ register, to determine when to transmit a pause control frame.
Software can use this information to determine when it should request that a
pause control frame be transmitted (by setting bit 6 of the EMAC_CFG4 register).
For the BlksLeft logic to operate properly, the Receive buffer must contain at least
one more packet buffer than the number of packet buffers required for the largest
packet. That is, one packet cannot fill the entire Receive buffer. Otherwise, the
BlksLeft will be in error. See Tables 180 and 181.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
283
Table 180. EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_BLKSLFT_L = 0055h)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R
5
0
R
4
0
R
3
0
R
2
0
R
1
0
R
0
0
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_BLKSLFT_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 2-byte EMAC
Receive Blocks Left value, {EMAC_BLKSLFT_H,
EMAC_BLKSLFT_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value.
Bit 0 is bit 0 (lsb) of the 16-bit value.
Table 181. EMAC Receive Blocks Left Register—High Byte
(EMAC_BLKSLFT_H = 0056h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
Value
[7:0]
00h–
EMAC_BLKSLFT_H FFh
PS019209-0504
Description
These bits represent the High byte of the 2-byte EMAC
Receive Blocks Left value, {EMAC_BLKSLFT_H,
EMAC_BLKSLFT_L}. Bit 7 is bit 15 (msb) of the 16-bit
value. Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 16-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
284
EMAC FIFO Data Register—Low and High Bytes
The FIFO Read/Write Test Access Data Register allows writing and reading the
FIFO selected by the EMAC_TEST TxRx_SEL bit when the EMAC_TEST register
TEST_FIFO bit is set. See Tables 182 and 183.
Table 182. EMAC FIFO Data Register—Low Byte
(EMAC_FDATA_L = 0057h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
EMAC_FDATA_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 10-bit EMAC
FIFO data value, {EMAC_FDATA_H[1:0],
EMAC_FDATA_L}. Bit 7 is bit 7 of the 16-bit value. Bit 0 is
bit 0 (lsb) of the 10-bit value.
Table 183. EMAC FIFO Data Register—High Byte
(EMAC_FDATA_H = 0058h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:2]
00h
Reserved.
[1:0]
0h–3h
EMAC_FDATA_H
PS019209-0504
These bits represent the upper two bits of the 10-bit
EMAC FIFO data value, {EMAC_FDATA_H[1:0],
EMAC_FDATA_L}. Bit 1 is bit 9 (msb) of the 16-bit value.
Bit 0 is bit 8 of the 10-bit value.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
285
EMAC FIFO Flags Register
The FIFO Flags value is set in the EMAC module hardware to half full, or 16
bytes. See Table 184.
Table 184. EMAC FIFO Flags Register
(EMAC_FFLAGS = 0059h)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
7
TFF
1
Transmit FIFO full.
0
Transmit FIFO not full.
6
0
Reserved.
5
TFAE
1
Transmit FIFO almost empty.
0
Transmit FIFO not almost empty.
4
TFE
1
Transmit FIFO empty.
0
Transmit FIFO not empty.
3
RFF
1
Receive FIFO full.
0
Receive FIFO not full.
2
RFAF
1
Receive FIFO almost full.
0
Receive FIFO not almost full.
1
RFAE
1
Receive FIFO almost empty.
0
Receive FIFO not almost empty.
0
RFE
1
Receive FIFO empty.
0
Receive FIFO not empty.
PRELIMINARY
Ethernet Media Access Controller
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
286
ZiLOG Debug Interface
Introduction
The ZiLOG Debug Interface (ZDI) provides a built-in debugging interface to the
CPU. ZDI provides basic in-circuit emulation features including:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Examining and modifying internal registers
Examining and modifying memory
Starting and stopping the user program
Setting program and data break points
Single-stepping the user program
Executing user-supplied instructions
Debugging the final product with the inclusion of one small connector
Downloading code into SRAM
C source-level debugging using ZiLOG Developer Studio II (ZDS II)
The above features are built into the silicon. Control is provided via a two-wire
interface that is connected to the ZPAK II emulator. Figure 51 illustrates a typical
setup using a a target board, ZPAK II, and the host PC running ZiLOG Developer
Studio II. Refer to the ZiLOG website for more information on ZPAK II and ZDS II.
Target Board
ZiLOG
Developer
Studio
ZPAK
Emulator
C
O
N
N
E
C
T
O
R
eZ80
Product
Figure 51. Typical ZDI Debug Setup
ZDI allows reading and writing of most internal registers without disturbing the
state of the machine. Reads and Writes to memory can occur as fast as the ZDI
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
287
downloads and uploads data, with a maximum frequency of one-half the eZ80F91
system clock frequency, or less. See Table 185 for recommended values.
Table 185. Recommend ZDI Clock vs. System Clock Frequency
System Clock Frequency
ZDI Clock Frequency
3–10 MHz
1 MHz
8–16 MHz
2 MHz
12–24 MHz
4 MHz
20–50 MHz
8 MHz
ZDI-Supported Protocol
ZDI supports a bidirectional serial protocol. The protocol defines any device that
sends data as the transmitter and any receiving device as the receiver. The
device controlling the transfer is the master and the device being controlled is the
slave. The master always initiates the data transfers and provides the clock for
both receive and transmit operations. The ZDI block on the eZ80F91 device is
considered a slave in all data transfers.
Figure 52 illustrates the schematic for building a connector on a target board. This
connector allows the user to connect directly to the ZPAK emulator using a six-pin
header.
TVDD
(Target VDD )
330 KΩ
eZ80F91
330 KΩ
TCK (ZCL)
TDI (ZDA)
2
1
4
3
6
5
6-Pin Target Connector
Figure 52. Schematic For Building a Target Board ZPAK Connector
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
288
ZDI Clock and Data Conventions
The two pins used for communication with the ZDI block are the ZDI clock pin
(ZCL) and the ZDI data pin (ZDA). On the eZ80F91, the ZCL pin is shared with
the TCK pin while the ZDA pin is shared with the TDI pin. The ZCL and ZDA pin
functions are only available when the On-Chip Instrumentation is disabled and the
ZDI is therefore enabled. For general data communication, the data value on the
ZDA pin can change only when ZCL is Low (0). The only exception is the ZDI
START bit, which is indicated by a High-to-Low transition (falling edge) on the
ZDA pin while ZCL is High.
Data is shifted into and out of ZDI, with the most-significant bit (bit 7) of each byte
being first in time, and the least-significant bit (bit 0) last in time. All information is
passed between the master and the slave in 8-bit (single-byte) units. Each byte is
transferred with nine clock cycles: eight to shift the data, and the ninth for internal
operations.
ZDI START Condition
All ZDI commands are preceded by the ZDI START signal, which is a High-to-Low
transition of ZDA when ZCL is High. The ZDI slave on the eZ80F91 device continually monitors the ZDA and ZCL lines for the START signal and does not respond
to any command until this condition is met. The master pulls ZDA Low, with ZCL
High, to indicate the beginning of a data transfer with the ZDI block. Figures 53
and 54 illustrate a valid ZDI START signal prior to writing and reading data,
respectively. A Low-to-High transition of ZDA while the ZCL is High produces no
effect.
Data is shifted in during a Write to the ZDI block on the rising edge of ZCL, as
illustrated in Figure 53. Data is shifted out during a Read from the ZDI block on
the falling edge of ZCL as illustrated in Figure 54. When an operation is completed, the master stops during the ninth cycle and holds the ZCL signal High.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
289
ZDI Data In
(Write)
ZDI Data In
(Write)
ZCL
ZDA
Start Signal
Figure 53. ZDI Write Timing
ZDI Data Out
(Read)
ZDI Data Out
(Read)
ZCL
ZDA
Start Signal
Figure 54. ZDI Read Timing
ZDI Single-Bit Byte Separator
Following each 8-bit ZDI data transfer, a single-bit byte separator is used. To initiate a new ZDI command, the single-bit byte separator must be High (logical 1) to
allow for a new ZDI START command to be sent. For all other cases, the single-bit
byte separator can be either Low (logical 0) or High (logical 1). When ZDI is configured to allow the CPU to accept external bus requests, the single-bit byte separator should be Low (logical 0) during all ZDI commands. This Low value indicates
that ZDI is still operating and is not ready to relinquish the bus. The CPU does not
accept the external bus requests until the single-bit byte separator is a High (logi-
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
290
cal 1). For more information on accepting bus requests in ZDI DEBUG mode,
please see the Bus Requests During ZDI Debug Mode section on page 293.
ZDI Register Addressing
Following a START signal the ZDI master must output the ZDI register address.
All data transfers with the ZDI block use special ZDI registers. The ZDI control
registers that reside in the ZDI register address space should not be confused
with the eZ80F91 device peripheral registers that reside in the I/O address space.
Many locations in the ZDI control register address space are shared by two registers—one for Read Only access and one for Write Only access. As an example, a
Read from ZDI register address 00h returns the eZ80 Product ID Low Byte, while
a Write to this same location, 00h, stores the Low byte of one of the address
match values used for generating break points.
The format for a ZDI address is seven bits of address, followed by one bit for
Read or Write control, and completed by a single-bit byte separator. The ZDI executes a Read or Write operation depending on the state of the R/W bit (0 = Write,
1 = Read). If no new START command is issued at completion of the Read or
Write operation, the operation can be repeated. This allows repeated Read or
Write operations without having to resend the ZDI command. A START signal
must follow to initiate a new ZDI command. Figure 55 illustrates the timing for
address Writes to ZDI registers.
Single-Bit
Byte Separator
or new ZDI
START Signal
ZDI Address Byte
ZCL
S
ZDA
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
R/W
msb
9
0/1
lsb
0 = WRITE
1 = READ
START
Signal
Figure 55. ZDI Address Write Timing
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
291
ZDI Write Operations
ZDI Single-Byte Write
For single-byte Write operations, the address and write control bit are first written
to the ZDI block. Following the single-bit byte separator, the data is shifted into the
ZDI block on the next 8 rising edges of ZCL. The master terminates activity after 8
clock cycles.Figure 56 illustrates the timing for ZDI single-byte Write operations.
ZDI Data Byte
ZCL
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
ZDA
A0
Write
0/1
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
msb
of DATA
lsb of
ZDI Address
9
1
lsb
of DATA
Single-Bit
Byte Separator
End of Data
or New ZDI
START Signal
Figure 56. ZDI Single-Byte Data Write Timing
ZDI Block Write
The block Write operation is initiated in the same manner as the single-byte Write
operation, but instead of terminating the Write operation after the first data byte is
transferred, the ZDI master can continue to transmit additional bytes of data to the
ZDI slave on the eZ80F91 device. After the receipt of each byte of data the ZDI
register address increments by 1. If the ZDI register address reaches the end of
the Write Only ZDI register address space (30h), the address stops incrementing.
Figure 57 illustrates the timing for ZDI block Write operations.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
292
ZDI Data Bytes
ZCL
7
8
9
1
2
3
7
8
9
1
2
ZDA
A0
Write
0/1
D7
D6
D5
D1
D0
0/1
D7
D6
msb
of DATA
Byte 1
lsb of
ZDI Address
lsb
of DATA
Byte 1
Single-Bit
Byte Separator
9
1
msb
of DATA
Byte 2
Single-Bit
Byte Separator
Figure 57. ZDI Block Data Write Timing
ZDI Read Operations
ZDI Single-Byte Read
Single-byte Read operations are initiated in the same manner as single-byte Write
operations, with the exception that the R/W bit of the ZDI register address is set to
1. Upon receipt of a slave address with the R/W bit set to 1, the eZ80F91 device’s
ZDI block loads the selected data into the shifter at the beginning of the first cycle
following the single-bit data separator. The most-significant bit (msb) is shifted out
first. Figure 58 illustrates the timing for ZDI single-byte Read operations.
ZDI Data Byte
ZCL
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
ZDA
A0
Read
0/1
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
msb
of DATA
lsb of
ZDI Address
9
1
lsb
of DATA
Single-Bit
Byte Separator
End of Data
or New ZDI
START Signal
Figure 58. ZDI Single-Byte Data Read Timing
ZDI Block Read
A block Read operation is initiated in the same manner as a single-byte Read;
however, the ZDI master continues to clock in the next byte from the ZDI slave as
the ZDI slave continues to output data. The ZDI register address counter incre-
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
293
ments with each Read. If the ZDI register address reaches the end of the Read
Only ZDI register address space (20h), the address stops incrementing. Figure 59
illustrates the ZDI’s block Read timing.
ZDI Data Bytes
ZCL
7
8
9
1
2
3
7
8
9
1
2
ZDA
A0
Read
0/1
D7
D6
D5
D1
D0
0/1
D7
D6
msb
of DATA
Byte 1
lsb of
ZDI Address
lsb
of DATA
Byte 1
Single-Bit
Byte Separator
9
1
msb
of DATA
Byte 2
Single-Bit
Byte Separator
Figure 59. ZDI Block Data Read Timing
Operation of the eZ80F91 Device during ZDI Break Points
If the ZDI forces the CPU to break, only the CPU suspends operation. The system
clock continues to operate and drive other peripherals. Those peripherals that can
operate autonomously from the CPU can continue to operate, if so enabled. For
example, the Watch-Dog Timer and Programmable Reload Timers continue to
count during a ZDI break point.
When using the ZDI interface, any Write or Read operations of peripheral registers in the I/O address space produces the same effect as Read or Write operations using the CPU. Because many register Read/Write operations exhibit
secondary effects, such as clearing flags or causing operations to commence, the
effects of the Read/Write operations during a ZDI break must be taken into consideration.
Bus Requests During ZDI Debug Mode
The ZDI block on the eZ80F91 device allows an external device to take control of
the address and data bus while the eZ80F91 device is in DEBUG mode.
ZDI_BUSACK_EN causes ZDI to allow or prevent acknowledgement of bus
requests by external peripherals. The bus acknowledge only occurs at the end of
the current ZDI operation (indicated by a High during the single-bit byte separator). The default reset condition is for bus acknowledgement to be disabled. To
allow bus acknowledgement, the ZDI_BUSACK_EN must be written.
When an external bus request (BUSREQ pin asserted) is detected, ZDI waits until
completion of the current operation before responding. ZDI acknowledges the bus
request by asserting the bus acknowledge (BUSACK) signal. If the ZDI block is
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
294
not currently shifting data, it acknowledges the bus request immediately. ZDI uses
the single-bit byte separator of each data word to determine if it is at the end of a
ZDI operation. If the bit is a logical 0, ZDI does not assert BUSACK to allow additional data Read or Write operations. If the bit is a logical 1, indicating completion
of the ZDI commands, BUSACK is asserted.
Potential Hazards of Enabling Bus Requests During Debug Mode
There are some potential hazards that the user must be aware of when enabling
external bus requests during ZDI DEBUG mode. First, when the address and data
bus are being used by an external source, ZDI must only access ZDI registers
and internal CPU registers to prevent possible bus contention. The bus acknowledge status is reported in the ZDI_BUS_STAT register. The BUSACK output pin
also indicates the bus acknowledge state.
A second hazard is that when a bus acknowledge is granted, the ZDI is subject to
any wait states that are assigned to the device currently being accessed by the
external peripheral. To prevent data errors, ZDI should avoid data transmission
while another device is controlling the bus.
Finally, exiting ZDI Debug mode while an external peripheral controls the address
and data buses, as indicated by BUSACK assertion, can produce unpredictable
results.
ZDI Write Only Registers
Table 186 lists the ZDI Write Only registers. Many of the ZDI Write Only
addresses are shared with ZDI Read Only registers.
Table 186. ZDI Write Only Registers
PS019209-0504
ZDI Address
ZDI Register Name
ZDI Register Function
Reset
Value
00h
ZDI_ADDR0_L
Address Match 0 Low Byte
XXh
01h
ZDI_ADDR0_H
Address Match 0 High Byte
XXh
02h
ZDI_ADDR0_U
Address Match 0 Upper Byte
XXh
04h
ZDI_ADDR1_L
Address Match 1 Low Byte
XXh
05h
ZDI_ADDR1_H
Address Match 1 High Byte
XXh
06h
ZDI_ADDR1_U
Address Match 1 Upper Byte
XXh
08h
ZDI_ADDR2_L
Address Match 2 Low Byte
XXh
09h
ZDI_ADDR2_H
Address Match 2 High Byte
XXh
0Ah
ZDI_ADDR2_U
Address Match 2 Upper Byte
XXh
0Ch
ZDI_ADDR3_L
Address Match 3 Low Byte
XXh
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
295
Table 186. ZDI Write Only Registers (Continued)
ZDI Address
ZDI Register Name
ZDI Register Function
Reset
Value
0Dh
ZDI_ADDR3_H
Address Match 3 High Byte
XXh
0Eh
ZDI_ADDR3_U
Address Match 4 Upper Byte
XXh
10h
ZDI_BRK_CTL
Break Control Register
00h
11h
ZDI_MASTER_CTL
Master Control Register
00h
13h
ZDI_WR_DATA_L
Write Data Low Byte
XXh
14h
ZDI_WR_DATA_H
Write Data High Byte
XXh
15h
ZDI_WR_DATA_U
Write Data Upper Byte
XXh
16h
ZDI_RW_CTL
Read/Write Control Register
00h
17h
ZDI_BUS_CTL
Bus Control Register
00h
21h
ZDI_IS4
Instruction Store 4
XXh
22h
ZDI_IS3
Instruction Store 3
XXh
23h
ZDI_IS2
Instruction Store 2
XXh
24h
ZDI_IS1
Instruction Store 1
XXh
25h
ZDI_IS0
Instruction Store 0
XXh
30h
ZDI_WR_MEM
Write Memory Register
XXh
ZDI Read Only Registers
Table 187 lists the ZDI Read Only registers. Many of the ZDI Read Only
addresses are shared with ZDI Write Only registers.
Table 187. ZDI Read Only Registers
ZDI Address
ZDI Register Name
ZDI Register Function
Reset
Value
00h
ZDI_ID_L
eZ80 Product ID Low Byte Register
08h
01h
ZDI_ID_H
eZ80 Product ID High Byte Register
00h
02h
ZDI_ID_REV
eZ80 Product ID Revision Register
XXh
03h
ZDI_STAT
Status Register
00h
10h
ZDI_RD_L
Read Memory Address Low Byte Register
XXh
11h
ZDI_RD_H
Read Memory Address High Byte Register
XXh
12h
ZDI_RD_U
Read Memory Address Upper Byte Register
XXh
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
296
Table 187. ZDI Read Only Registers (Continued)
ZDI Address
ZDI Register Name
ZDI Register Function
Reset
Value
17h
ZDI_BUS_STAT
Bus Status Register
00h
20h
ZDI_RD_MEM
Read Memory Data Value
XXh
ZDI Register Definitions
ZDI Address Match Registers
The four sets of address match registers are used for setting the addresses for
generating break points. When the accompanying BRK_ADDRX bit is set in the
ZDI Break Control register to enable the particular address match, the current
eZ80F91 address is compared with the 3-byte address set, {ZDI_ADDRx_U,
ZDI_ADDRx_H, ZDI_ADDR_x_L}. If the CPU is operating in ADL mode, the
address is supplied by ADDR[23:0]. If the CPU is operating in Z80 mode, the
address is supplied by {MBASE[7:0], ADDR[15:0]}. If a match is found, ZDI issues
a break to the eZ80F91 device placing the CPU in ZDI mode pending further
instructions from the ZDI interface block. If the address is not the first op-code
fetch, the ZDI break is executed at the end of the instruction in which it is executed. There are four sets of address match registers. They can be used in conjunction with each other to break on branching instructions. See Table 188.
Table 188. ZDI Address Match Registers
ZDI_ADDR0_L = 00h, ZDI_ADDR0_H = 01h, ZDI_ADDR0_U = 02h,
ZDI_ADDR1_L = 04h, ZDI_ADDR1_H = 05h, ZDI_ADDR1_U = 06h,
ZDI_ADDR2_L = 08h, ZDI_ADDR2_H = 09h, ZDI_ADDR2_U = 0Ah,
ZDI_ADDR3_L = 0Ch, ZDI_ADDR3_H = 0Dh, and ZDI_ADDR3_U = 0Eh
in the ZDI Register Write Only Address Space
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
ZDI_ADDRX_L,
ZDI_ADDRX_H,
or
ZDI_ADDRX_U
PS019209-0504
Value Description
00h–
FFh
The four sets of ZDI address match registers are used for
setting the addresses for generating break points. The 24bit addresses are supplied by {ZDI_ADDRx_U,
ZDI_ADDRx_H, ZDI_ADDRx_L, where x is 0, 1, 2, or 3.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
297
ZDI Break Control Register
The ZDI Break Control register is used to enable break points. ZDI asserts a
break when the CPU instruction address, ADDR[23:0], matches the value in the
ZDI Address Match 3 registers, {ZDI_ADDR3_U, ZDI_ADDR3_H,
ZDI_ADDR3_L}. BREAKs can only occur on an instruction boundary. If the
instruction address is not the beginning of an instruction (that is, for multibyte
instructions), then the break occurs at the end of the current instruction. The
BRK_NEXT bit is set to 1. The BRK_NEXT bit must be reset to 0 to release the
break. See Table 189.
Table 189. ZDI Break Control Register
(ZDI_BRK_CTL = 10h in the ZDI Write Only Register Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
7
BRK_NEXT
6
BRK_ADDR3
5
BRK_ADDR2
PS019209-0504
Value Description
0
The ZDI break on the next CPU instruction is disabled.
Clearing this bit releases the CPU from its current BREAK
condition.
1
The ZDI break on the next CPU instruction is enabled.
The CPU can use multibyte Op Codes and multibyte
operands. Break points only occur on the first Op Code in
a multibyte Op Code instruction. If the ZCL pin is High and
the ZDA pin is Low at the end of RESET, this bit is set to 1
and a break occurs on the first instruction following the
RESET. This bit is set automatically during ZDI break on
address match. A break can also be forced by writing a 1
to this bit.
0
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 3, is
disabled.
1
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 3, is
enabled.
0
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 2, is
disabled.
1
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 2, is
enabled.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
298
Bit
Position
4
BRK_ADDR1
3
BRK_ADDR0
2
IGN_LOW_1
1
IGN_LOW_0
0
SINGLE_STEP
PS019209-0504
Value Description
0
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 1, is
disabled.
1
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 1, is
enabled.
0
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 0, is
disabled.
1
The ZDI break, upon matching break address 0, is
enabled.
0
The Ignore the Low Byte function of the ZDI Address
Match 1 registers is disabled. If BRK_ADDR1 is set to 1,
ZDI initiates a break when the entire 24-bit address,
ADDR[23:0], matches the 3-byte value {ZDI_ADDR1_U,
ZDI_ADDR1_H, ZDI_ADDR1_L}.
1
The Ignore the Low Byte function of the ZDI Address
Match 1 registers is enabled. If BRK_ADDR1 is set to 1,
ZDI initiates a break when only the upper 2 bytes of the
24-bit address, ADDR[23:8], match the 2-byte value
{ZDI_ADDR1_U, ZDI_ADDR1_H}. As a result, a break
can occur anywhere within a 256-byte page.
0
The Ignore the Low Byte function of the ZDI Address
Match 1 registers is disabled. If BRK_ADDR0 is set to 1,
ZDI initiates a break when the entire 24-bit address,
ADDR[23:0], matches the 3-byte value {ZDI_ADDR0_U,
ZDI_ADDR0_H, ZDI_ADDR0_L}.
1
The Ignore the Low Byte function of the ZDI Address
Match 1 registers is enabled. If the BRK_ADDR1 is set to
0, ZDI initiates a break when only the upper 2 bytes of the
24-bit address, ADDR[23:8], match the 2 bytes value
{ZDI_ADDR0_U, ZDI_ADDR0_H}. As a result, a break
can occur anywhere within a 256-byte page.
0
ZDI SINGLE STEP mode is disabled.
1
ZDI SINGLE STEP mode is enabled. ZDI asserts a break
following execution of each instruction.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
299
ZDI Master Control Register
The ZDI Master Control register provides control of the eZ80F91 device. It is
capable of forcing a RESET and waking up the eZ80F91 from the low-power
modes (HALT or SLEEP). See Table 190.
Table 190. ZDI Master Control Register
(ZDI_MASTER_CTL = 11h in ZDI Register Write Address Spaces)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
7
ZDI_RESET
0
No action.
1
Initiate a RESET of the eZ80F91. This bit is
automatically cleared at the end of the RESET event.
[6:0]
0000000 Reserved.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
300
ZDI Write Data Registers
These three registers are used in the ZDI Write Only register address space to
store the data that is written when a Write instruction is sent to the ZDI Read/Write
Control register (ZDI_RW_CTL). The ZDI Read/Write Control register is located at
ZDI address 16h immediately following the ZDI Write Data registers. As a result,
the ZDI Master is allowed to write the data to {ZDI_WR_U, ZDI_WR_H,
ZDI_WR_L} and the Write command in one data transfer operation. See Table
191.
Table 191. ZDI Write Data Registers
(ZDI_WR_U = 13h, ZDI_WR_H = 14h, and ZDI_WR_L = 15h
in the ZDI Register Write Only Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: X = Undefined; W = Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
ZDI_WR_L,
ZDI_WR_H,
or
ZDI_WR_L
Value Description
00h–
FFh
These registers contain the data that is written during
execution of a Write operation defined by the
ZDI_RW_CTL register. The 24-bit data value is stored as
{ZDI_WR_U, ZDI_WR_H, ZDI_WR_L}. If less than 24 bits
of data are required to complete the required operation,
the data is taken from the least-significant byte(s).
ZDI Read/Write Control Register
The ZDI Read/Write Control register is used in the ZDI Write Only Register
address to read data from, write data to, and manipulate the CPU’s registers or
memory locations. When this register is written, the eZ80F91 device immediately
performs the operation corresponding to the data value written as described in
Table 192. When a Read operation is executed via this register, the requested
data values are placed in the ZDI Read Data registers {ZDI_RD_U, ZDI_RD_H,
ZDI_RD_L}. When a Write operation is executed via this register, the Write data is
taken from the ZDI Write Data registers {ZDI_WR_U, ZDI_WR_H, ZDI_WR_L}.
See Table 192. Refer to the eZ80 CPU User Manual (UM0077) on zilog.com for
information regarding the CPU registers.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
301
Table 192. ZDI Read/Write Control Register Functions*
(ZDI_RW_CTL = 16h in the ZDI Register Write Only Address Space)
Hex
Value
Hex
Value
Command
Command
00
Read {MBASE, A, F}
ZDI_RD_U ← MBASE
ZDI_RD_H ← F
ZDI_RD_L ← A
80
Write AF
MBASE ← ZDI_WR_U
F ← ZDI_WR_H
A ← ZDI_WR_L
01
Read BC
ZDI_RD_U ← BCU
ZDI_RD_H ← B
ZDI_RD_L ← C
81
Write BC
BCU ← ZDI_WR_U
B ← ZDI_WR_H
C ← ZDI_WR_L
02
Read DE
ZDI_RD_U ← DEU
ZDI_RD_H ← D
ZDI_RD_L ← E
82
Write DE
DEU ← ZDI_WR_U
D ← ZDI_WR_H
E ← ZDI_WR_L
03
Read HL
ZDI_RD_U ← HLU
ZDI_RD_H ← H
ZDI_RD_L ← L
83
Write HL
HLU ← ZDI_WR_U
H ← ZDI_WR_H
L ← ZDI_WR_L
04
Read IX
ZDI_RD_U ← IXU
ZDI_RD_H ← IXH
ZDI_RD_L ← IXL
84
Write IX
IXU ← ZDI_WR_U
IXH ← ZDI_WR_H
IXL ← ZDI_WR_L
05
Read IY
ZDI_RD_U ← IYU
ZDI_RD_H ← IYH
ZDI_RD_L ← IYL
85
Write IY
IYU ← ZDI_WR_U
IYH ← ZDI_WR_H
IYL ← ZDI_WR_L
06
Read SP
In ADL mode, SP = SPL.
In Z80 mode, SP = SPS.
86
Write SP
In ADL mode, SP = SPL.
In Z80 mode, SP = SPS.
07
Read PC
ZDI_RD_U ← PC[23:16]
ZDI_RD_H ← PC[15:8]
ZDI_RD_L ← PC[7:0]
87
Write PC
PC[23:16] ← ZDI_WR_U
PC[15:8] ← ZDI_WR_H
PC[7:0] ← ZDI_WR_L
08
Set ADL
ADL ← 1
88
Reserved
Note: *The CPU’s alternate register set (A’, F’, B’, C’, D’, E’, HL’) cannot be read directly. The ZDI
programmer must execute the exchange instruction (EXX) to gain access to the alternate
CPU register set.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
302
Table 192. ZDI Read/Write Control Register Functions*
(ZDI_RW_CTL = 16h in the ZDI Register Write Only Address Space) (Continued)
Hex
Value
Command
Hex
Value
Command
09
Reset ADL
ADL ← 0
89
Reserved
0A
Exchange CPU register sets
AF ← AF’
BC ← BC’
DE ← DE’
HL ← HL’
8A
Reserved
0B
Read memory from current
PC value, increment PC
8B
Write memory from current PC
value, increment PC
Note: *The CPU’s alternate register set (A’, F’, B’, C’, D’, E’, HL’) cannot be read directly. The ZDI
programmer must execute the exchange instruction (EXX) to gain access to the alternate
CPU register set.
ZDI Bus Control Register
The ZDI Bus Control register controls bus requests during DEBUG mode. It
enables or disables bus acknowledge in ZDI DEBUG mode and allows ZDI to
force assertion of the BUSACK signal. This register should only be written during
ZDI Debug mode (that is, following a break). See Table 193.
Table 193. ZDI Bus Control Register
(ZDI_BUS_CTL = 17h in the ZDI Register Write Only Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write Only.
Bit
Position
7
ZDI_BUSAK_EN
PS019209-0504
Value
Description
0
Bus requests by external peripherals using the BUSREQ
pin are ignored. The bus acknowledge signal, BUSACK,
is not asserted in response to any bus requests.
1
Bus requests by external peripherals using the BUSREQ
pin are accepted. A bus acknowledge occurs at the end of
the current ZDI operation. The bus acknowledge is
indicated by asserting the BUSACK pin in response to a
bus request.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
303
Bit
Position
6
ZDI_BUSAK
[5:0]
Value
Description
0
Deassert the bus acknowledge pin (BUSACK) to return
control of the address and data buses back to ZDI.
1
Assert the bus acknowledge pin (BUSACK) to pass
control of the address and data buses to an external
peripheral.
000000
Reserved.
Instruction Store 4:0 Registers
The ZDI Instruction Store registers are located in the ZDI Register Write Only
address space. They can be written with instruction data for direct execution by
the CPU. When the ZDI_IS0 register is written, the eZ80F91 device exits the ZDI
break state and executes a single instruction. The Op Codes and operands for the
instruction come from these Instruction Store registers. The Instruction Store Register 0 is the first byte fetched, followed by Instruction Store registers 1, 2, 3, and
4, as necessary. Only the bytes the CPU requires to execute the instruction must
be stored in these registers. Some CPU instructions, when combined with the
MEMORY mode suffixes (.SIS, .SIL, .LIS, or .LIL), require 6 bytes to operate.
These 6-byte instructions cannot be executed directly using the ZDI Instruction
Store registers. See Table 194.
Note: The Instruction Store 0 register is located at a higher ZDI address than the other
Instruction Store registers. This feature allows the use of the ZDI auto-address
increment function to load and execute a multibyte instruction with a single data
stream from the ZDI master. Execution of the instruction commences with writing
the final byte to ZDI_IS0.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
304
Table 194. Instruction Store 4:0 Registers
(ZDI_IS4 = 21h, ZDI_IS3 = 22h, ZDI_IS2 = 23h, ZDI_IS1 = 24h, and ZDI_IS0 = 25h
in the ZDI Register Write Only Address Space)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
X
W
6
X
W
5
X
W
4
X
W
3
X
W
2
X
W
1
X
W
0
X
W
Note: X = Undefined; W = Write.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
ZDI_IS4,
ZDI_IS3,
ZDI_IS2,
ZDI_IS1,
or
ZDI_IS0
Value Description
00h–
FFh
These registers contain the Op Codes and operands for
immediate execution by the CPU following a Write to
ZDI_IS0. The ZDI_IS0 register contains the first Op Code
of the instruction. The remaining ZDI_ISx registers
contain any additional Op Codes or operand dates
required for execution of the required instruction.
ZDI Write Memory Register
A Write to the ZDI Write Memory register causes the eZ80F91 device to write the
8-bit data to the memory location specified by the current address in the Program
Counter. In Z80 MEMORY mode, this address is {MBASE, PC[15:0]}. In ADL
MEMORY mode, this address is PC[23:0]. The Program Counter, PC, increments
after each data Write. However, the ZDI register address does not increment automatically when this register is accessed. As a result, the ZDI master is allowed to
write any number of data bytes by writing to this address one time followed by any
number of data bytes. See Table 195.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
305
Table 195. ZDI Write Memory Register
(ZDI_WR_MEM = 30h in the ZDI Register Write Only Address Space)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
X
W
6
X
W
5
X
W
4
X
W
3
X
W
2
X
W
1
X
W
0
X
W
Note: X = Undefined; W = Write.
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
ZDI_WR_MEM
00h–
FFh
The 8-bit data that is transferred to the ZDI slave following
a Write to this address is written to the address indicated
by the current Program Counter. The Program Counter is
incremented following each 8 bits of data. In Z80
MEMORY mode, ({MBASE, PC[15:0]}) ← 8 bits of
transferred data. In ADL MEMORY mode, (PC[23:0]) ←
8-bits of transferred data.
eZ80 Product ID Low and High Byte Registers
The eZ80 Product ID Low and High Byte registers combine to provide a means for
an external device to determine the particular eZ80® product being addressed.
See Tables 196 and 197.
Table 196. eZ80 Product ID Low Byte Register
(ZDI_ID_L = 00h in the ZDI Register Read Only Address Space,
ZDI_ID_L = 0000h in the I/O Register Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
ZDI_ID_L
PS019209-0504
Value Description
08h
{ZDI_ID_H, ZDI_ID_L} = {00h, 08h} indicates the
eZ80F91 product.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
306
Table 197. eZ80 Product ID High Byte Register
(ZDI_ID_H = 01h in the ZDI Register Read Only Address Space,
ZDI_ID_H = 0001h in the I/O Register Address Space)
Bit
Reset
CPU Access
7
0
R
6
0
R
5
0
R
4
0
R
3
0
R
2
0
R
1
0
R
0
0
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
ZDI_ID_H
Value Description
00h
{ZDI_ID_H, ZDI_ID_L} = {00h, 08h} indicates the
eZ80F91 device.
eZ80 Product ID Revision Register
The eZ80 Product ID Revision register identifies the current revision of the
eZ80F91 product. See Table 198. The revision register use the same numbering
used in the mask revision of the die. The first nibble (most-significant) corresponds to a full mask revision, while the second nibble refers to a partial mask
revision.
Table 198. eZ80 Product ID Revision Register
(ZDI_ID_REV = 02h in the ZDI Register Read Only Address Space,
ZDI_ID_REV = 0002h in the I/O Register Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: X = Undetermined; R = Read Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
ZDI_ID_REV
00h–
FFh
Identifies the current revision of the eZ80F91 product.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
307
ZDI Status Register
The ZDI Status register provides current information on the eZ80F91 device and
the CPU. See Table 199.
Table 199. ZDI Status Register
(ZDI_STAT = 03h in the ZDI Register Read Only Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
7
ZDI_ACTIVE
0
The CPU is not functioning in ZDI mode.
1
The CPU is currently functioning in ZDI mode.
6
0
Reserved.
5
halt_SLP
0
The CPU is not currently in HALT or SLEEP mode.
1
The CPU is currently in HALT or SLEEP mode.
4
ADL
0
The CPU is operating in Z80 MEMORY mode.
(ADL bit = 0)
1
The CPU is operating in ADL MEMORY mode.
(ADL bit = 1)
3
MADL
0
The CPU’s Mixed-Memory mode (MADL) bit is reset to 0.
1
The CPU’s Mixed-Memory mode (MADL) bit is set to 1.
2
IEF1
0
The CPU’s Interrupt Enable Flag 1 is reset to 0. Maskable
interrupts are disabled.
1
The CPU’s Interrupt Enable Flag 1 is set to 1. Maskable
interrupts are enabled.
00
Reserved.
[1:0]
RESERVED
PS019209-0504
Value Description
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
308
ZDI Read Register Low, High, and Upper
The ZDI register Read Only address space offers Low, High, and Upper functions,
which contain the value read by a Read operation from the ZDI Read/Write Control register (ZDI_RW_CTL). This data is valid only while in ZDI BREAK mode and
only if the instruction is read by a request from the ZDI Read/Write Control register. See Table 200.
Table 200. ZDI Read Register Low, High and Upper
(ZDI_RD_L = 10h, ZDI_RD_H = 11h, and ZDI_RD_U = 12h
in the ZDI Register Read Only Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
[7:0]
ZDI_RD_L,
ZDI_RD_H,
or
ZDI_RD_U
PS019209-0504
Value Description
00h–
FFh
Values read from the memory location as requested by
the ZDI Read Control register during a ZDI Read
operation. The 24-bit value is supplied by {ZDI_RD_U,
ZDI_RD_H, ZDI_RD_L}.
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
309
ZDI Bus Status Register
The ZDI Bus Status register monitors BUSACKs during DEBUG mode. See Table
201.
Table 201. ZDI Bus Control Register
(ZDI_BUS_STAT = 17h in the ZDI Register Read Only Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
Bit
Position
7
ZDI_BUSACK_EN
6
ZDI_BUS_STAT
[5:0]
Value
Description
0
Bus requests by external peripherals using the
BUSREQ pin are ignored. The bus acknowledge
signal, BUSACK, is not asserted.
1
Bus requests by external peripherals using the
BUSREQ pin are accepted. A bus acknowledge occurs
at the end of the current ZDI operation. The bus
acknowledge is indicated by asserting the BUSACK
pin.
0
Address and data buses are not relinquished to an
external peripheral. bus acknowledge is deasserted
(BUSACK pin is High).
1
Address and data buses are relinquished to an external
peripheral. bus acknowledge is asserted (BUSACK pin
is Low).
000000
Reserved.
ZDI Read Memory Register
When a Read is executed from the ZDI Read Memory register, the eZ80F91
device fetches the data from the memory address currently pointed to by the Program Counter, PC; the Program Counter is then incremented. In Z80 MEMORY
mode, the memory address is {MBASE, PC[15:0]}. In ADL MEMORY mode, the
memory address is PC[23:0]. Refer to the eZ80 CPU User Manual (UM0077),
available on zilog.com, for more information regarding Z80 and ADL MEMORY
modes. The Program Counter, PC, increments after each data Read. However,
the ZDI register address does not increment automatically when this register is
accessed. As a result, the ZDI master can read any number of data bytes out of
memory via the ZDI Read Memory register. See Table 202.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
310
Table 202. ZDI Read Memory Register
(ZDI_RD_MEM = 20h in the ZDI Register Read Only Address Space)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: R = Read Only.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:0]
ZDI_RD_MEM
00h–
FFh
8-bit data Read from the memory address indicated by
the CPU’s Program Counter. In Z80 MEMORY mode, 8bit data is transferred out from address {MBASE,
PC[15:0]}. In ADL Memory mode, 8-bit data is transferred
out from address PC[23:0].
PRELIMINARY
ZiLOG Debug Interface
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
311
On-Chip Instrumentation
Introduction to On-Chip Instrumentation
On-Chip Instrumentation1 (OCI™) for the eZ80® CPU core enables powerful
debugging features. The OCI provides run control, memory and register visibility,
complex break points, and trace history features.
The OCI employs all of the functions of the ZiLOG Debug Interface (ZDI) as
described in the ZDI section. It also adds the following debug features:
•
Control via a 4-pin JTAG port that conforms to IEEE Standard 1149.1 (Test
Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture)
•
•
Complex break point trigger functions
•
•
Trace history buffer
Break point enhancements, such as the ability to:
– Define two break point addresses that form a range
– Break on masked data values
– Start or stop trace
– Assert a trigger output signal
Software break point instruction
There are four sections to the OCI:
•
•
•
•
JTAG interface
ZDI debug control
Trace buffer memory
Complex triggers
This document contains information to activate the OCI for JTAG boundary scan
register operations. For additional information regarding OCI features, or to order
OCI debug tools, please contact:
First Silicon Solutions, Inc.
5440 SW Westgate Drive, Suite 240
Portland, OR 97221
Phone: (503) 292-6730
Fax: (503) 292-5840
www.fs2.com
1. On-Chip Instrumentation and OCI are trademarks of First Silicon Solutions,
Inc.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
312
OCI Activation
OCI features clock initialization circuitry so that external debug hardware can be
detected during power-up. The external debugger must drive the OCI clock pin
(TCK) Low at least two system clock cycles prior to the end of the RESET to activate the OCI block. If TCK is High at the end of the RESET, the OCI block shuts
down so that it does not draw power in normal product operation. When the OCI is
shut down, ZDI is enabled directly and can be accessed via the clock (TCK) and
data (TDI) pins. See the ZiLOG Debug Interface section on page 286 for more
information on ZDI.
OCI Interface
There are six dedicated pins on the eZ80F91 for the OCI interface. Four pins—
TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO—are required for IEEE Standard 1149.1-compliant
JTAG ports. A fifth pin, TRSTn, is optional for IEEE 1149.1 and utilized by the
eZ80F91 device. The TRIGOUT pin provides additional testability features. These
six OCI pins are described in Table 203.
Table 203. OCI Pins
Symbol
Name
Type
Description
TCK
Clock.
Input
Asynchronous to the primary eZ80F91 system clock.
The TCK period must be at least twice the system
clock period. During RESET, this pin is sampled to
select either OCI or ZDI DEBUG modes. If Low
during RESET, the OCI is enabled. If High during
RESET, the OCI is powered down and ZDI DEBUG
mode is enabled. When ZDI DEBUG mode is active,
this pin is the ZDI clock. On-chip pull-up ensures a
default value of 1 (High).
TRSTn
TAP Reset
Input
Active Low asynchronous reset for the Test Access
Port state register. On-chip pull-up ensures a default
value of 1 (High).
TMS
Test Mode Select
Input
This serial test mode input controls JTAG mode
selection. On-chip pull-up ensures a default value of
1 (High). The TMS signal is sampled on the rising
edge of the TCK signal.
TDI
Data In
Input
(OCI enabled)
Serial test data input. This pin is input-only when the
OCI is enabled. The input data is sampled on the
rising edge of the TCK signal.
I/O
(OCI disabled)
When the OCI is disabled, this pin functions as the
ZDA (ZDI Data) I/O pin. NORMAL mode, following
RESET, configures TDI as an input.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
313
Table 203. OCI Pins (Continued)
Symbol
Name
Type
Description
TDO
Data Out
Output
The output data changes on the falling edge of the
TCK signal.
TRIGOUT
Trigger Output
Output
Generates an active High trigger pulse when valid
OCI trigger events occur. Output is tristate when no
data is being driven out.
JTAG Boundary Scan
Introduction
This section describes coverage, implementation, and usage of the eZ80F91
boundary scan register based on the Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) standard. A
working knowledge of the IEEE 1149.1 specification, particularly Clause 11, is
assumed.
Pin Coverage
All pins are included in the boundary scan chain, except for the following:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
PS019209-0504
TCK
TMS
TDI
TDO
TRSTN
VDD
VSS
PLL_VDD
PLL_VSS
RTC_VDD
XIN
XOUT
RTC_XIN
RTC_XOUT
LOOP_FILT
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
314
Boundary Scan Cell Functionality
The boundary scan cells implemented are analogous to cell BC_1, defined in the
Standard VHDL Package STD_1149_1_2001.
All boundary scan cells are of the type control-and-observe; they provide both
controllability and observability for the pins to which they are connected. For
tristate outputs and bidirectional pins, this type includes controllability and observability of output enables.
Chain Sequence and Length
When enabled to shift data, the boundary scan shift register is connected to TDI
at the input line for TRIGOUT and to TDO at PD0. The shift register is arranged so
that data is shifted via the pins starting to the left of the OCI interface pins and proceeding clockwise around the chip. If a pin features multiple scannable bits (e.g.,
bidirectional pins or tristate output pins), the data is shifted first into the input signal, then the output, then the output enable (OEN).
The boundary scan register is 213 bits wide. Table 204 shows the ordering of bits
in the shift register, numbering them in clockwise order.
Table 204. Pin to Boundary Scan Cell Mapping
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
TRIGOUT
Input
0
TRIGOUT
Output
TRIGOUT
Direction
Scan Cell #
MII_TxD2
Output
107
1
MII_TxD3
Output
108
OEN
2
MII_COL
Input
109
HALT_SLP
Output
3
MII_CRS
Input
110
BUSACK
Output
4
PA7
Input
111
BUSREQ
Input
5
PA7
Output
112
NMI
Input
6
PA7
OEN
113
RESET
Input
7
PA6
Input
114
Output
8
PA6
Output
115
Input
9
PA6
OEN
116
Output
10
PA5
Input
117
RESET_OUT
WAIT
INSTRD
Pin
Notes:
1. The address bits 0–7, 8–15, and 16–23 each share a single output enable. In this table, the output enables are
shown to be associated with the least-significant bit that they control.
2. Direction on the data bus is controlled by a single output enable. It is shown in this table as being associated
with D[0].
3. MREQ, IORQ, INSTRDN, RD, and WR share an output enable; it is associated in this table with WR.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
315
Table 204. Pin to Boundary Scan Cell Mapping (Continued)
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
WR
Output
11
PA5
Output
118
WR
OEN
12
PA5
OEN
119
RD
Output
13
PA4
Input
120
MREQ
Input
14
PA4
Output
121
MREQ
Output
15
PA4
OEN
122
IORQ
Input
16
PA3
Input
123
IORQ
Output
17
PA3
Output
124
D7
Input
18
PA3
OEN
125
D7
Output
19
PA2
Input
126
D6
Input
20
PA2
Output
127
D6
Output
21
PA2
OEN
128
D5
Input
22
PA1
Input
129
D5
Output
23
PA1
Output
130
D4
Input
24
PA1
OEN
131
D4
Output
25
PA0
Input
132
D3
Input
26
PA0
Output
133
D3
Output
27
PA0
OEN
134
D2
Input
28
PHI
Output
135
D2
Output
29
PHI
OEN
136
D1
Input
30
SCL
Input
137
D1
Output
31
SCL
Output
138
D0
Input
32
SDA
Input
139
D0
Output
33
SDA
Output
140
D0
OEN
34
PB7
Input
141
Output
35
PB7
Output
142
CS3
Notes:
1. The address bits 0–7, 8–15, and 16–23 each share a single output enable. In this table, the output enables are
shown to be associated with the least-significant bit that they control.
2. Direction on the data bus is controlled by a single output enable. It is shown in this table as being associated
with D[0].
3. MREQ, IORQ, INSTRDN, RD, and WR share an output enable; it is associated in this table with WR.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
316
Table 204. Pin to Boundary Scan Cell Mapping (Continued)
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
CS2
Output
36
PB7
OEN
143
CS1
Output
37
PB6
Input
144
CS0
Output
38
PB6
Output
145
A23
Input
39
PB6
OEN
146
A23
Output
40
PB5
Input
147
A22
Input
41
PB5
Output
148
A22
Output
42
PB5
OEN
149
A21
Input
43
PB4
Input
150
A21
Output
44
PB4
Output
151
A20
Input
45
PB4
OEN
152
A20
Output
46
PB3
Input
153
A19
Input
47
PB3
Output
154
A19
Output
48
PB3
OEN
155
A18
Input
49
PB2
Input
156
A18
Output
50
PB2
Output
157
A17
Input
51
PB2
OEN
158
A17
Output
52
PB1
Input
159
A16
Input
53
PB1
Output
160
A16
Output
54
PB1
OEN
161
A16
OEN
55
PB0
Input
162
A15
Input
56
PB0
Output
163
A15
Output
57
PB0
OEN
164
A14
Input
58
PC7
Input
165
A14
Output
59
PC7
Output
166
A13
Input
60
PC7
OEN
167
Notes:
1. The address bits 0–7, 8–15, and 16–23 each share a single output enable. In this table, the output enables are
shown to be associated with the least-significant bit that they control.
2. Direction on the data bus is controlled by a single output enable. It is shown in this table as being associated
with D[0].
3. MREQ, IORQ, INSTRDN, RD, and WR share an output enable; it is associated in this table with WR.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
317
Table 204. Pin to Boundary Scan Cell Mapping (Continued)
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
A13
Output
61
PC6
Input
168
A12
Input
62
PC6
Output
169
A12
Output
63
PC6
OEN
170
A11
Input
64
PC5
Input
171
A11
Output
65
PC5
Output
172
A10
Input
66
PC5
OEN
173
A10
Output
67
PC4
Input
174
A9
Input
68
PC4
Output
175
A9
Output
69
PC4
OEN
176
A8
Input
70
PC3
Input
177
A8
Output
71
PC3
Output
178
A8
OEN
72
PC3
OEN
179
A7
Input
73
PC2
Input
180
A7
Output
74
PC2
Output
181
A6
Input
75
PC2
OEN
182
A6
Output
76
PC1
Input
183
A5
Input
77
PC1
Output
184
A5
Output
78
PC1
OEN
185
A4
Input
79
PC0
Input
186
A4
Output
80
PC0
Output
187
A3
Input
81
PC0
OEN
188
A3
Output
82
PD7
Input
189
A2
Input
83
PD7
Output
190
A2
Output
84
PD7
OEN
191
A1
Input
85
PD6
Input
192
Notes:
1. The address bits 0–7, 8–15, and 16–23 each share a single output enable. In this table, the output enables are
shown to be associated with the least-significant bit that they control.
2. Direction on the data bus is controlled by a single output enable. It is shown in this table as being associated
with D[0].
3. MREQ, IORQ, INSTRDN, RD, and WR share an output enable; it is associated in this table with WR.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
318
Table 204. Pin to Boundary Scan Cell Mapping (Continued)
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
Pin
Direction
Scan Cell #
A1
Output
86
PD6
Output
193
A0
Input
87
PD6
OEN
194
A0
Output
88
PD5
Input
195
A0
OEN
89
PD5
Output
196
WP
Input
90
PD5
OEN
197
MII_MDIO
Input
91
PD4
Input
198
MII_MDIO
Output
92
PD4
Output
199
MII_MDIO
OEN
93
PD4
OEN
200
MII_MDC
Output
94
PD3
Input
201
MII_RxD3
Input
95
PD3
Output
202
MII_RxD2
Input
96
PD3
OEN
203
MII_RxD1
Input
97
PD2
Input
204
MII_RxD0
Input
98
PD2
Output
205
MII_Rx_DV
Input
99
PD2
OEN
206
MII_Rx_CLK
Input
100
PD1
Input
207
MII_Rx_ER
Input
101
PD1
Output
208
MII_Tx_ER
Output
102
PD1
OEN
209
MII_Tx_CLK
Input
103
PD0
Input
210
MII_Tx_EN
Output
104
PD0
Output
211
MII_TxD0
Output
105
PD0
OEN
212
MII_TxD1
Output
106
Notes:
1. The address bits 0–7, 8–15, and 16–23 each share a single output enable. In this table, the output enables are
shown to be associated with the least-significant bit that they control.
2. Direction on the data bus is controlled by a single output enable. It is shown in this table as being associated
with D[0].
3. MREQ, IORQ, INSTRDN, RD, and WR share an output enable; it is associated in this table with WR.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
319
Usage
Boundary scan functionality is utilized by issuing the appropriate Test Access Port
(TAP) instruction and shifting data accordingly. Both of these steps are accomplished using the JTAG interface. To activate the TAP (see the OCI Activation section on page 312), the TCK pin must be driven Low at least two CPU system clock
cycles prior to the deassertion of the RESET pin. Otherwise, the OCI-JTAG features are disabled.
As per the IEEE 1149.1 specification, the boundary scan cells capture system I/O
on the rising edge of TCK during the CAPTURE_DR state. This captured data is
shifted on the rising edge of TCK while in the SHIFT_DR state. Pins and logic
receive shifted data only when enabled, and only on the falling edge of TCK during the UPDATE_DR state, after shifting is completed.
Refer to the Application Note titled Using BSDL Files with eZ80® and
eZ80Acclaim!™ Devices (AN0114) on the ZiLOG website for more information
about eZ80F91 boundary scan support.
Boundary Scan Instructions
The eZ80F91 device’s boundary scan architecture supports the following instructions:
•
•
•
•
•
PS019209-0504
BYPASS (required)
SAMPLE (required)
EXTEST (required)
PRELOAD (required)
IDCODE (optional)
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Instrumentation
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
320
Phase-Locked Loop
Overview
The Phase-Locked-Loop (PLL) is a programmable frequency multiplier that satisfies the equation SCLK (Hz) = N * FOSC(Hz). A diagram of the PLL block is shown
in Figure 60.
System Clock
(FOSC < SCLK < FOSC * N)
SCLK-MUX
PLL_CTL1[0] = PLL Enable
RTC_CLK
(1MHz < FOSC < 10MHz)
x2
x1
Oscillator
Charge
Pump
PFD
Lock
Detect
PLL_INT
PLL_CTL0[7:6]
VCO
Off-Chip
Loop Filter
CPLL1
RPLL
CPLL2
Div N
PLL_CTL0[3:2]
{PLL_DIV_H, PLL_DIV_L}
Figure 60. Phase-Locked Loop Block Diagram
The seven main blocks of the PLL are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
PS019209-0504
Phase Frequency Detector
Charge Pump
Voltage Controlled Oscillator
Loop Filter
Divider
MUX/CLK Sync
Lock Detect
PRELIMINARY
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
321
Each of these blocks is described in this overview section.
Phase Frequency Detector
The Phase Frequency Detector (PFD) is a digital block. The 2 inputs are the reference clock (XTAL oscillator; see the On-Chip Oscillators section on page 342)
and the PLL divider output. The 2 outputs drive the internal charge pump and represent the error (or difference) between the falling edges of the PFD inputs.
Charge Pump
The Charge Pump is an analog block that is driven by 2 digital inputs from the
PFD that control its programmable current sources. The internal current source
contains four programmable values: 1.5 mA, 1 mA, 500 µA, and 100 µA. These values are selected by PLL_CTRL1[7:6]. The selected current drive is sinked/
sourced onto the loop-filter node according to the error (or difference) between
the falling edges of the PFD inputs. Ideally, when the PLL is locked, there are no
errors (error = 0) and no current is sourced/sinked onto the loop-filter node.
Voltage Controlled Oscillator
The Voltage Controlled Oscillator is an analog block that exhibits an output frequency proportional to its input voltage. The VCO input is driven from the charge
pump and filtered via the off-chip loop filter.
Loop Filter
The Loop Filter comprises off-chip passive components (usually 1 resistor and 2
capacitors) that filter/integrate charge from the internal charge pump. The filtered
node also drives the VCO input, which creates a proportional frequency output.
When the PLL is not used, the Loop Filter pin should be a No Connect.
Divider
The Divider is a digital, programmable downcounter. The divider input is driven by
the VCO. The divider output drives the PFD. The function of the Divider is to
divide the frequency of its input signal by a programmable factor N and supply the
result in its output.
MUX/CLK Sync
The MUX/CLK Sync is a digital, software-controllable multiplexer that selects
between PLL or the XTAL oscillator as the system clock (SCLK). A PLL source
can only be selected after the PLL is locked (via the lock detect block) to allow
glitch-free clock switching.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
322
Lock Detect
The Lock Detect digital block analyzes the PFD output for a locked condition. The
PLL block of the eZ80F91 device is considered locked when the error (or difference) between the reference clock and divided-down VCO is less than the minimum timing lock criteria for the number of consecutive reference clock cycles. The
lock criteria is selected in the PLL Control Register, PLL_CTL0[LDS_CTL]. When
the locked condition is met, this block outputs a logic High signal (lock) that can
interrupt the CPU.
PLL Normal Operation
By default (after system reset) the PLL is disabled and SCLK = XTAL oscillator.
Assuming the proper loop filter, supply voltages and external oscillator are correctly configured, the PLL can be enabled. The SCLK/Timer cannot choose the
PLL as its source until the PLL is locked, as determined by the lock detect block.
By forcing the PLL to be locked prior to enabling the PLL as a SCLK/Timer
source, it is assured to be stable and accurate.
The programming flow for normal PLL operation is shown in Figure 61.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
323
POR/System
Reset
Execute instructions with
SCLK = XTAL Oscillator
Program:
{PLL Divider}
PLL_DIV_L then PLL_DIV_H
{Charge Pump & Lock criteria}
PLL_CTL0
Enable:
{Interrupts & PLL}
PLL_CTL1
Upon Lock Interrupt:
Set SCLK MUX to PLL (PLL_CTL0)
Disable Lock Interrupt Mask
(PLL_CTL1)
Execute Application Code
Figure 61. Normal PLL Programming Flow
Power Requirement to the Phase-Locked Loop Function
Regardless of whether or not the developer chooses to use the PLL module block
as a clock source for the eZ80F91 device, the PLL_VDD (pin 87) must be connected to a VDD supply and the PLL_VSS (pin 84) must be connected to a VSS
supply for proper operation of the eZ80F91 using any system clock source.
PLL Registers
PLL Divider Control Register—Low and High Bytes
This register is designed such that the 11-bit divider value is loaded into the
divider module whenever the PLL_DIV_H register is written. Therefore, the procedure should be to load the PLL_DIV_L register, followed by the PLL_DIV_H register, for the divider to receive the appropriate value.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
324
The divider is designed such that any divider value less than 2 is ignored; a value
of 2 is used in its place.
The least-significant byte of PLL divider N is set via the corresponding bits in the
PLL_DIV_L register. See Tables 205 and 206.
Note: The PLL divider register can only be written to when the PLL is disabled. A readback of the PLL Divider registers returns 0.
Table 205. PLL Divider Register—Low Bytes
(PLL_DIV_L = 005Ch)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: W = Write only.
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:0]
PLL_DIV_L
00h–
FFh
These bits represent the Low byte of the 11-bit PLL divider
value. The complete PLL divider value is returned by
{PLL_DIV_H, PLL_DIV_L}.
Table 206. PLL Divider Register—High Bytes
(PLL_DIV_H = 005Dh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Note: R = Read only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value
Description
[7:3]
00h
Reserved
[2:0]
PLL_DIV_H
0h–7h
These bits represent the High byte of the 11-bit PLL divider
value. The complete PLL divider value is returned by
{PLL_DIV_H, PLL_DIV_L}.
PRELIMINARY
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
325
PLL Control Register 0
The charge pump program, lock detect sensitivity, and system clock source selections can be set using this register. A brief description of each of these PLL Control Register 0 attributes is listed below, and further described in Table 207.
Charge Pump Program (CHRP_CTL). Selects one of four values of charge pump
current.
Lock Detect Sensitivity (LDS_CTL). Determines the lock criteria for the PLL.
System Clock Source (CLK_MUX). Selects the system clock source from a choice
of the external crystal oscillator (XTAL), PLL, or Real-Time Clock crystal oscillator.
Table 207. PLL Control Register 0
(PLL_CTL0 = 005Eh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CPU Access
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
Bit
Position
[7:6]
CHRP_CTL1
Value Description
00
Charge pump current = 100 µA.
01
Charge pump current = 500 µA.
10
Charge pump current = 1.0 mA.
11
Charge pump current = 1.5 mA.
[5:4]
00
Reserved.
[3:2]
LDS_CTL1
00
Lock criteria—8 consecutive cycles of 20 ns.
01
Lock criteria—16 consecutive cycles of 20 ns.
10
Lock criteria—8 consecutive cycles of 400 ns.
11
Lock criteria—16 consecutive cycles of 400 ns.
00
System clock source is the external crystal oscillator.
01
System clock source is the PLL.2.
10
System clock source is the Real-Time Clock crystal oscillator.
11
Reserved (previous select is preserved).
[1:0]
CLK_MUX
Notes:
1. Bits can only be programmed when the PLL is disabled. The PLL is disabled when PLL_CTL1
bit 0 is equal to 0.
2. PLL cannot be selected when disabled or out of lock.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
326
PLL Control Register 1
The PLL is enabled using this register. PLL lock-detect status, the PLL interrupt
signals and the PLL interrupt enables are accessed via this register. A brief
description of each of these PLL Control Register 1 attributes is listed below, and
further described in Table 208.
Lock Status (LCK_STATUS). The current lock bit out of the PLL is synchronized
and can be read via this bit.
Interrupt Lock (INT_LOCK). This signal feeds the interrupt line out of the CLKGEN
module and indicates that a rising edge on the lock signal out of the PLL has been
observed.
Interrupt Unlock (INT_UNLOCK). This signal feeds the interrupt line out of the clk-
gen module and indicates that a falling edge on the lock signal out of the PLL has
been observed.
Interrupt Lock Enable (INT_LOCK_EN). This signal enables the interrupt lock bit.
Interrupt Unlock Enable (INT_UNLOCK_EN). This signal enables the interrupt
unlock bit.
PLL Enable (PLL_ENABLE). Enables/disables the PLL.
.
Table 208. PLL Control Register 1
(PLL_CTL1 = 005Fh)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CPU Access
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: R = Read Only; R/W = Read/Write.
PS019209-0504
Bit
Position
Value Description
[7:6]
00
Reserved
5
LCK_STATUS
0
PLL is currently out of lock.
1
PLL is currently locked.
4
INT_LOCK
0
Lock signal from PLL has not risen since last time register
was read.
1
Interrupt generated when PLL enters lock mode. Held until
register is read.
PRELIMINARY
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
327
Bit
Position
3
INT_UNLOCK
Value Description
0
Lock signal from PLL has not fallen since last time register
was read
1
Interrupt generated when PLL goes out of lock. Held until
register is read.
2
0
INT_LOCK_EN
Interrupt generation for PLL locked condition (Bit 4) is
disabled.
1
Interrupt generation for PLL locked condition is enabled.
1
0
INT_UNLOCK_
EN
1
Interrupt generation for PLL unlocked condition (Bit 3) is
disabled.
0
PLL_ENABLE
0
PLL is disabled.1
1
PLL is enabled.
Interrupt generation for PLL unlocked condition is enabled.
Notes:
1. PLL cannot be disabled if the CLK_MUX bit of PLL_CTL0[1:0] is set to 01, because the PLL is
selected as the clock source.
PLL Characteristics
The operating and testing characteristics for the PLL are described in Table 209.
Note: Not all conditions are tested in production test. The values in Table 209 are for
design and characterization only.
Table 209. PLL Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Test Condition
IOHCP_OUT
High level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD < 3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT < VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 11
–0.86 –1.50 –2.13
mA
IOLCP_OUT
Low level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT < VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 11
0.86
1.50
2.13
mA
IOHCP_OUT
High level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT < VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 10
–0.42
–1.0
–1.42
mA
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
328
Table 209. PLL Characteristics (Continued)
Symbol
Parameter
Test Condition
Min
Typ
Max
Units
IOLCP_OUT
Low level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT <VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 10
0.42
1.0
1.42
mA
IOHCP_OUT
High level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT <VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 01
–210
–500
–710
µA
IOLCP_OUT
Low level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT <VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 01
210
500
710
µA
IOHCP_OUT
High level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT <VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 00
–42
–100
–142
µA
IOLCP_OUT
Low level output current for
CP_OUT pin (programmed
value ±42%)
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < PD_OUT <VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = 00
42
100
142
µA
Match
IOHCP_OUT–IOLCP_OUT
current match
3.0 < VDD <3.6
0.6 < CP_OUT <VDD – 0.6
PLL_CTL0[7:6] = XX
–15
+15
%
ILCP_OUT
Tristate leakage on CP_OUT CP_OUT tristated
output pin
–1
1
µA
FOSC
Crystal oscillator frequency
PLL_CTL0[5:4] = 01
1M
10M
Hz
FVCO
VCO frequency
Recommended operating
conditions
GVCO
VCO Gain
Recommended operating
conditions
36
D1
SCLK Duty Cycle from PLL
Recommended operating
conditions
45
or XTALOSC source.
50
MHz
120
MHz/
V
50
55
%
350
500
ps
T1A
PLL Clock Jitter
FVCO = 50 MHz. XTALOSC
= 10 MHz
Lock2
PLL Lock-Time
FVCO = 50MHz. XTALOSC
= 3.579 MHz
CPLL1 = 220 pF, RPLL =
499Ω, CPLL2 = 0.056 µF
IOH1
(XTL)
High-level Output Current for VOH = VDD–0.4 V
XTAL2 pin
PLL_CTL0[5:4] = 01
–0.3
mA
IOL1
(XTL)
Low-level Output Current for VOL = 0.4 V
XTAL2 pin
PLL_CTL0[5:4] = 01
0.6
mA
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
s
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
329
Table 209. PLL Characteristics (Continued)
Symbol
Parameter
IOH2
(XTL)
High-level Output Current for VOH = VDD–0.4 V
XTAL2 pin
PLL_CTL0[5:4] = 11
mA
IOL2
(XTL)
Low-level Output Current for VOL = 0.4 V
XTAL2 pin
PLL_CTL0[5:4] = 11
mA
VPP3M
(XTL)
Peak-to-peak voltage under
oscillator conditions for
XTAL2 pin
FOSC = 3.579 MHz
Cx1 = 10 pF
Cx2 = 10 pF
V
VPP10M
(XTL)
Peak-to-peak voltage under
oscillator conditions for
XTAL2 pin
FOSC = 10 MHz
Cx1 = 10 pF
Cx2 = 10 pF
V
CXTAL1
Capacitance measured from T = 25ºC
XTAL1 pin to GND
pF
CXTAL2
(package
type)
Capacitance measured from T = 25ºC
XTAL2 pin to GND
pF
CLOOP
(package
type)
Capacitance measured from T = 25ºC
loop filter pin to GND
pF
(package
type)
PS019209-0504
Test Condition
PRELIMINARY
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Phase-Locked Loop
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
330
eZ80® CPU Instruction Set
Tables 210 through 219 indicate the CPU instructions available for use with the
eZ80F91 device. The instructions are grouped by class. More detailed information
is available in the eZ80 CPU User Manual (UM0077), available on zilog.com.
Table 210. Arithmetic Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
ADC
Add with Carry
ADD
Add without Carry
CP
Compare with Accumulator
DAA
Decimal Adjust Accumulator
DEC
Decrement
INC
Increment
MLT
Multiply
NEG
Negate Accumulator
SBC
Subtract with Carry
SUB
Subtract without Carry
Table 211. Bit Manipulation Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
BIT
Bit Test
RES
Reset Bit
SET
Set Bit
Table 212. Block Transfer and Compare Instructions
PS019209-0504
Mnemonic
Instruction
CPD (CPDR)
Compare and Decrement (with Repeat)
CPI (CPIR)
Compare and Increment (with Repeat)
PRELIMINARY
eZ80® CPU Instruction Set
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
331
Table 212. Block Transfer and Compare Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
LDD (LDDR)
Load and Decrement (with Repeat)
LDI (LDIR)
Load and Increment (with Repeat)
Table 213. Exchange Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
EX
Exchange registers
EXX
Exchange CPU Multibyte register banks
Table 214. Input/Output Instructions
PS019209-0504
Mnemonic
Instruction
IN
Input from I/O
IN0
Input from I/O on Page 0
IND (INDR)
Input from I/O and Decrement (with Repeat)
INDRX
Input from I/O and Decrement Memory Address with Stationary
I/O Address
IND2 (IND2R)
Input from I/O and Decrement (with Repeat)
INDM (INDMR)
Input from I/O and Decrement (with Repeat)
INI (INIR)
Input from I/O and Increment (with Repeat)
INIRX
Input from I/O and Increment Memory Address with Stationary
I/O Address
INI2 (INI2R)
Input from I/O and Increment (with Repeat)
INIM (INIMR)
Input from I/O and Increment (with Repeat)
OTDM (OTDMR)
Output to I/O and Decrement (with Repeat)
OTDRX
Output to I/O and Decrement Memory Address with Stationary
I/O Address
OTIM (OTIMR)
Output to I/O and Increment (with Repeat)
OTIRX
Output to I/O and Increment Memory Address with Stationary I/
O Address
OUT
Output to I/O
PRELIMINARY
eZ80® CPU Instruction Set
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
332
Table 214. Input/Output Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
OUT0
Output to I/0 on Page 0
OUTD (OTDR)
Output to I/O and Decrement (with Repeat)
OUTD2 (OTD2R)
Output to I/O and Decrement (with Repeat)
OUTI (OTIR)
Output to I/O and Increment (with Repeat)
OUTI2 (OTI2R)
Output to I/O and Increment (with Repeat)
TSTIO
Test I/O
Table 215. Load Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
LD
Load
LEA
Load Effective Address
PEA
Push Effective Address
POP
Pop
PUSH
Push
Table 216. Logical Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
AND
Logical AND
CPL
Complement Accumulator
OR
Logical OR
TST
Test Accumulator
XOR
Logical Exclusive OR
Table 217. Processor Control Instructions
PS019209-0504
Mnemonic
Instruction
CCF
Complement Carry Flag
DI
Disable Interrupts
PRELIMINARY
eZ80® CPU Instruction Set
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
333
Table 217. Processor Control Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
EI
Enable Interrupts
HALT
Halt
IM
Interrupt Mode
NOP
No Operation
RSMIX
Reset Mixed-Memory Mode Flag
SCF
Set Carry Flag
SLP
Sleep
STMIX
Set Mixed-Memory Mode Flag
Table 218. Program Control Instructions
Mnemonic
Instruction
CALL
Call Subroutine
CALL cc
Conditional Call Subroutine
DJNZ
Decrement and Jump if Nonzero
JP
Jump
JP cc
Conditional Jump
JR
Jump Relative
JR cc
Conditional Jump Relative
RET
Return
RET cc
Conditional Return
RETI
Return from Interrupt
RETN
Return from Nonmaskable interrupt
RST
Restart
Table 219. Rotate and Shift Instructions
PS019209-0504
Mnemonic
Instruction
RL
Rotate Left
RLA
Rotate Left–Accumulator
PRELIMINARY
eZ80® CPU Instruction Set
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
334
Table 219. Rotate and Shift Instructions
PS019209-0504
Mnemonic
Instruction
RLC
Rotate Left Circular
RLCA
Rotate Left Circular–Accumulator
RLD
Rotate Left Decimal
RR
Rotate Right
RRA
Rotate Right–Accumulator
RRC
Rotate Right Circular
RRCA
Rotate Right Circular–Accumulator
RRD
Rotate Right Decimal
SLA
Shift Left Arithmetic
SRA
Shift Right Arithmetic
SRL
Shift Right Logical
PRELIMINARY
eZ80® CPU Instruction Set
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
335
Op-Code Map
Tables 220 through 226 indicate the hex values for each of the eZ80® instructions.
Table 220. Op Code Map—First Op Code
Legend
Lower Op Code Nibble
Upper
Op Code
Nibble
4
AND
A
A,H
Mnemonic
Second Operand
First Operand
Lower Nibble (Hex)
Upper Nibble (Hex)
0
1
LD
0 NOP
BC,
Mmn
LD
DJNZ
1
DE,
d
Mmn
LD
JR
2
HL,
NZ,d
Mmn
LD
JR
3
SP,
NC,d
Mmn
.SIS
LD
4
suffix
B,C
LD
LD
5
D,B
D,C
LD
LD
6
H,B
H,C
LD
LD
7
(HL),B (HL),C
ADD
ADD
8
A,B
A,C
SUB
SUB
9
A,B
A,C
AND
AND
A
A,B
A,C
OR
OR
B
A,B
A,C
C
RET
NZ
D
RET
NC
E
RET
PO
F
RET
P
Notes:
2
3
4
5
6
LD
(BC),A
INC
BC
INC
B
DEC
B
LD
B,n
LD
(DE),A
INC
DE
INC
D
DEC
D
LD
D,n
LD
INC
INC
DEC
LD
(Mmn),
HL
H
H
H,n
HL
LD
INC
INC
DEC
LD
(Mmn),
SP
(HL)
(HL) (HL),n
A
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
B,D
B,E
B,H
B,L
B,(HL)
.SIL
LD
LD
LD
LD
suffix
D,E
D,H
D,L
D,(HL)
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
H,D
H,E
H,H
H,L
H,(HL)
LD
LD
LD
LD
HALT
(HL),D (HL),E (HL),H (HL),L
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
A,D
A,E
A,H
A,L
A,(HL)
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
A,D
A,E
A,H
A,L
A,(HL)
AND
AND
AND
AND
AND
A,D
A,E
A,H
A,L
A,(HL)
OR
OR
OR
OR
OR
A,D
A,E
A,H
A,L
A,(HL)
JP
CALL
POP
JP
PUSH ADD
NZ,
NZ,
BC
Mmn
BC
A,n
Mmn
Mmn
JP
CALL
POP
OUT
PUSH SUB
NC,
NC,
DE
(n),A
DE
A,n
Mmn
Mmn
JP
CALL
POP
EX
PUSH AND
PO,
PO,
HL
(SP),HL
HL
A,n
Mmn
Mmn
JP
CALL
POP
PUSH
OR
P,
DI
P,
AF
AF
A,n
Mmn
Mmn
n = 8-bit data; Mmn = 16- or 24-bit addr or data; d
PS019209-0504
7
8
9
A
EX
ADD
LD
RLCA
AF,AF’ HL,BC A,(BC)
RLA
JR
d
ADD
LD
HL,DE A,(DE)
B
C
D
E
F
DEC
BC
INC
C
DEC
C
LD
C,n
RRCA
DEC
DE
INC
E
DEC
E
LD
E,n
RRA
INC
L
DEC
L
LD
L,n
CPL
INC
A
DEC
A
LD
A,n
CCF
LD
C,H
LD
E,H
LD
L,H
LD
A,H
ADC
A,H
SBC
A,H
XOR
A,H
CP
A,H
CALL
Z,
Mmn
CALL
CF,
Mmn
CALL
PE,
Mmn
CALL
M,
Mmn
LD
C,L
LD
E,L
LD
L,L
LD
A,L
ADC
A,L
SBC
A,L
XOR
A,L
CP
A,L
LD
C,(HL)
LD
E,(HL)
LD
L,(HL)
LD
A,(HL)
ADC
A,(HL)
SBC
A,(HL)
XOR
A,(HL)
CP
A,(HL)
LD
C,A
LD
E,A
LD
L,A
LD
A,A
ADC
A,A
SBC
A,A
XOR
A,A
CP
A,A
CALL
Mmn
ADC
A,n
RST
08h
Table
222
SBC
A,n
RST
18h
Table
223
XOR
A,n
RST
28h
Table
224
CP
A,n
RST
38h
LD
DEC
HL,
HL
(Mmn)
LD
JR
ADD
DEC
SCF
A,
CF,d HL,SP
SP
(Mmn)
LD
LD
.LIS
LD
LD
B,A
C,B
suffix
C,D
C,E
LD
LD
LD
LD
.LIL
D,A
E,B
E,C
E,D
suffix
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
H,A
L,B
L,C
L,D
L,E
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
(HL),A
A,B
A,C
A,D
A,E
ADD
ADC
ADC
ADC
ADC
A,A
A,B
A,C
A,D
A,E
SUB
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
A,A
A,B
A,C
A,D
A,E
AND
XOR
XOR
XOR
XOR
A,A
A,B
A,C
A,D
A,E
OR
CP
CP
CP
CP
A,A
A,B
A,C
A,D
A,E
JP
RST
RET
Table
RET
Z,
00h
Z
221
Mmn
JP
RST
RET
IN
EXX
CF,
10h
CF
A,(n)
Mmn
JP
RST
RET
JP
EX
PE,
20h
PE
(HL)
DE,HL
Mmn
JP
RST
RET
LD
M,
EI
30h
M
SP,HL
Mmn
= 8-bit two’s-complement displacement.
DAA
JR
Z,d
PRELIMINARY
ADD
HL,HL
Op-Code Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
336
Table 221. Op Code Map—Second Op Code after 0CBh
Legend
Lower Nibble of 2nd Op Code
Upper
Nibble
of Second
Op Code
4
RES
A
4,H
Mnemonic
First Operand
Second Operand
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
0
RLC
B
RLC
C
RLC
D
RLC
E
RLC
H
RLC
L
RLC
(HL)
RLC
A
RRC
B
RRC
C
RRC
D
RRC
E
RRC
H
RRC
L
RRC
(HL)
RRC
A
1
RL
B
RL
C
RL
D
RL
E
RL
H
RL
L
RL
(HL)
RL
A
RR
B
RR
C
RR
D
RR
E
RR
H
RR
L
RR
(HL)
RR
A
2
SLA
B
SLA
C
SLA
D
SLA
E
SLA
H
SLA
L
SLA
(HL)
SLA
A
SRA
B
SRA
C
SRA
D
SRA
E
SRA
H
SRA
L
SRA
(HL)
SRA
A
SRL
B
SRL
C
SRL
D
SRL
E
SRL
H
SRL
L
SRL
(HL)
SRL
A
Upper Nibble (Hex)
3
4
BIT
0,B
BIT
0,C
BIT
0,D
BIT
0,E
BIT
0,H
BIT
0,L
BIT
0,(HL)
BIT
0,A
BIT
1,B
BIT
1,C
BIT
1,D
BIT
1,E
BIT
1,H
BIT
1,L
BIT
1,(HL)
BIT
1,A
5
BIT
2,B
BIT
2,C
BIT
2,D
BIT
2,E
BIT
2,H
BIT
2,L
BIT
2,(HL)
BIT
2,A
BIT
3,B
BIT
3,C
BIT
3,D
BIT
3,E
BIT
3,H
BIT
3,L
BIT
3,(HL)
BIT
3,A
6
BIT
4,B
BIT
4,C
BIT
4,D
BIT
4,E
BIT
4,H
BIT
4,L
BIT
4,(HL)
BIT
4,A
BIT
5,B
BIT
5,C
BIT
5,D
BIT
5,E
BIT
5,H
BIT
5,L
BIT
5,(HL)
BIT
5,A
7
BIT
6,B
BIT
6,C
BIT
6,D
BIT
6,E
BIT
6,H
BIT
6,L
BIT
6,(HL)
BIT
6,A
BIT
7,B
BIT
7,C
BIT
7,D
BIT
7,E
BIT
7,H
BIT
7,L
BIT
7,(HL)
BIT
7,A
8
RES
0,B
RES
0,C
RES
0,D
RES
0,E
RES
0,H
RES
0,L
RES
0,(HL)
RES
0,A
RES
1,B
RES
1,C
RES
1,D
RES
1,E
RES
1,H
RES
1,L
RES
1,(HL)
RES
1,A
9
RES
2,B
RES
2,C
RES
2,D
RES
2,E
RES
2,H
RES
2,L
RES
2,(HL)
RES
2,A
RES
3,B
RES
3,C
RES
3,D
RES
3,E
RES
3,H
RES
3,L
RES
3,(HL)
RES
3,A
A
RES
4,B
RES
4,C
RES
4,D
RES
4,E
RES
4,H
RES
4,L
RES
4,(HL)
RES
4,A
RES
5,B
RES
5,C
RES
5,D
RES
5,E
RES
5,H
RES
5,L
RES
5,(HL)
RES
5,A
B
RES
6,B
RES
6,C
RES
6,D
RES
6,E
RES
6,H
RES
6,L
RES
6,(HL)
RES
6,A
RES
7,B
RES
7,C
RES
7,D
RES
7,E
RES
7,H
RES
7,L
RES
7,(HL)
RES
7,A
C
SET
0,B
SET
0,C
SET
0,D
SET
0,E
SET
0,H
SET
0,L
SET
0,(HL)
SET
0,A
SET
1,B
SET
1,C
SET
1,D
SET
1,E
SET
1,H
SET
1,L
SET
1,(HL)
SET
1,A
D
SET
2,B
SET
2,C
SET
2,D
SET
2,E
SET
2,H
SET
2,L
SET
2,(HL)
SET
2,A
SET
3,B
SET
3,C
SET
3,D
SET
3,E
SET
3,H
SET
3,L
SET
3,(HL)
SET
3,A
E
SET
4,B
SET
4,C
SET
4,D
SET
4,E
SET
4,H
SET
4,L
SET
4,(HL)
SET
4,A
SET
5,B
SET
5,C
SET
5,D
SET
5,E
SET
5,H
SET
5,L
SET
5,(HL)
SET
5,A
F
SET
6,B
SET
6,C
SET
6,D
SET
6,E
SET
6,H
SET
6,L
SET
6,(HL)
SET
6,A
SET
7,B
SET
7,C
SET
7,D
SET
7,E
SET
7,H
SET
7,L
SET
7,(HL)
SET
7,A
Notes:
n = 8-bit data; Mmn = 16- or 24-bit addr or data; d = 8-bit two’s-complement displacement.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Op-Code Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
337
Table 222. Op Code Map—Second Op Code After 0DDh
Legend
Lower Nibble of 2nd Op Code
Upper
Nibble
of Second
Op Code
9
F LD
SP,IX
Mnemonic
Second Operand
First Operand
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
LD BC,
(IX+d)
ADD
IX,BC
1
LD DE,
(IX+d)
ADD
IX,DE
2
LD
IX,
Mmn
3
LD IY,
(IX+d)
4
Upper Nibble (Hex)
1
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
LD
(Mmn),
IX
INC
IX
INC
IXH
DEC
IXH
LD
IXH,n
LD HL,
(IX+d)
ADD
IX,IX
INC
(IX+d)
DEC
(IX+d)
LD (IX
+d),n
LD IX,
(IX+d)
ADD
IX,SP
LD
LD
B,IXH B,IXL
LD
LD
D,IXH D,IXL
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
IXH,B IXH,C IXH,D IXH,E IXH,IXH IXH,IXL
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
(IX+d),B (IX+d),C (IX+d),D (IX+d),E (IX+d),H (IX+d),L
ADD
ADD
A,IXH A,IXL
SUB
SUB
A,IXH A,IXL
AND
AND
A,IXH A,IXL
OR
OR
A,IXH A,IXL
LD B,
(IX+d)
LD D,
(IX+d)
LD H,
(IX+d)
LD
LD
IXH,A IXL,B
LD
(IX+d),A
LD
IXL,C
ADD A,
(IX+d)
SUB A,
(IX+d)
AND A,
(IX+d)
OR A,
(IX+d)
C
A
B
C
D
LD
IX,
(Mmn)
DEC
IX
INC
IXL
DEC
IXL
LD
IXL,D
LD
C,IXH
LD
E,IXH
LD
LD
IXL,E IXL,IXH
LD
A,IXH
ADC
A,IXH
SBC
A,IXH
XOR
A,IXH
CP
A,IXH
Table
225
E
LD
C,IXL
LD
E,IXL
LD
IXL,IXL
LD
A,IXL
ADC
A,IXL
SBC
A,IXL
XOR
A,IXL
CP
A,IXL
F
LD
(IX+d),
BC
LD
(IX+d),
DE
LD
LD
(IX+d),
IXL,n
HL
LD
LD
(IX+d), (IX+d),
IY
IX
LD C,
(IX+d)
LD E,
(IX+d)
LD L,
LD
(IX+d) IXL,A
LD A,
(IX+d)
ADC A,
(IX+d)
SBC A,
(IX+d)
XOR A,
(IX+d)
CP A,
(IX+d)
D
POP
IX
E
EX
(SP),IX
PUSH
IX
JP
(IX)
LD
SP,IX
F
Notes:
n = 8-bit data; Mmn = 16- or 24-bit addr or data; d = 8-bit two’s-complement displacement.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Op-Code Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
338
Table 223. Op Code Map—Second Op Code After 0EDh
Legend
Lower Nibble of 2nd Op Code
Upper
Nibble
of Second
Op Code
2
4 SBC
HL,BC
First Operand
Mnemonic
Second Operand
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
1
2
LEA
BC,
IX+d
LEA
DE,
IX+d
3
LEA
BC,
IY+d
LEA
DE,
IY+d
0
IN0
B,(n)
OUT0
(n),B
1
IN0
D,(n)
OUT0
(n),D
2
IN0
H,(n)
OUT0 LEA HL LEA HL
(n),H ,IX+d ,IY+d
4
6
7
8
9
TST
A,B
LD BC,
(HL)
IN0
C,(n)
OUT0
(n),C
TST
A,C
TST
A,D
LD DE,
(HL)
IN0
E,(n)
OUT0
(n),E
TST
A,E
TST
A,H
LD HL,
(HL)
IN0
L,(n)
OUT0
(n),L
TST
A,L
LD IX,
(HL)
IN0
A,(n)
OUT0
(n),A
TST
A,A
IM 0
LD
I,A
IN
C,(C)
OUT
(C),C
IM 1
LD
A,I
IN
E,(C)
OUT
(C),E
PEA
IY+d
RRD
IN
L,(C)
OUT
(C),L
IN
A,(C)
OUT
(C),A
LD IY, LEA IX LEA IY TST
(HL)
,IX+d ,IY+d A,(HL)
3
LD
IN
OUT
SBC
(Mmn), NEG RETN
B,(BC) (BC),B HL,BC
BC
LD
IN
OUT
SBC
LEA IX, LEA IY,
5
(Mmn),
D,(BC) (BC),D HL,DE
IY+d
IX+d
DE
LD
IBN
OUT
SBC
TST
PEA
6
(Mmn),
H,(C) (BC),H HL,HL
A,n
IX+d
HL
LD
SBC
TSTIO
7
(Mmn),
HL,SP
n
SP
4
Upper Nibble (Hex)
5
8
INIM
9
OTIM
SLP
INI2
LDI
CPI
INI
OUTI
OUTI2
B
LDIR
CPIR
INIR
OTIR
OTI2R
C
INIRX OTIRX
D
B
LD
BC,
(Mmn)
LD
ADC
DE,
HL,DE
(Mmn)
LD
ADC
HL,
HL,HL
(Mmn)
LD
ADC
SP,
HL,SP
(Mmn)
ADC
HL,BC
INDM OTDM
INIMR OTIMR INI2R
A
A
C
MLT
BC
D
MLT
SP
F
LD
(HL),
BC
LD(HL),
DE
LD
(HL),IY
LD
MB,A
LD
(HL),
HL
LD
(HL),
IX
LD
R,A
RETI
MLT
DE
MLT
HL
E
IM 2
LD
A,R
LD
A,MB
RLD
STMIX RSMIX
IND2
INDMR OTDMR IND2R
LDD
CPD
LDDR CPDR
LD
I,HL
LD
HL,I
IND
OUTD OUTD2
INDR
OTDR OTD2R
INDRX OTDRX
E
F
Notes:
n = 8-bit data; Mmn = 16- or 24-bit addr or data; d = 8-bit two’s-complement displacement.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Op-Code Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
339
Table 224. Op Code Map—Second Op Code After 0FDh
Legend
Lower Nibble of 2nd Op Code
Upper
Nibble
of Second
Op Code
9
LD
F
SP,IY
Mnemonic
First Operand
Second Operand
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
1
2
3
4
5
0
1
LD
LD
(Mmn),I
IY,Mmn
Y
LD IX,
(IY+d)
2
3
4
Upper Nibble (Hex)
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
INC
IY
INC
IYH
DEC
IYH
INC
DEC
(IY+d) (IY+d)
LD
LD
B,IYH B,IYL
LD
LD
D,IYH D,IYL
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
LD
IYH,B IYH,C IYH,D IYH,E IYH,IYH IYH,IYL
LD (IY LD (IY LD (IY LD (IY LD (IY LD (IY
+d),B +d),C +d),D +d),E +d),H +d),L
ADD
ADD
A,IYH A,IYL
SUB
SUB
A,IYH A,IYL
AND
AND
A,IYH A,IYL
OR
OR
A,IYH A,IYL
6
7
8
9
LD BC,
(IY+d)
LD DE,
(IY+d)
ADD
IY,BC
ADD
IY,DE
LD
LD HL,
IYH,n (IY+d)
ADD
IY,IY
LD (IY LD IY,
+d),n (IY+d)
LD B,
(IY+d)
LD D,
(IY+d)
LD H,
LD
(IY+d) IYH,A
LD (IY
+d),A
ADD A,
(IY+d)
SUB A,
(IY+d)
AND A,
(IY+d)
OR A,
(IY+d)
ADD
IY,SP
LD
IYL,B
LD
IYL,C
C
A
B
C
D
E
F
LD (IY
+d),BC
LD (IY
+d),DE
LD
IY,
(Mmn)
LD
IYL,D
DEC
IY
INC
IYL
LD
C,IYH
LD
E,IYH
LD
LD
IYL,E IYL,IYH
LD
A,IYH
ADC
A,IYH
SBC
A,IYH
XOR
A,IYH
CP
A,IYH
Table
226
DEC
IYL
LD
IYL,n
LD
C,IYL
LD
E,IYL
LD
IYL,IYL
LD
A,IYL
ADC
A,IYL
SBC
A,IYL
XOR
A,IYL
CP
A,IYL
LD (IY
+d),HL
LD (IY LD (IY
+d),IX +d),IY
LD C,
(IY+d)
LD E,
(IY+d)
LD L,
LD
(IY+d) IYL,A
LD A,
(IY+d)
ADC A,
(IY+d)
SBC A,
(IY+d)
XOR A,
(IY+d)
CP A,
(IY+d)
D
POP
IY
E
EX
(SP),IY
PUSH
IY
JP
(IY)
LD
SP,IY
F
Notes:
n = 8-bit data; Mmn = 16- or 24-bit addr or data; d = 8-bit two’s-complement displacement.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Op-Code Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
340
Table 225. Op Code Map—Fourth Byte After 0DDh, 0CBh, and dd
Legend
Lower Nibble of 4th Byte
Upper
Nibble
of Fourth
Byte
6
BIT
4 0,(IX+d)
First Operand
Mnemonic
Second Operand
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
RLC
(IX+d)
RL
(IX+d)
SLA
(IX+d)
0
1
2
7
8
3
BIT 0,
(IX+d)
BIT 2,
(IX+d)
BIT 4,
(IX+d)
BIT 6,
(IX+d)
RES 0,
(IX+d)
RES 2,
(IX+d)
RES 4,
(IX+d)
RES 6,
(IX+d)
SET 0,
(IX+d)
SET 2,
(IX+d)
SET 4,
(IX+d)
SET 6,
(IX+d)
4
Upper Nibble (Hex)
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
Notes:
9
A
B
C
D
E
RRC
(IX+d)
RR
(IX+d)
SRA
(IX+d)
SRL
(IX+d)
BIT 1,
(IX+d)
BIT 3,
(IX+d)
BIT 5,
(IX+d)
BIT 7,
(IX+d)
RES 1,
(IX+d)
RES 3,
(IX+d)
RES 5,
(IX+d)
RES 7,
(IX+d)
SET 1,
(IX+d)
SET 3,
(IX+d)
SET 5,
(IX+d)
SET 7,
(IX+d)
F
d = 8-bit two’s-complement displacement.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Op-Code Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
341
Table 226. Op Code Map—Fourth Byte After 0FDh, 0CBh, and dd*
Legend
Lower Nibble of 4th Byte
Upper
Nibble
of Fourth
Byte
6
BIT
4
0,(IY+d)
First Operand
Mnemonic
Second Operand
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
RLC
(IY+d)
RL
(IY+d)
SLA
(IY+d)
0
1
2
3
BIT 0,
(IY+d)
BIT 2,
(IY+d)
BIT 4,
(IY+d)
BIT 6,
(IY+d)
RES 0,
(IY+d)
RES 2,
(IY+d)
RES 4,
(IY+d)
RES 6,
(IY+d)
SET 0,
(IY+d)
SET 2,
(IY+d)
SET 4,
(IY+d)
SET 6,
(IY+d)
4
Upper Nibble (Hex)
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
Notes:
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
RRC
(IY+d)
RR
(IY+d)
SRA
(IY+d)
SRL
(IY+d)
BIT 1,
(IY+d)
BIT 3,
(IY+d)
BIT 5,
(IY+d)
BIT 7,
(IY+d)
RES 1,
(IY+d)
RES 3,
(IY+d)
RES 5,
(IY+d)
RES 7,
(IY+d)
SET 1,
(IY+d)
SET 3,
(IY+d)
SET 5,
(IY+d)
SET 7,
(IY+d)
d = 8-bit two’s-complement displacement.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Op-Code Map
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
342
On-Chip Oscillators
The eZ80F91 features two on-chip oscillators for use with an external crystal. The
primary oscillator generates the system clock for the internal CPU and the majority of the on-chip peripherals. Alternatively, the XIN input pin can also accept a
CMOS-level clock input signal. If an external clock generator is used, the XOUT
pin should be left unconnected. The secondary oscillator can drive a 32 KHz crystal to generate the time-base for the Real-Time Clock.
Primary Crystal Oscillator Operation
Figure 62 illustrates a recommended configuration for connection with an external
50MHz, 3rd-overtone, parallel-resonant crystal. Recommended crystal specifications are provided in Tables 227 and 228. Printed circuit board layout should add
no more than 4 pF of stray capacitance to either the XIN or XOUT pins. If oscillation
does not occur, the user should try removing C1 for testing and decreasing the
value of C2 by the estimated stray capacitance to decrease loading.
On-Chip Oscillator
XIN
XOUT
50 MHz Crystal
(Third Overtone)
C 1 = 5 pF
R = 100 KΩ
C 2 = 10-15 pF
L = 33 µH (± 10%)
C3 = .01-0.1 µF
Figure 62. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Configuration—50 MHz Operation
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Oscillators
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
343
Table 227. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Specifications—1 MHz Operation
Parameter
Frequency
Dependent Value
Units
Frequency
1
MHz
Resonance
Parallel
Mode
Fundamental
Series Resistance (RS)
750
Ohms
Maximum
Load Capacitance (CL)
13
pF
Maximum
Shunt Capacitance (C0)
7
pF
Maximum
Drive Level
1
mW
Maximum
Comments
Table 228. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Specifications—10 MHz Operation
Parameter
Frequency
Dependent Value
Units
Frequency
10
MHz
Resonance
Parallel
Mode
Fundamental
Series Resistance (RS)
35
Ohms
Maximum
Load Capacitance (CL)
30
pF
Maximum
Shunt Capacitance (C0)
7
pF
Maximum
Drive Level
1
mW
Maximum
Comments
32 KHz Real-Time Clock Crystal Oscillator Operation
Figure 63 illustrates a recommended configuration for connecting the Real-Time
Clock oscillator with an external 32 KHz, fundamental-mode, parallel-resonant
crystal. The recommended crystal specifications are provided in Table 229. A
printed circuit board layout should add no more than 4 pF of stray capacitance to
either the RTC_XIN or RTC_XOUT pins. If oscillation does not occur, reduce the
values of capacitors C1 and C2 to decrease loading.
An on-chip MOS resistor sets the crystal drive current limit. This configuration
does not require an external bias resistor across the crystal. An on-chip MOS
resistor provides the biasing.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Oscillators
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
344
On-Chip Oscillator
RTC_XIN
C1 = 10 pF
RTC_XOUT
32 kHz Crystal
(Fundamental Mode)
C2 = 10 pF
Figure 63. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Configuration—32 KHz Operation
Table 229. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Specifications—32 KHz Operation
PS019209-0504
Parameter
Value
Units
Comments
Frequency
32
KHz
32768 Hz
Resonance
Parallel
Mode
Fundamental
Series Resistance (RS)
40
kΩ
Maximum
Load Capacitance (CL)
12.5
pF
Maximum
Shunt Capacitance (C0)
3
pF
Maximum
Drive Level
1
µW
Maximum
PRELIMINARY
On-Chip Oscillators
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
345
Electrical Characteristics
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Stresses greater than those listed in Table 230 can cause permanent damage to
the device. These ratings are stress ratings only. Operation of the device at any
condition outside those indicated in the operational sections of these specifications is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended
periods can affect device reliability. For improved reliability, unused inputs should
be tied to one of the supply voltages (VDD or VSS).
Table 230. Absolute Maximum Ratings
Parameter
Min
Max
Units
Notes
Ambient temperature under bias (ºC)
–40
+105
ºC
1
Storage temperature (ºC)
–65
+150
C
Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS
–0.3
+5.5
V
Voltage on VDD pin with respect to VSS
–0.3
+3.6
V
Total power dissipation
830
mW
Maximum current out of VSS
230
mA
Maximum current into VDD
230
mA
Maximum current on input and/or inactive output pin
–15
+15
µA
Maximum output current from active output pin
–8
+8
mA
2
Notes:
1. Operating temperature is specified in DC Characteristics.
2. This voltage applies to all pins except where noted otherwise.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
346
DC Characteristics
Table 231 lists the DC characteristics of the eZ80F91 device.
Note: All data is preliminary and subject to change following completion of production
characterization.
Table 231. DC Characteristics
TA =
0ºC to 70ºC
TA =
–40ºC to 105ºC
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
Max
VDD
Supply Voltage
3.0
3.6
3.0
3.6
V
Low Level
Input Voltage
–0.3
0.3 x VDD
–0.3
0.3 x VDD
V
VIL
High Level
Input Voltage
0.7 x VDD
5.5
0.7 x VDD
5.5
V
VIH
Low Level
Output Voltage
0.4
V
VOL
VDD = 3.0 V;
IOL = 1 mA
High Level
Output Voltage
2.4
V
VOH
VDD = 3.0 V;
IOH = –1 mA
RTC Supply
Voltage
2.0
3.6
2.0
3.6
V
VRTC
Input Leakage
Current
–10
+10
–10
+10
µA
IIL
VDD = 3.6V;
VIN = VDD or VSS1
Tristate Leakage
Current
–10
+10
–10
+10
µA
VDD = 3.6 V
ITL
ICC a
Active Current
230
mA
HALT Mode
Current
120
mA
ICC h
SLEEP Mode
Current
850
µA
ICC s
RTC Supply
Current
10
µA
IRTC
0.4
2.5
Typical
2.4
10
2.5
Typical
Units Conditions
Supply current into
VRTC
Note: 1This condition excludes all pins with on-chip pull-ups when driven Low.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
347
POR and VBO Electrical Characteristics
Table 232 lists the Power-On Reset and Voltage Brown-Out characteristics of the
eZ80F91 device.
Table 232. POR and VBO Electrical Characteristics
TA = –40ºC to 105ºC
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
VVBO
VBO Voltage Threshold
2.45
2.77
VPOR
POR Voltage Threshold
2.55
VHYST
POR/VBO Hysteresis
55
TANA
POR/VBO analog RESET duration 40
Unit
Conditions
2.90
V
VCC = VVBO
2.70
2.95
V
VCC = VPOR.
75
95
mV
100
µs
TVBO_MIN VBO pulse reject period
10
IPOR_VBO POR/VBO DC current consumption
40
VCCRAMP VCC ramp rate requirements to
guarantee proper RESET occurs
Max
µs
0.1
50
µA
100
V/ms
Flash Memory Characteristics
Table 233 lists the Flash memory characteristics of the eZ80F91 device.
Table 233. Flash Memory Electrical Characteristics and Timing
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6 V; TA = –40ºC to 105ºC
Symbol
Minimum
Typical
Maximum
Units
Flash Byte Read Time
60
—
—
ns
Flash Byte Program Time
65
—
85
ns
Flash Page Erase Time
—
10
—
ms
Flash Mass Erase Time
—
200
—
ms
Writes to Single Address
—
—
2
Flash Row Program Time
—
—
13.4
ms
100
—
—
years
10,000
—
—
cycles
Data Retention
Endurance
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Notes
2 KB
Before Next Erase
ROW mode
25ºC
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
348
AC Characteristics
The section provides information about the AC characteristics and timing of the
eZ80F91 device. All AC timing information assumes a standard load of 50 pF on
all outputs. See Table 234.
Note: All data is preliminary and subject to change following completion of production
characterization.
Table 234. AC Characteristics
TA =
0ºC to 70ºC
Symbol Parameter
TA =
–40ºC to 105ºC
Min
Max
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
1000
20
1000
ns
VDD = 3.0 – 3.6V
TXIN
System Clock
Cycle Time
20
TXINH
System Clock
High Time
8
8
ns
VDD = 3.0 – 3.6V;
TCLK = 20 ns
TXINL
System Clock
Low Time
8
8
ns
VDD = 3.0 – 3.6V;
TCLK = 20 ns
TXINR
System Clock
Rise Time
3
3
ns
VDD = 3.0 – 3.6V;
TCLK = 20 ns
TXINF
System Clock
Fall Time
3
3
ns
VDD = 3.0 – 3.6V;
TCLK = 20 ns
CIN
Input capacitance
pF
Pad library
simulation
10 typical
10 typical
Table 235 shows simulated inductance, capacitance, and resistance results for
the 144-pin LQFP package at 100 MHz operating frequency.
Table 235. Typical 144-LQFP Package Electrical Characteristics*
Lead
Inductance (nH)
Capacitance (pF)
Resistance (mΩ)
Longest
6.430
1.100
62.9
Shortest
4.230
1.070
52.6
Note: *Package vendor-supplied; 100 MHz operating frequency.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
349
External Memory Read Timing
Figure 64 and Table 236 diagram the timing for external memory reads.
TCLK
PHI
T1
T2
ADDR[23:0]
T3
T4
DATA[7:0]
(input)
T5
T8
CSx
T7
T8
T9
T10
MREQ
RD
Figure 64. External Memory Read Timing
Table 236. External Memory Read Timing
Delay (ns)
PS019209-0504
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min.
Max.
T1
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Valid Delay
—
6.8
T2
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Hold Time
2.2
—
T3
Input DATA Valid to PHI Clock Rise Setup Time
0.2
—
T4
PHI Clock Rise to DATA Hold Time
0.9
—
T5
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Assertion Delay
2.6
10.8
T6
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Deassertion Delay
2.4
8.8
T7
PHI Clock Rise to MREQ Assertion Delay
2.6
7.0
T8
PHI Clock Rise to MREQ Deassertion Delay
2.3
6.3
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
350
Table 236. External Memory Read Timing (Continued)
Delay (ns)
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min.
Max.
T9
PHI Clock Rise to RD Assertion Delay
2.7
7.0
T10
PHI Clock Rise to RD Deassertion Delay
2.4
6.3
External Memory Write Timing
Figure 65 and Table 237 diagram the timing for external memory Writes.
TCLK
PHI
T2
T1
ADDR[23:0]
T4
T3
DATA[7:0]
(output)
T5
T6
CSx
T7
T8
MREQ
T9
T10
WR
Figure 65. External Memory Write Timing
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
351
Table 237. External Memory Write Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min.
Max.
T1
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Valid Delay
—
6.8
T2
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Hold Time
2.2
—
T3
PHI Clock Fall to Output DATA Valid Delay
—
7.5
T4
PHI Clock Rise to DATA Hold Time
2.3
—
T5
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Assertion Delay
2.6
10.8
T6
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Deassertion Delay
2.4
8.8
T7
PHI Clock Rise to MREQ Assertion Delay
2.6
7.0
T8
PHI Clock Rise to MREQ Deassertion Delay
2.3
6.3
T9
PHI Clock Fall to WR Assertion Delay
1.8
4.5
T10
PHI Clock Rise to WR Deassertion Delay*
1.6
4.4
WR Deassertion to ADDR Hold Time
0.4
—
WR Deassertion to DATA Hold Time
0.5
—
WR Deassertion to CSx Hold Time
1.2
—
WR Deassertion to MREQ Hold Time
0.5
—
* At the conclusion of a Write cycle, deassertion of WR always occurs before any
change to ADDR, DATA, CSx, or MREQ.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
352
External I/O Read Timing
Figure 66 and Table 238 diagram the timing for external I/O reads. PHI clock rise/
fall to signal transition timing is independent of the particular bus mode employed
(eZ80, Z80, Intel, or Motorola).
TCLK
PHI
T1
T2
ADDR[23:0]
T3
T4
DATA[7:0]
(input)
T5
T8
CSx
T7
T8
T9
T10
IORQ
RD
Figure 66. External I/O Read Timing
Table 238. External I/O Read Timing
Delay (ns)
PS019209-0504
Parameter
Abbreviation
T1
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Valid Delay
—
6.8
T2
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Hold Time
2.2
—
T3
Input DATA Valid to PHI Clock Rise Setup Time
0.2
—
T4
PHI Clock Rise to DATA Hold Time
0.9
—
T5
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Assertion Delay
2.6
10.8
T6
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Deassertion Delay
2.4
8.8
T7
PHI Clock Rise to IORQ Assertion Delay
2.6
7.0
PRELIMINARY
Min
Max
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
353
Table 238. External I/O Read Timing (Continued)
Delay (ns)
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min
Max
T8
PHI Clock Rise to IORQ Deassertion Delay
2.3
6.3
T9
PHI Clock Rise to RD Assertion Delay
2.7
7.0
T10
PHI Clock Rise to RD Deassertion Delay
2.4
6.3
External I/O Write Timing
Figure 67 and Table 239 diagram the timing for external I/O Writes. PHI clock rise/
fall to signal transition timing is independent of the particular bus mode employed
(eZ80, Z80, Intel, or Motorola).
TCLK
PHI
T2
T1
ADDR[23:0]
T4
T3
DATA[7:0]
(output)
T5
T6
CSx
T7
T8
IORQ
T9
T10
WR
Figure 67. External I/O Write Timing
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
354
Table 239. External I/O Write Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min
Max
T1
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Valid Delay
—
6.8
T2
PHI Clock Rise to ADDR Hold Time
2.2
—
T3
PHI Clock Fall to Output DATA Valid Delay
—
7.5
T4
PHI Clock Rise to DATA Hold Time
2.3
—
T5
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Assertion Delay
2.6
10.8
T6
PHI Clock Rise to CSx Deassertion Delay
2.4
8.8
T7
PHI Clock Rise to IORQ Assertion Delay
2.6
7.0
T8
PHI Clock Rise to IORQ Deassertion Delay
2.3
6.3
T9
PHI Clock Fall to WR Assertion Delay
1.8
4.5
T10
PHI Clock Rise to WR Deassertion Delay*
1.6
4.4
WR Deassertion to ADDR Hold Time
0.4
—
WR Deassertion to DATA Hold Time
0.5
—
WR Deassertion to CSx Hold Time
1.2
—
WR Deassertion to IORQ Hold Time
0.5
—
Note: *At the conclusion of a Write cycle, deassertion of WR always occurs before any change to
ADDR, DATA, CSx, or IORQ.
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
355
Wait State Timing for Read Operations
Figure 68 illustrates the extension of the memory access signals using a single
WAIT state for a Read operation. This wait state is generated by setting CS_WAIT
to 001 in the Chip Select Control Register.
TCLK
TWAIT
SCLK
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
(output)
CSx
MREQ
RD
INSTRD
Figure 68. Wait State Timing for Read Operations
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
356
Wait State Timing for Write Operations
Figure 69 illustrates the extension of the memory access signals using a single
WAIT state for a Write operation. This wait state is generated by setting CS_WAIT
to 001 in the Chip Select Control Register.
TCLK
TWAIT
PHI
ADDR[23:0]
DATA[7:0]
(output)
CSx
MREQ
WR
Figure 69. Wait State Timing for Write Operations
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
357
General Purpose I/O Port Input Sample Timing
Figure 70 illustrates timing of the GPIO input sampling. The input value on a GPIO
port pin is sampled on the rising edge of the system clock. The port value is then
available to the CPU on the second rising clock edge following the change of the
port value.
TCLK
PHI
Port Value
Changes to 0
GPIO Pin
Input Value
GPIO Input
Data Latch
0 Latched
Into GPIO
Data Register
GPIO Data Register
Value 0 Read
by eZ80
GPIO Data
READ on Data Bus
Figure 70. Port Input Sample Timing
General Purpose I/O Port Output Timing
Figure 71 and Table 240 provide timing information for GPIO port pins.
TCLK
PHI
Port Output
T1
T2
Figure 71. GPIO Port Output Timing
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
358
Table 240. GPIO Port Output Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min
Max
T1
PHI Clock Rise to Port Output Valid Delay
—
9.3
T2
PHI Clock Rise to Port Output Hold Time
2.0
—
External Bus Acknowledge Timing
Table 241 provides information on the bus acknowledge timing.
Table 241. Bus Acknowledge Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min
Max
T1
PHI Clock Rise to BUSACK Assertion Delay
2.8
7.1
T2
PHI Clock Rise to BUSACK Deassertion Delay
2.5
6.5
External System Clock Driver Timing
Table 242 provides timing information for the PHI pin. The PHI pin allows external
peripherals to synchronize with the internal system clock driver on the eZ80F91
device.
Table 242. PHI System Clock Timing
Delay (ns)
PS019209-0504
Parameter
Abbreviation
Min
Max
T1
PHI Clock Rise to PHI Rise
1.6
4.6
T2
PHI Clock Fall to PHI Fall
1.8
4.3
PRELIMINARY
Electrical Characteristics
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
359
Packaging
Figure 72 illustrates the 144-pin LQFP (low-profile quad flat pack) package for the
eZ80F91 device.
HD
D
A
A2
A1
CL
F
E
HE
DETAIL A
CL
LE
c
b
e
L
Figure 72. 144-Lead Plastic Low-Profile Quad Flat Package (LQFP)
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Packaging
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
360
Figure 73 illustrates the 144-pin BGA (chip array Ball Grid Array) package for the
eZ80F91 device.
Figure 73. 144-Lead Chip Array Ball Grid Array (BGA)
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Packaging
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
361
Ordering Information
Table 243 provides a part name, a product specification index code, and a brief
description of each part.
Table 243. Ordering Information
Part
PSI
Description
eZ80F91
eZ80F91AZ050SC
144-pin LQFP, 256 KB Flash memory, 8 KB
SRAM, 50 MHz, Standard Temperature.
eZ80F91AZ050EC
144-pin LQFP, 256 KB Flash memory, 8 KB
SRAM, 50 MHz, Extended Temperature.
eZ80F91NA050SC
144-pin BGA, 256 KB Flash memory, 8 KB
SRAM, 50 MHz, Standard Temperature.
eZ80F91NA050EC
144-pin BGA, 256 KB Flash memory, 8 KB
SRAM, 50 MHz, Extended Temperature.
eZ80F910200ZCO
Complete Development Kit.
eZ80F91 Development Kit
Navigate your browser to ZiLOG’s website to order the eZ80F91 microcontroller.
Or, contact your local ZiLOG Sales Office. ZiLOG provides additional assistance
on its Customer Service page, and is also here to help with Technical Support
issues.
For ZILOG’s valuable development tools and downloadable software, visit the
ZiLOG website.
Part Number Description
ZiLOG part numbers consist of a number of components, as indicated in the following examples:
ZiLOG Base Products
PS019209-0504
eZ80
ZiLOG eZ80® CPU
F91
Product Number
AZ
Package
050
Speed
S or E
Temperature
C
Environmental Flow
PRELIMINARY
Ordering Information
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
362
Package
AZ = LQFP (also called the VQFP)
Speed
050 = 50 MHz
Standard Temperature
S = 0ºC to +70ºC
Extended Temperature
E = –40ºC to +105ºC
Environmental Flow
C = Plastic Standard
Example: Part number eZ80F91AZ050SC is an eZ80F91 product in a LQFP package,
operating with a 50-MHz external clock frequency over a 0ºC to +70ºC temperature range
and built using the Plastic Standard environmental flow.
Precharacterization Product
The product represented by this document is newly introduced and ZiLOG has not
completed the full characterization of the product. The document states what
ZiLOG knows about this product at this time, but additional features or nonconformance with some aspects of the document might be found, either by ZiLOG or its
customers in the course of further application and characterization work. In addition, ZiLOG cautions that delivery might be uncertain at times, due to start-up
yield issues.
ZiLOG, Inc.
532 Race Street
San Jose, CA
95126-3432
USA
Telephone (408) 558-8500
FAX 408 558-8300
Internet: www.zilog.com
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Ordering Information
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
363
Document Information
Document Number Description
The Document Control Number that appears in the footer on each page of this
document contains unique identifying attributes, as indicated in the following
table:
PS
Product Specification
0192
Unique Document Number
09
Revision Number
0504
Month and Year Published
Change Log
PS019209-0504
Rev
Date
Purpose
By
01
12/02
Original issue
J. Eversmann, B. Metzler, R. Beebe
02
01/03
Minor content changes
B. Metzler, R. Beebe
03
02/03
Minor content changes
P. Clark, R. Beebe
04
02/03
Minor content changes
R. Beebe
05
03/03
Modified INT_P0:5
B. Metzler, R. Beebe
06
06/03
Minor modifications
B. Metzler, R. Beebe
07
07/03
Minor modifications
C. Bender, R. Beebe
08
10/03
Added BGA info
C. Bender, R. Beebe
09
05/04
Minor content changes
R. Xue, C. Bender, B. Metzler, R. Beebe
PRELIMINARY
Document Information
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
364
Index
Numerics
100-pin LQFP package 4, 5
16-bit clock divisor value 189, 215
16-bit divisor count 189, 215
32 KHz Real-Time Clock Crystal Oscillator
Operation 343
A
AAK—see I2C Acknowledge
Absolute Maximum Ratings 345
AC Characteristics 348
ACK—see Acknowledge
Acknowledge 221, 225–229, 232, 236–237
I2C 221
ADDR0 6
ADDR1 6
ADDR2 6
ADDR3 6
ADDR4 7
ADDR5 7
ADDR6 7
ADDR7 7
ADDR8 8
ADDR9 8
ADDR10 8
ADDR11 8
ADDR12 9
ADDR13 9
ADDR14 9
ADDR15 9
ADDR16 10
ADDR17 10
ADDR18 10
ADDR19 10
ADDR20 11
ADDR21 11
ADDR22 11
ADDR23 11
PS019209-0504
address bus 6–11, 66, 76, 78–79, 82–83, 86,
89–90, 93–94, 168, 293–294, 303, 309
24-bit 35
Addressing, I2C 231
alarm bit flag 167, 181
alarm condition 167–168, 181
AND/OR Gating of the PWM Outputs 153–154
Arbiter, EMAC 242
Arbitration, I2C 223
Architectural Overview 1
asynchronous communications protocol 183–
184
asynchronous serial data 17, 20–21
B
Basic Timer Operation 128
Basic Timer Register Set 136
Baud Rate Generator 188
Functional Description 213
BCD—see Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation
binary operation 166
Binary-Coded-Decimal Operation 166, 168–
179, 181
bit generation 183–184
Block Diagram 2
Boot Block 33, 105, 115, 117
Boundary Scan Cell Functionality 314
Boundary Scan Instructions 319
Boundary-Scan Architecture 311
break detection 183, 193
Break Point Halting 132
break point trigger functions 311
BRG Control Registers 189
bus acknowledge 15, 78, 98, 293–294, 302–
303, 309, 358
cycle 6–9, 11, 14–15, 78, 98–100, 102
Bus Arbiter 98
Bus Arbitration Overview 219
Bus Clock Speed, I2C 239
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
365
Bus Mode Controller 78
bus mode state 79–80, 83
bus modes 78–79, 92, 96
Switching Between 92
bus request 15, 78, 98, 293, 302, 309
Bus Requests During ZDI Debug Mode 293
bus timing 78
BUSACK—see bus acknowledge
BUSREQ—see bus request
Byte Format, I2C 221
C
C source-level debugging 286
capture flag 134
carrier sense 255, 259–260
Window Referencing 260
MII 30, 259
Chain Sequence and Length, JTAG Boundary
Scan 314
Change Log 363
Characteristics, Electrical
Charge Pump 320, 325
PLL 321
Chip Select Registers 93
Chip Select x Bus Mode Control Register 96
Chip Select x Control Register 95
Chip Select x Lower Bound Register 93
Chip Select x Upper Bound Register 94
Chip Select/Wait State Generator block 6–8,
10–11
Chip Selects and Wait States 73
Chip Selects During Bus Request/Bus
Acknowledge Cycles 78
Clear To Send 18, 21, 199, 202
Delta Status Change Of 202
CLK_MUX 325
clock divisor value, 16-bit 189, 215
clock initialization circuitry 312
Clock Peripheral Power-Down Registers 55
Clock Phase 210–212, 216
Clock Polarity 211–212, 216
Clock Synchronization for Handshake 224
Clock Synchronization, I2C 222
PS019209-0504
Clocking Overview 219
COL—see Collision Detect, MII
Collision Detect, MII 30
Complex triggers 311
CONTINUOUS mode 127, 130–132, 139,
143–144
Control Transfers, UART 187
CPHA—see Clock Phase
CPOL—see Clock Polarity
CRC—see cyclic redundancy check 246–247,
251–252, 264
CRS—see Carrier Sense, MII
CS0 11, 73–76
CS1 12, 73–76
CS2 12, 73, 75–76
CS3 12, 73, 75–76
CTS—see Clear To Send
CTS0 18, 206
CTS1 21
Customer Feedback Form 379
cycle termination signal 89–90
D
data bus 12, 78–79, 81–83, 86, 90, 96, 168,
293–294, 303, 309
Data Carrier Detect 19, 22, 199, 202
Delta Status Change Of 202
Data Set Ready 19, 22, 199, 202
Delta Status Change Of 202
Data Terminal Ready 18, 22, 199, 202
Data Transfer Procedure with SPI configured
as a Slave 214
Data Transfer Procedure with SPI Configured
as the Master 214
data transfer, SPI 217
Data Transfers, UART 187
Data Validity, I2C 220
DATA0 12
DATA1 12
DATA2 12
DATA3 12
DATA4 13
DATA5 13
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
366
DATA6 13
DATA7 13
DC Characteristics 346
DCD—see Data Carrier Detect
DCD0 19, 206
DCD1 22
DCTS—see Clear To Send, Delta Status
Change Of
DDCD—see Data Carrier Detect, Delta Status
Change Of
DDSR—see Data Set Ready, Delta Status
Change Of
Divider, PLL 321
divisor count 215
16-bit 189
Document Information 363
Document Number Description 363
DSR—see Data Set Ready
DSR0 19, 206
DSR1 22
DTACK—see cycle termination signal
DTR—see Data Terminal Ready
DTR0 18, 206
DTR1 22
E
EC0 23, 133, 136, 138
EC1 30, 133, 135, 138
edge-selectable interrupts 62
Edge-Triggered Interrupts 60, 62
Electrical Characteristics 345
EMAC—see Ethernet Media Access Controller
EMACMII module 240
Enabling and Disabling the WDT 123
encoder/decoder 204–205, 207–208
signal pins 206
IrDA 56
endec—see encoder/decoder
ENDEC Mode 254, 258
Erasing Flash Memory 109
Ethernet Media Access Controller 240
Address Filter Register 263
PS019209-0504
Boundary Pointer Register—Low and High
Bytes 271
Boundary Pointer Register—Upper Byte
272
Buffer Size Register 274
Configuration Register 1 251
Configuration Register 2 253
Configuration Register 3 254
Configuration Register 4 255
FIFO Data Register—Low and High Bytes
284
FIFO Flags Register 285
Functional Description 241
functions 240
Hash Table Register 264
Interpacket Gap 258
Interpacket Gap Register 259
Interrupt Enable Register 275
Interrupt Status Register 277
Interrupts 244
Maximum Frame Length Register—Low
and High Bytes 261
memory 241, 242
MII Management Register 265
MII Status Register 279
Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 1
260
Non-Back-To-Back IPG Register—Part 2
261
PHY Address Register 267
PHY Configuration Data Register—High
Byte 267
PHY Configuration Data Register—Low
Byte 266
PHY Read Status Data Register—Low and
High Bytes 278
PHY Unit Select Address Register 268
RAM 101–104
Receive Blocks Left Register—Low and
High Bytes 282
Receive High Boundary Pointer Register—
Low and High Bytes 272
Receive Read Pointer Register—Low and
High Bytes 273
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
367
Receive Write Pointer Register—High Byte
281
Receive Write Pointer Register—Low Byte
280
Receiver Interrupts 244
Registers 249
Reset Control Register 269
Shared Memory Organization 245
Station Address Register 256
sublayer module 240
System Interrupts 244
Test Register 249
Transmit Lower Boundary Pointer
Register—Low and High Bytes 270
Transmit Pause Timer Value Register—
Low and High Bytes 257
Transmit Polling Timer Register 268
Transmit Read Pointer Register—High
Byte 282
Transmit Read Pointer Register—Low
Byte 281
Transmitter Interrupts 244
event count input 138
event count mode 134
event counter 131, 133
External Bus Acknowledge Timing 358
external bus master 98–99
external bus request 78, 289, 293
External I/O Read Timing 352
External I/O Write Timing 353
External Memory Read Timing 349
External Memory Write Timing 350
external pull-down resistor 59
External Reset Input and Indicator 51
External System Clock Driver (PHI) Timing 358
eZ80 Bus Mode 79, 96
eZ80 CPU 14, 77–78, 82, 89, 204, 296, 311
Core 50
Instruction Set 330
eZ80 Product ID Low and High Byte Registers
305
eZ80 Product ID Revision Register 306
eZ80Acclaim!™ Flash Microcontrollers 1, 106
eZ80F91 device 4–5, 35, 347
PS019209-0504
F
falling edge 152–153, 155, 160
FAST mode 219, 239
FCS—see frame check sequence
Features 1
Features, eZ80 CPU Core 50
FIFO mode 184, 187
Flash Address registers 107–108, 111, 118
Flash Address Upper Byte Register 112
Flash Column Select Register 120
Flash Control Register 110, 113
Flash controller 106–108, 114, 116
clock 114
Flash Data Register 111
Flash Frequency Divider Register 114
Flash Interrupt Control Register 116
Flash Key Register 110
Flash Memory 105
Arrangement in the eZ80F91 Device 105
array 106, 118
Overview 106
Flash Page Select Register 118
Flash Program Control Register 120
Flash Row Select Register 119
Flash Write/Erase Protection Register 115
frame check sequence 247–248, 258
framing error 183, 185, 193, 200
frequency divider 106, 114
full-duplex transmission 212
Functional Description, Infrared Encoder/
Decoder 204
Functional Description, SPI 212
G
General Purpose Input/Output 58
Control Registers 62
Interrupts 61
modes 59–60
Operation 58
Port Input Sample Timing 357
Port Output Timing 357
port pins 51, 58, 63, 357
GND—see Ground
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
368
GPIO—see General Purpose Input/Output
Ground 2
H
HALT instruction 16, 54, 307, 333
Op-Code Map 335
HALT Mode 1, 54–55, 299, 307
HALT_SLP 16, 307, 314
handshake 183, 185, 224
hash table 263
I
I/O Chip Select Operation 76
I/O Chip Selects, External 35
I/O Read 107
I/O space 6–8, 10–11, 13, 73, 76
I2C Acknowledge 221, 225–226, 228–231,
234–235
I2C bus 219, 222–224
clock 219
protocol 220
I2C Clock Control Register 238
I2C control bit 225–226, 228
I2C Control Register 234
I2C Data Register 233
I2C Extended Slave Address Register 232
I2C General Characteristics 219
I2C Interrupt Flag 219, 224, 227, 229–232,
234, 237
I2C Registers 231
I2C Serial Clock 26, 219–221, 238
I2C Serial I/O Interface 219
I2C Slave Address Register 232
I2C Software Reset Register 239
I2C Status Register 236
IC0 23, 133, 136, 140–141, 144–147, 157, 161
IC1 24, 133, 136, 140–141, 144, 146, 157, 161
IC2 25, 133, 136, 140–141, 144–146, 157, 161
IC3 25, 133, 136, 140–141, 144, 146–147,
157, 161
IEEE 1149.1 specification 313, 319
PS019209-0504
IEEE 802.3 specification 253–254, 263
frames 252
IEEE 802.3, 802.3(u) minimum values 258
IEEE 802.3/4.2.3.2.1 Carrier Deference 259–
260
IEEE Standard 1149.1 311–312
IEF1 67–68, 131, 307
IEF2 67–68
IFLG—see I2C Interrupt Flag
IM 0, Op Code Map 338
IM 1, Op Code Map 338
IM 2, Op Code Map 338
Information Page Characteristics 110
Infrared Data Association 204
Receive Data 17
specifications 205
standard 204
standard baud rates 204
transceiver 207
Transmit Data 17
Infrared Encoder/Decoder 17, 56, 204, 207
Register 207
Signal Pins 206
Input capture mode 133–134, 136, 140
Input/Output Request 13, 15, 76, 79, 82–83, 86
Assertion Delay 352, 354
Deassertion Delay 353–354
Hold Time 354
INSTRD—see Instruction Read
Instruction Read 14
Instruction Store 4
0 Registers 303
Intel Bus Mode 81
Separate Address and Data Buses 82
internal pull-up 59
Internal RC oscillator 122–123, 125
internal system clock 77
interpacket gap 247, 258–259, 261
Interrupt Controller 65
Interrupt Enable bit 15, 167, 186, 234
Interrupt Enable Flag 131, 307
interrupt input 17–19, 21–22, 24–27, 29, 207
Interrupt Priority 69, 71
levels 68
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
369
Registers 68
Interrupt request 60–62, 66, 117, 133, 139–
140
enable 213, 216
signals 65
interrupt service routine 66–68
SPI 66
interrupt sources 157
interrupt vector 65–66
address 67, 68
bus 65–68
locations 66
table 67
interrupt, higher-priority 71, 194
interrupt, highest-priority 65–66
interrupts, edge-selectable 62
interrupts, level-sensitive 62
Introduction to On-Chip Instrumentation 311
Introduction, ZiLOG Debug Interface 286
IORQ—see Input/Output Request
IR_RXD modulation signal 205–208
IR_TxD modulation signal 17, 205–207
IrDA—see Infrared Data Association 204
IRQ—see interrupt request
IRQ_EN—see interrupt request enable
ISR—see interrupt service routine
IVECT—see interrupt vector bus
L
least-significant bit 142–143, 145–146, 149,
162, 164, 224–228, 230, 262, 266, 270,
272–273, 278, 280–281
least-significant byte 66–68, 143, 238, 243,
256, 263
level-sensitive interrupt modes 60
level-sensitive interrupts 62, 207
Level-Triggered Interrupts 61
Line break detection 183
line status error 186
line status interrupt 185, 187–188, 193
Lock Detect 320, 322
sensitivity 325
PLL 322
Loop Filter 320, 322, 329
PLL 20, 321
LOOP Mode 185
LOOP_FILT 313
Loopback Testing, Infrared Encoder/Decoder
207
low-byte vector 65
Low-Power Modes 54
LSB—see least-significant byte
lsb—see least-significant bit
M
J
Jitter, Infrared Encoder/Decoder 206
Joint Test Action Group 313
Boundary Scan 313
interface 311, 319
mode selection 312
Test Clock 288, 312–313, 319
Test Data In 312–314
Test Data Out 312–314
Test Mode 16
Test Mode Select 312–313
JTAG—see Joint Test Action Group
PS019209-0504
maskable interrupt 55, 65, 68, 71
MASS ERASE operation 109–110, 115–116,
118, 120–121
MASTER mode 211, 219, 230, 234–239
Start bit 234
Stop bit 234
SPI 212
MASTER RECEIVE Mode 219, 227
MASTER TRANSMIT Mode 219, 224
MASTER_EN bit 213
Master-In, Slave-Out 25, 210, 212
Master-Out, Slave-In 26, 210–212
MAXF—see Maximum Frame Length
Maximum Frame Length 251, 261
MBIST—see Memory Built-In Self-Test
controllers
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
370
MDC—see Media-Independent Interface
Management Data Clock
MDIO—see Media-Independent Interface
Management Data
Media-Independent Interface 240, 244, 258,
265, 276–279
Collision Detect 30
Management Data 33
Management Data Clock 33, 266
Memory and I/O Chip Selects 73
Memory Built-In Self-Test controllers 104
Memory Chip Select Example 74
Memory Chip Select Operation 73
Memory Chip Select Priority 74
Memory Read 107
Memory Request 14
memory space 73, 76
Memory Write 109
Memory, EMAC 241
MII—see Media-Independent Interface
MISO—see Master-In, Slave-Out
Mode fault error flag 210, 213, 217
modem status 186–188, 194, 198, 202
interrupt 206
signal 18–19, 21–22
MODF—see Mode fault error flag
Module Reset, UART 187
MOSI—see Master-Out, Slave-In
most significant bit 118, 143–144, 146–147,
150, 163, 165, 221, 262, 270, 279, 281–283,
292
most significant byte 67, 144, 243
Motorola Bus Mode 88
Motorola-compatible 78
MPWM_EN 151, 158
MREQ—see Memory Request 14–15, 74, 79,
82–83, 86, 349, 351
Hold Time 351
MSB—see most significant byte
msb—see most significant bit
Multibyte I/O Write (Row Programming) 108
multicast address 248, 264
multicast packet 263, 264
multimaster conflict 213, 217
PS019209-0504
Multi-PWM Control Registers 158
Multi-PWM Mode 150
Multi-PWM Power-Trip Mode 157
MUX/CLK Sync 320
PLL 321
N
NACK—see Not Acknowledge
New Instructions, eZ80 CPU Core 50
NMI—see Nonmaskable Interrupt
NMI_flag bit 124
NMI_OUT bit 124
Nonmaskable Interrupt 15, 50, 55, 65, 122,
124, 333
nonoverlapping delay, PWM 153, 156
Not Acknowledge 221, 225–226, 228–229,
235, 237
O
OC0 27, 133, 135, 140–141, 148–150
OC1 27, 133, 135, 140–141
OC2 28, 133, 135, 140,–141
OC3 28, 133, 135, 139, 141, 149–150
OCI—see On-Chip Instrumentation
On-Chip Instrumentation 311
Activation 312
clock pin 312
Interface 312
Introduction to 311
On-Chip Oscillators 342
on-chip pull-up 346
on-chip RAM 73, 101–102
Op Code maps 335
Open source I/O 59
open-drain I/O 59
open-drain mode 59
open-drain output 59, 219
open-source mode 59
open-source output 17–19, 21–23, 25–27, 29,
59
Operating Modes, I2C 224
Operation of the eZ80F91 Device during ZDI
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
371
Break Points 293
Ordering Information 361
OUTPUT COMPARE mode 133, 134, 137,
139, 148
overrun condition, receiver 186
overrun error 183, 185, 193, 201
Overview, Low-Power Modes 54
Overview, Phase-Locked Loop 320
P
PA7 155
Packaging 359
Page Erase operation 109, 118, 120, 121
PAIR_EN 158–159
parity error 185, 196, 201
Part Number Description 361
PB0 23
PB1 24
PB2 24
PB3 24
PB4 25
PB5 25
PB6 25
PB7 26
PC0 20, 27
PC1 21, 27
PC2 21, 28
PC3 21, 28
PC4 22, 29
PC5 22, 29
PC6 22, 30
PC7 23, 30
PD0 17, 207
PD1 17, 207
PD2 18, 207
PD3 18
PD4 18
PD5 19
PD6 19
PD7 19, 207
Phase Frequency Detector 320
PLL 321
Phase-Locked Loop 320
PS019209-0504
PHI—see system clock output
PHY—see Physical Layer, OSI Model
MII 240, 265
Physical Layer, OSI Model 6, 30–31, 32, 37–
38, 244, 248, 266–267, 277–279
Pin Characteristics 6
Pin Coverage, JTAG Boundary Scan 313
Pin Description 4
PLL Characteristics 327
PLL Control Register 0 325
PLL Control Register 1 326
PLL Divider Control Register—Low and High
Bytes 323
PLL Loop Filter 20
PLL Normal Operation 322
PLL Registers 323
PLL_VDD 323
PLL_VSS 323
Poll Mode Transfers 188
POP, Op Code Map 335, 337, 339
POR—see Power-On Reset
Port A 27, 28, 29, 56, 58, 66, 70, 71, 150
Port x Alternate Register 1 63
Port x Alternate Register 2 64
Port x Data Direction Registers 63
Port x Data Registers 62
Potential Hazards of Enabling Bus Requests
During Debug Mode 294
Power connections 2
Power-On Reset
Power Requirement to the Phase-Locked Loop
Function 323
Power-On Reset 51–52, 347
and VBO Electrical Characteristics 347
and VBO analog RESET duration 347
and VBO DC current consumption 347
and VBO Hysteresis 347
voltage threshold 52, 347
Power-Trip Mode, Multi-PWM 157–158
Precharacterization Product 362
Primary Crystal Oscillator Operation 342
Program Counter 51, 54–55, 67, 105, 304–
305, 309
Program Counter, Starting 68
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
372
Programmable Reload Timers 127
Programming Flash Memory 107
PROMISCUOUS Mode 263
PT_EN 158
pull-up resistor, external 59, 219
Pulse-Width Modulation
Control Register 1 158
Control Register 2 159
Control Register 3 161
delay feature 156
edge transition values 153–154
Falling Edge—High Byte 165
Falling Edge—Low Byte 164
generator 150–154, 158
generators 151
Master Mode 153
mode 127, 133, 137, 140
mode, Multi- 150–151, 153–154, 158
nonoverlapping delay 153
nonoverlapping delay time 156
Nonoverlapping Output Pair Delays 155
output pairs 153
outputs 154–155, 157
Outputs, AND/OR Gating 153–154
outputs, inverted 152
pairs 154
power-trip state 157
Rising Edge—High Byte 163
Rising Edge—Low Byte 162
signals 150
trip levels 161
waveform 154
PUSH, Op Code Map 335, 337, 339
PWM—see Pulse-Width Modulation
PWM0 155
PWM1 27, 29, 133, 135, 152, 154
PWM1 falling edge end-of-count 153, 156
PWM1 rising edge end-of-count 153, 156
PWM1_EN 158
PWM1FH 153
PWM1RH 163, 165
PWM1RL 162–165
PWM2 28, 30, 133, 135, 152
PWM2 falling edge end-of-count 153
PS019209-0504
PWM2 rising edge end-of-count 153
PWM2_EN 158
PWM2RH 153
PWM3 28, 30, 133, 135, 152
PWM3_EN 158
PWMCNTRL1 151
PWMCNTRL2 153
PWMCNTRL3 157
Q
qualified multicast messages 263
R
RAM—see Random Access Memory
Random Access Memory 101
Address Upper Byte Register 103
Control Register 102
RD—see Read instruction
Read instruction 13–14, 74, 76, 79, 82–83, 86
Assertion Delay 350, 353
Deassertion Delay 350, 353
Reading Flash Memory 106
Reading the Current Count Value 128
Real-Time Clock 51, 54, 166–168, 180
Alarm 54, 167
Alarm Control Register 180
Alarm Day-of-the-Week Register 179
Alarm Hours Register 178
Alarm Minutes Register 177
Alarm Seconds Register 176
Battery Backup 167
Century Register 175
Control Register 181
Day-of-the-Month Register 172
Day-of-the-Week Register 171
Hours Register 170
Minutes Register 169
Month Register 173
Oscillator and Source Selection 167
Overview 166
Recommended Operation 167
Registers 168
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
373
Seconds Register 168
signal 134
source 122, 125, 131
Year Register 174
Receive, Infrared Encoder/Decoder 205
Recommended Usage of the Baud Rate
Generator 189
Register Map 35
Register Set for Capture in Timer 1 136
Register Set for Capture/Compare/PWM in
Timer 3 137
Request To Send 18, 21, 199, 202, 206
RESET 14, 51–52, 54–55, 59, 73, 101–102,
113, 115, 122–124, 168, 171–181, 189, 207,
214–215, 297, 299, 312, 314, 347
Reset controller 51–52
RESET event 51, 58
RESET mode timer 51–52
Reset Operation 51
RESET Or NMI Generation 124
Reset States 74
RESET_OUT 314
Resetting the I2C Registers 231
RI—see Ring Indicator
RI0 19, 206
RI1 23, 60
Ring Indicator 19, 23, 185, 199, 202
Trailing Edge of 202
rising edge 152–153, 155, 160
RST_FLAG bit 124
RTC Oscillator Input 134
RTC Supply Voltage 346
RTC_VDD 16
RTC_XIN 15
RTC_XOUT 15, 167
RTS—see Request To Send
RTS0 18
RTS1 21
Rx_CLK 32
Rx_DV 32
Rx_ER 32
RxD0 17, 32
RxD1 21, 32
RxD2 32
PS019209-0504
RxD3 33
RxDMA 243
S
Schmitt Trigger 14–15
Input 14–16, 20, 22–23, 25, 33
input buffers 58
SCK—see SPI Serial Clock
SCL—see I2C Serial Clock
SCL line 222, 224
SCLK—see System Clock
SDA 26, 219, 220, 221, 231
SDA line 223
see system reset 13
serial bus, SPI 217, 218
Serial Clock 219
Serial Clock, I2C 26, 219–221, 238
Serial Clock, SPI 24, 210
Serial Data 210, 219
Serial Data, I2C 26
Serial Peripheral Interface 1, 56, 66, 70, 209–
210, 212
Baud Rate Generator 213
Baud Rate Generator Registers—Low
Byte and High Byte 215
Control Register 216
Data Rate 214
Flags 213
Functional Description 212
interrupt service routine 66
master device 25–26, 214
MASTER mode 212
mode 24
Receive Buffer Register 218
Registers 214
serial bus 217
Signals 210
slave device 25, 26
SLAVE mode 212
Status Register 217
Status register 213
Transmit Shift Register 213–214, 217
Setting Timer Duration 128
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
374
Shift Left Arithmetic 226, 228, 232, 334
Op Code Map 336, 340–341
Shift Right Arithmetic 334
Op Code Map 336, 340
SINGLE PASS Mode 127, 129–130, 139
Single-Byte I/O Write 107
SLA—see Shift Left Arithmetic
SLAVE mode 219, 230, 232, 234, 237
SLAVE mode, SPI 212
Slave Receive 219, 230
Slave Select 24, 210–212, 214, 216
Slave Transmit mode 219, 229–230, 235
SLEEP Mode 54, 181, 299, 307
sleep-mode recovery 181
reset 35, 182
Software break point instruction 311
Specialty Timer Modes 133
SPI—see Serial Peripheral Interface
SPI Serial Clock 24, 210
Flag 212, 217–218,
Idle State 211
pin 212, 216
Receive Edge 211
signal 212
Transmit Edge 211
SPIF—see SPI Flag
SRA—see Shift Right Arithmetic
SRAM—see Static RAM
SS—see Slave Select
STA—see MASTER Mode Start bit
STANDARD mode 219
Standard VHDL Package STD_1149_1_2001
314
START and STOP Conditions 220
START condition 220, 222–224, 226–227,
229–237, 239
ZDI 288
Starting Program Counter 67–68
Static RAM 1, 112, 281, 286, 361
internal Ethernet 245
STOP condition 220–221, 224, 227, 229–231,
234–235, 237, 239
supply voltage 2, 52, 59, 219, 322, 345–347
Switching Between Bus Modes 92
PS019209-0504
System Clock 51, 54–57, 60–61, 122–123,
125, 131, 133, 138, 155, 188, 213, 238–239,
242, 266, 320–322, 357
Cycle Time 348
cycles 14, 76, 79–80, 83, 86–87, 90, 123,
128, 312
divider 139
driver 358
Driver Timing, External 358
Fall Time 348
Frequency 128, 189, 214
frequency 107, 109, 113–114, 287
High Time 348
jitter 134
Low Time 348
Oscillator Input 20
Oscillator Output 20
output 26, 57, 315, 358
period 312
periods 156, 160
Rise Time 348
rising edge 188, 213
source 325
Timing, PHI 358
system clock, high-frequency 213
system clock, internal 77
system RESET 51, 167, 169, 170, 191, 249,
322
T
T2 clock 156
T2 end-of-count 156
T23CLKCN 156
TAP—see Test Access Port
TCK—see JTAG Test Clock
TDI—see JTAG Test Data In
TDO—see JTAG Test Data Out
TERI—see Ring Indicator, Trailing Edge of
Test Access Port 311, 319
instruction 319
Reset 312–313
state register 312
Test Mode 312
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
375
Time-Out Period Selection 123
Timer Control Register 138
Timer Data Register—High Byte 142
Timer Data Register—Low Byte 142
Timer Input Capture Control Register 144
Timer Input Capture Value A Register—High
Byte 146
Timer Input Capture Value A Register—Low
Byte 145
Timer Input Capture Value B Register—High
Byte 147
Timer Input Capture Value B Register—Low
Byte 146
Timer Input Source Selection 131
Timer Interrupt Enable Register 139
Timer Interrupt Identification Register 141
Timer Interrupts 130
Timer Output 131
Compare Control Register 1 147
Compare Control Register 2 148
Compare Value Register—High Byte 150
Compare Value Register—Low Byte 149
Timer Port Pin Allocation 135
Timer Registers 136
Timer Reload Register—High Byte 144
Timer Reload Register—Low Byte 143
TMS—see JTAG Test Mode Select
TOUT0 29, 135
TOUT1 29, 135
Trace buffer memory 311
Trace history buffer 311
Transferring Data 221
transmit shift register 184, 192, 196, 200
Transmit Shift Register, SPI 212–214, 217–
218
Transmit, Infrared Encoder/Decoder 205
trigger-level detection logic 184
TRIGOUT 312, 314
tristate 157
TRSTn—see Test Access Port Reset
Tx_CLK 31
Tx_EN 31
Tx_ER 31
TxD0 17, 31
PS019209-0504
TxD1 20, 31
TxD2 31
TxD3 31
TxDMA 242
U
UART—see Universal Asynchronous
Receiver/Transmitter
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
183
Baud Rate Generator Register—Low and
High Bytes 189
FIFO Control Register 195
Functional Description 184
Functions 184
Interrupt Enable Register 192
Interrupt Identification Register 193
Interrupts 186
Line Control Register 196
Line Status Register 200
Modem Control 185
Modem Control Register 198
Modem Status Interrupt 187
Modem Status Register 202
Receive Buffer Register 192
Receiver 185
Receiver Interrupts 186
Recommended Usage 187
Registers 191
Scratch Pad Register 203
Transmit Holding Register 191
Transmitter 184
Transmitter Interrupt 186
Usage, JTAG Boundary Scan 319
V
VBO—see Voltage Brown-Out
VCC—see supply voltage
VCC ramp rate 347
VCO—see Voltage Controlled Oscillator
VLAN tagged frame 261
Voltage Brown-Out 51–53, 347
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
376
pulse reject period 347
Reset 52
Voltage Threshold 347
Voltage Controlled Oscillator 321, 328
PLL 321
voltage signal, high 108
voltage, input 321
voltage, peak-to-peak 329
voltage, supply 2, 59, 219, 322, 345, 346
W
WAIT 1, 14, 83, 86, 89–90, 120
WAIT Input Signal 77
WAIT pin, external 79
Wait State Timing for Read Operations 355
Wait State Timing for Write Operations 356
WAIT states 66, 76, 80, 87, 83, 86, 95, 294,
355–356
Watch-Dog Timer 1, 51, 54, 122–124, 293
clock source 122–123, 125
Control Register 35, 124
Operation 123
oscillator 124
Overview 122
Registers 124
Reset Register 126
time-out 51, 54–55, 122–126
time-out reset 35
WCOL—see Write Collision
WDT—see Watch-Dog Timer
WP—see Write Protect pin
WR—see Write instruction
Write Collision 212–213, 217
SPI 217
Write instruction 13–14, 74, 76, 79, 83, 86,
351, 354
Write Protect pin 33, 105, 115, 117
X
Z
Z80 Bus Mode 79
ZCL—see ZiLOG Debug Interface Clock
ZDA—see ZiLOG Debug Interface Data
ZDI—see ZiLOG Debug Interface
ZDI_BUS_STAT 294, 296, 309
ZDI_BUSACK_EN 293, 309
ZDI-Supported Protocol 287
ZDS II—see ZiLOG Developer Studio II
ZiLOG Debug Interface 286–287, 311
Address Match Registers 296
Block Read 292
Block Write 291
Break Control Register 297
Bus Control Register 302
Bus Status Register 309
Clock 288, 291, 297
lock and Data Conventions 288
clock pin 288
Data 288, 297, 312
data pin 288
debug control 311
Master Control Register 299
Read Memory Register 309
Read Operations 292
Read Register Low, High, and Upper 308
Read/Write Control Register 300
Read-Only Registers 295
Register Addressing 290
Register Definitions 296
Single-Bit Byte Separator 289
Single-Byte Read 292
Single-Byte Write 291
Start Condition 288
Status Register 307
Write Data Registers 300
Write Memory Register 304
Write Only Registers 294
Write Operations 291
ZiLOG Developer Studio II 286
XIN input pin 342
XOUT output pin 342
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Index
eZ80F91 MCU
Product Specification
377
Customer Feedback Form
The eZ80F91 Product Specification
If you experience any problems while operating this product, or if you note any inaccuracies while reading
this Product Specification, please copy and complete this form, then mail or fax it to ZiLOG (see Return
Information, below). We also welcome your suggestions!
Customer Information
Name
Country
Company
Phone
Address
Fax
City/State/Zip
Email
Product Information
Serial # or Board Fab #/Rev. #
Software Version
Document Number
Host Computer Description/Type
Return Information
ZiLOG
System Test/Customer Support
532 Race Street
San Jose, CA 95126
Phone: (408) 558-8500
Fax: (408) 558-8536
Email: [email protected]
Problem Description or Suggestion
Provide a complete description of the problem or your suggestion. If you are reporting a specific problem,
include all steps leading up to the occurrence of the problem. Attach additional pages as necessary.
_______________________________________________________________________________
_______________________________________________________________________________
_______________________________________________________________________________
_______________________________________________________________________________
_______________________________________________________________________________
PS019209-0504
PRELIMINARY
Customer Feedback Form